This is only a preview of the June 2012 issue of Silicon Chip. You can view 28 of the 104 pages in the full issue, including the advertisments. For full access, purchase the issue for $10.00 or subscribe for access to the latest issues. Items relevant to "Crazy Cricket Or Freaky Frog":
Items relevant to "Wideband Oxygen Sensor Controller Mk.2, Pt.1":
Items relevant to "Mix-It: An Easy-To Build 4-Channel Mixer":
Items relevant to "PIC/AVR Programming Adaptor Board; Pt.2":
Purchase a printed copy of this issue for $10.00. |
siliconchip.com.au
June 2012 1
Ask for our 2-page
CRAZY CLEARANCE FLYER
JUNE
CRAZY
in-store or download from our website.
www.jaycar.com.au/JUNEclearanceAU
40A Switchmode Laboratory
Power Supply
CLEARANCE
A high-powered switch mode power
supply that will deliver up to 40 amps. It has a variable
output voltage from 3 to 15VDC, or it can be fixed at
13.8VDC. The unit has overload, over temperature and over
voltage protection.
UP TO
70% OFF
29900
$
• Large, seven segment LED display
• Size: 220(W) x 110(H) x 300(L)mm
MP-3090 Was $339.00
SAVE $40
10MHz Velleman Rechargeable Handheld Pocket Scope
A complete portable oscilloscope with a tiny size. Aside from standard scope
features, it has nifty tools for measurement of RMS speaker power, display hold
function, and memory storage for 2 signals. Housed in a durable rubber surround
with backlit LCD display and inbuilt Ni-MH battery. See our website or
in-store for full specifications.
LeoStick Arduino Compatible
A tiny Arduino-compatible board that's so small you
can plug it straight into your USB port without
requiring a cable! Features a full range of analogue
and digital I/O just like its larger cousins, and
also has a user-controllable RGB LED on
the board and an on-board
Piezo/sound generator so you can
make your board light up and
play sounds without any extra
hardware at all!
• ATmega32u4 MCU with 2.5k RAM and 32k Flash
• 6 analogue inputs (10-bit ADC)
with digital I/O, 14 extra
NEW
digital I/O pins
$
95
XC-4266
29
LeoStick Prototyping Shield
Add your own custom parts to the LeoStick to
build projects or add more I/O connectors. Fits on
the top of the LeoStick and provides you a free
matrix of platedthrough holes for
your own use.
• 64 general-purpose
plated holes for
your parts
• All Arduino I/O headers
NEW
brought up for your use
• Includes male header pins
$ 95
• Gold-plated surface
XC-4268
7
• CRO probe and USB charge
cable supplied
• 10MHz
• Rechargeable
• Size: 114(H) x 74(W) x 29(D)mm
QC-1914
24900
$
BUY
BOTH FOR
$400 SAVE
$48
1MHz Handheld Function Generator
A signal generator with the features of a bench top generator and a portable size! This
pocket signal generator will produce sine, square, and triangle waveform signals yet it is
only a little bigger than a Smartphone. Output frequency adjustment is from 1Hz to 1MHz
with maximum amplitude of 8Vpp. It also has a function to shift between two frequencies
over an adjustable period. With a backlit LCD, inbuilt rechargeable battery, and durable
rubber surround it is an ideal instrument for testing on the
go or in your workshop. See website for specifications.
NEW
• Weight: 200g
• Size: 114(H) x 74(W) x 29(D)mm
QT-2304
KIT BACK CATALOGUE
If you can’t find the kit you are looking
for, try the Jaycar Kit Back Catalogue.
Our central warehouse keeps a quantity
of older and slow moving kits that can
no longer be held in stores. A list of kits
can be found on our website. Just
search for “kit
back catalogue”.
Attention:
Kit Builders
To order call 1800 022 888
19900
$
Non-Contact AC Voltage
Tester with Torch
Detects AC voltages from 200 - 1000V in
mains outlets, powerboards or insulated wiring.
It also has an LED torch and a handy
pocket clip. A must for
every toolbox.
• CAT III rated
• Requires 2 x AA batteries
• Size: 180(L) x 20(D)mm
QP-2271 Was $19.95
Price valid until 23/06/2012
1495
$
SAVE $5
www.jaycar.com.au
Contents
SILICON
CHIP
www.siliconchip.com.au
Vol.25, No.6; June 2012
Features
12 New Microcontrollers: Feature-Laden, Fast & Furious
The microcontroller scene is on the boil, with a host of impressive products
now available. Here’s a brief look at what’s new – by Nicholas Vinen
20 WiNRADiO Excalibur WR-G31DDC HF Receiver
“Excalibur” is the name for the latest software-controlled HF receiver from
WiNRADiO. Like its namesake, it’s almost magical – by Maurie Findlay
82 Review: Agilent’s 35670A Dynamic Signal Analyser
Crazy Cricket Or Freaky
Frog – Page 26.
26.
An oldie but a goodie, Agilent’s 35670A is virtually the industry standard for
sound and vibration engineers – by Allan Linton-Smith
Pro jects To Build
26 Crazy Cricket Or Freaky Frog
Like the sound of crickets and frogs? You will probably revise your opinion after
exposure to Crazy or Freaky, a very pesky cricket and an equally annoying frog
– by John Clarke
32 Wideband Oxygen Sensor Controller Mk.2, Pt.1
Involved in car engine modifications? If so, you need to fit a wideband oxygen
sensor and build this improved Wideband Oxygen Sensor Controller to check
that your engine is not running too lean or too rich – by John Clarke
58 Mix-It: An Easy-To Build 4-Channel Mixer
Want to mix two or more audio signals together? This 4-channel mixer might
be simple to build but its performance lacks for nothing! – by Nicholas Vinen
Wideband Oxygen Sensor
Controller Mk.2, Pt.1 – Page 32.
74 PIC/AVR Programming Adaptor Board; Pt.2
Our new programming adaptor board works in conjunction with an ICSP to
program most 8/16-bit PIC and 8-bit Atmel AVR microcontrollers. This month,
we describe the construction and show you how to use it – by Nicholas Vinen
Special Columns
44 Serviceman’s Log
Off on yet another wild goose chase – by the Serviceman
68 Circuit Notebook
Mix-It: An Easy-To-Build
4-Channel Mixer – Page 58.
(1) Tank Water Level Circuit With Hysteresis; (2) Really Simple Garage Door
Monitor; (3) 433MHz Remote Lamp Switching; (4) Optical Tachometer Uses
Photo-Interruptor; (5) Accurate Clock Uses Maximite & Garmin GPS Module;
(6) Engine Hours Counter
90 Vintage Radio
John de Hass & his Philips vintage radio collection – by Rodney Champness
Departments
2
4
57
97
Publisher’s Letter
Mailbag
Product Showcase
Order Form
siliconchip.com.au
98 Ask Silicon Chip
103 Market Centre
104 Notes & Errata
PIC/AVR Programming Adaptor
Board, Pt.2 – Page 74.
June 2012 1
SILICON
SILIC
CHIP
www.siliconchip.com.au
Publisher & Editor-in-Chief
Leo Simpson, B.Bus., FAICD
Production Manager
Greg Swain, B.Sc. (Hons.)
Technical Editor
John Clarke, B.E.(Elec.)
Technical Staff
Ross Tester
Jim Rowe, B.A., B.Sc
Nicholas Vinen
Photography
Ross Tester
Reader Services
Ann Morris
Advertising Enquiries
Glyn Smith
Phone (02) 9939 3295
Mobile 0431 792 293
glyn<at>siliconchip.com.au
Regular Contributors
Brendan Akhurst
Rodney Champness, VK3UG
Kevin Poulter
Stan Swan
Dave Thompson
SILICON CHIP is published 12 times
a year by Silicon Chip Publications
Pty Ltd. ACN 003 205 490. ABN 49
003 205 490. All material is copyright ©. No part of this publication
may be reproduced without the written consent of the publisher.
Printing: Hannanprint, Noble Park,
Victoria.
Distribution: Network Distribution
Company.
Subscription rates: $97.50 per year
in Australia. For overseas rates, see
the order form in this issue.
Editorial office:
Unit 1, 234 Harbord Rd,
Brookvale, NSW 2100.
Postal address: PO Box 139,
Collaroy Beach, NSW 2097.
Phone (02) 9939 3295.
Fax (02) 9939 2648.
E-mail: silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
ISSN 1030-2662
Recommended and maximum price only.
2 Silicon Chip
Publisher’s Letter
What’s next on the automotive wish list?
Recent road trips have had me thinking about what
could be improved in modern cars, in terms of safety
and ease of driving. While features such as keyless entry
and starting, Bluetooth and USB connectivity and DVD
screens for the rear seat passengers undoubtedly have
their merits, they do little for road safety. Perhaps I
should qualify that; on a recent long trip with two rambunctious grandsons, I have to admit the DVDs were very
good for keeping them entertained (and blissfully quiet!).
Self-parking and adaptive cruise control, pedestrian
detect, collision avoidance and headlights which point around corners are all
good too, although most are rather expensive at the moment. They will undoubtedly become cheaper as they filter down to a wider range of cars. But none of
these really help with everyday ease of driving or road safety. Or if they do,
they are not along the lines that I am thinking.
What is the biggest problem with modern cars? All-round vision is the answer. All cars have their driver blind spots but modern cars seem to be getting
worse. The biggest offenders are so-called SUVs which seem to be very popular
with families; not because they can go off-road but because they are seen to be
rugged and supposedly offering greater safety in a collision. Well, if you equate
“heavy” with “rugged” then the bigger SUVs certainly fit into this category
but it does not necessarily mean greater safety in a collision, as evidenced by
ANSCAP ratings.
Paradoxically too, while SUVs are higher off the road than conventional
sedans, giving a better view of the road ahead, they are notoriously difficult
to see out of when parking. So much so that many SUVs now have optional
rear-view cameras – so that you can see what’s behind the vehicle! Part of this
problem though is because the rear window in so many of these vehicles is too
small. The stylists have sacrificed vision to styling. That complaint also applies
to many sedans and hatchbacks as well, with some having ludicrously small
rear windows and thick pillars. And of course, many cars also have heavily
tinted windows.
Which begs the question: if rear visibility on modern cars is so poor, why
aren’t rear-view cameras a standard feature? Taking the idea a bit further, why
not simply get rid of the rear view mirror altogether? They seldom give a full
view of the rear window which itself is often partly obscured by head rests
and assorted stuff on the parcel shelf. External rear view mirrors are also problematic, with those on the passenger’s side being convex and so giving a wider
but distorted view. And of course, external rear view mirrors must inevitably
increase the overall drag of the vehicle.
So why not dispense with rear view mirrors altogether and replace them with
three cameras? Carefully placed, they could eliminate all blind spots at the rear.
There would be other advantages as well. It would enable the rear window
and rear quarter windows to be eliminated. In hot climates like Australia this
would mean far less heat transmission (via glass). As well, since glass is heavy,
it could mean a reduction in weight while making the cabin stronger. Finally,
it would mean the end of that bane of night driving, being blasted by bright
headlights from the rear. I am assuming here that video processing of the camera
video signals would overcome overload problems.
In case the concept of a vehicle with no rear window seems too radical or
impractical, there are precedents. For a start, trucks don’t have rear windows
or if they do, they are obscured by the load. Second, some concept vehicles
have been produced with cameras and no rear window. While they may have
looked odd, the concept could certainly be made to work. What do you think?
Leo Simpson
siliconchip.com.au
SIOMAR
Battery Engineering
IRON PHOSPHATE
Lithium Iron Phosphate (LFP) is a special kind of rechargeable lithium battery that addresses the 4 major issues with current lithium
technologies: Safety, Life, Power, and Environmental Friendliness. The chemistry has similar charge requirements to lead acid
batteries and can therefore be more easily integrated into many lead acid applications than other chemistries.
SAFE
Lithium Iron Phosphate technology is an inherently safe battery chemistry "the safest lithium battery on the market" as shown
repeatedly by independent data generated by the Department of Energy, UL, UN, Sandia National Labs and other agencies. The cells
pass UN/DOT (UN38.3 transport safety testing) requirements with NO circuit board protection. This is not possible with traditional
lithium chemistries.
LONG LASTING
Traditional Li-ion chemistries already typically last 5 years or 500 charge / discharge cycles before the AH capacity tapers off to 80%
of what it was when the battery was new. This is a league above lead acid batteries which age dramatically with increasing
temperature and it is even better than NiCd and NiMH. Lithium iron phosphate is better still, achieving up to 2000 charge discharge
cycles.
POWERFUL
Cells can be optimized for long life, low or high temperature operation or high current without dramatically affecting service life. The
LFP300HPS (90AH) cell can deliver over 4,200 Amps. Lithium phosphate cells can now meet even the most demanding application
requirements — from starting a locomotive to powering an F1 racer, or cold starting a tractor at -20F.
CLEAN
Lithium Iron Phosphate can replace outdated battery chemistries like Lead-acid, NiCd, NiMH. They are designed to offer extremely
long cycle life, high energy capacity, outstanding power performance, and quick charge times, while simultaneously being
environmentally friendly.
These batteries use no harmful heavy metals and can be recycled. Use of phosphates in the system architecture reduces
environmental concerns in all stages of the battery’s life cycle. And given their long lasting nature, wearing one of these batteries out
takes a lot longer than most other batteries in the first place.
3.2V
50AH
3.2V
90AH
12V
10AH
24V
19AH
For more information, contact
SIOMAR BATTERY ENGINEERING
Phone (08) 9302 5444 or email mark<at>siomar.com
www.batterybook.com
Siomar Batteries design and custom make portable Power Solutions
siliconchip.com.au
June 2012 3
MAILBAG
Letters and emails should contain complete name, address and daytime phone number. Letters to
the Editor are submitted on the condition that Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd may edit and has the
right to reproduce in electronic form and communicate these letters. This also applies to submissions
to “Ask SILICON CHIP” and “Circuit Notebook”.
12V lighting in houses
must be properly designed
In the Mailbag pages of the April
2012 issue, Gordon Drennan asks if it’s
a crazy idea to disconnect the lighting
circuit from his home switchboard
and connect it to a 12V DC supply, to
run LED lights in place of the existing
230VAC lights. I think the idea borders
on crazy and should not be attempted.
I do agree with your comments regarding a 12V DC grid installation in
the house for powering not just lights
but also 12V appliances. Such a system
has been successfully incorporated
into caravans for at least 15 years
and there is no reason why it could
not work in homes. But it needs to be
properly designed with correctly rated
and protected cable and switches.
You can’t just shoe-horn it into your
existing house wiring without consequences.
I don’t believe that LED lighting
technology has yet become as cheap as
Gordon states. The Oatley Electronics
lights that he refers to sell for $6 each
and are a driver and LED kit which
would not be an effective replacement
LED replacement lamps
work well
I have recently moved about 80km
south of Sydney. The house was full
of 50W halogen down-lights and had
five halogen spot lights outside.
Wanting to combat rising power
bills (as does everyone else), I replac
ed most of the indoor lamps with
LED replacement globes; always
three are connected to a switchdimmer combination. About 50%
are GU10 230VAC while the rest
are MR16 12VAC/DC. The 230VAC
version works faultlessly with the
dimmer but the 12V lamps flickered.
Investigating this, I found three
different transformers were installed
and of course, these were not compatible with LED lamps.
I consulted various people includ4 Silicon Chip
for his room lights. LED globes which
may suit his requirements retail for
approximately $40 each.
SILICON CHIP comments that there
are two problems using existing wiring on 12V DC rather than 230VAC
– switch and wire corrosion and arcing/fusing of switches. I don’t entirely
agree with the solution given. A suitable DC circuit breaker would protect
against a short circuit but would not
prevent arcing and rapid destruction
of the AC-rated switches each time
they are turned on or off.
I can think of several more reasons
not to use the existing lighting circuit.
Lights aren’t the only items connected
to the lighting circuit. As well as lights
there could be ceiling fans, combined
exhaust/heat/light fans, dimmers, PIR
sensors and most importantly, hardwired smoke alarms. Upon disconnection of the lighting circuit from the
mains none of these will operate, with
possible disastrous effects in terms of
the smoke alarms.
Cable used in lighting circuits is
1mm2 or 1.5mm2 and they are usually
protected by a 10A circuit breaker.
ing the supplier of the LED lamps
in Sydney and operators of lighting
shops and was dismayed with the
lack of knowledge of LED lighting –
so much so that I replaced the 12V
versions with 230VAC versions and
did away with the transformers.
I now know that only transformers
especially designed for LED lamps
can be used. Why was I not told this
by all those experts who should be
on top of this subject? After all I can’t
be the only one wanting to reduce
power bills in older houses.
One lighting shop operator advised me not to install LED lamps
as a halogen 50W lamp only costs
about 50 cents to run per evening
(times about 12 lights in the living
room!). Another source said I need
a dimmer, switch, transformer and
These circuit breakers are selected to
match the current carrying capacity of
the cable used. This current carrying
restriction means that not very many
12V LED lamps could be wired into
each circuit. For a 10A circuit, you
could only have 120W of LED lighting.
Count the number of lights in your
home. Would this be enough?
Voltage drop is another factor to
be considered. The voltage dropped
by say 200+ metres of 1mm2/1.5mm2
cable from a 12V DC source would
be substantial and I doubt that there
would be sufficient voltage left to run
many LEDs.
Although I agree with the concept
I can’t agree with the proposed implementation. I hope no-one has attempted to try it.
David Anderson,
Pottsville, NSW.
Hearing aid
satisfaction
I would like to thank you for the
article “Australia Hears . . . And So Do
a driver to run LEDs. Everyone else
had not heard about drivers!
Another source of trouble I have
is radio reception. We are able to
receive Sydney stations like 2GB
and 2EA but with some interference. When any one of the dimmercontrolled lights is turned on, the
interference makes it impossible to
receive radio, except the local ABC
station. No-one has any suggestions
of how to overcome this interference
problem.
Would it be possible for SILICON
CHIP to run a detailed article on
LED conversions? It would make it
easier to comprehend the complexities and the costing before one starts
purchasing parts.
Hans Moll,
Bowral, NSW.
siliconchip.com.au
Excessive sound levels in cinemas is
unfortunate for the non-deaf
I totally agree that there is no need
I” in the July 2011 issue. I have a hearfor the sound level in cinemas to be
ing loss due to industrial deafness. It
as loud as it is. I think that part of
did not meet the 10% or greater loss as
the problem is that management is
defined by Workcover but was enough
catering for generation “Y” which,
that my wife would complain about
as we are all aware, are suffering
the volume of the TV or radio. Also, I
significant hearing loss from all that
had problems talking to people, even
“pubic enema” they call music. They
one on one where I needed them to
have impaired their brain function
repeat things.
by having it constantly pumping
Your article inspired me to purdirectly into their ears via powerchase a pair of LOF hearing aids and
ful MP3 players and high-powered
the programming software aids from
car stereos.
Blamey & Saunders Hearing, which
Unfortunately for the rest of us
has been one on the best investments
whose hearing may have survived
I have made. I ordered the hearing
aids around 6pm on the Friday and
the hearing aids arrived the following
Tuesday morning, fully programmed people talking and found them to
with my audiogram. So I was wearing function very well.
them as soon as the box was opened
One notable time was recently when
and batteries installed.
meeting a friend in a retirement vilAfter installing the software on a lage, where they have happy hour. I
computer I did go through the normali- commented that not many people were
sation part of the program to set up the wearing hearing aids as I could only
hearing aids to my comfort levels but see one person in the crowd of around
that was all that was required. Since 40. My mate said that a lot of them do
Assure
Connect
ad 11 Mayaids,
12 14/5/12
10:19 AM
1 hearing aids but don’t wear them
having
the hearing
I’ve been
in Page
have
C
Mdon’t
Y
CM
MY CY
crowded environments with lots of to this sort of event as they
help,
siliconchip.com.au
pre-OHS days, cinema volume can
be intolerable. I do not know why
there has not been the forethought
to install compressor/limiters in the
signal path to compress the dynamic
range, like we did when I was mixing
for bands in the 1980s.
I can only surmise that high-powered amplifiers and matching speakers are so affordable now that they
feel that any sort of compression is
not necessary. As well as blowing
people out of their seats, they may
think it might be an essential “part
of the cinema experience”.
Greg Johnson,
via email.
as all the noises are amplified. I had no
such problem even talking to people a
few metres away.
The only problem I’ve had is forgetting to take them out before having a
shower but I am now getting into a
routine; this shows how comfortable
they are to wear. The water has not
caused any problems, the free water
was wiped off and then the hearing
CMY
aidsKput into the drying jar overnight,
June 2012 5
Mailbag: continued
Helping to put you in Control
Control Equipment
Industrial Serial Server
The GW51C is a gateway for Ethernet (TCP/
IP) and RS232/RS485/
RS422 serial communications. It allows almost
any serial device to be connected to a
new or existing Ethernet network.
ATO-110 $199+GST
Heavy Duty Relay Card
Fitted with 2 20A relays
this card can be configured to switch a DC motor between forward-stopreverse.
KTA-272 $49.00+GST
LeoStick Arduino
The LeoStick is designed to be functionally
similar to the upcoming
Arduino Leonardo
Plugs into the USB of your PC
FRA-016 $27.25+GST
Wet/Dry Thermometer
Probe. Fitted with
PT100 sensors these
probes can measure
humidity and temperature in high humidity situations.
CMS-121 $299+GST
Industrial Flashing Light Tower
Flashing LED multi-level signal light
has Red, Yellow, Green lights and a
Buzzer. Powered from 24VDC the
lights flash at approximately 1Hz.
HEL-022 $64.95+GST
Tachometer/Line
Speed/Frequency
Meter This 5 digit
meter has a 4-20mA
output signal and RS485 Modbus communications. 24VDC or
230VAC powered
ALT-080 $249.00+GST
Trip Alarm A programmable
controller with a 0-10V/420mA input, a 3 digit display
and 2 relays providing on/off
control/alarm with or without
pulse mode. Use it to control
tank levels, pressures etc.
CMC-020 $149.00+GST
Contact Ocean Controls
Ph: 03 9782 5882
www.oceancontrols.com.au
6 Silicon Chip
Economics of
solar power
I would like to comment on the
economics of installing solar panels,
from the perspective of a user. Five
years ago, I installed a 1kW solar
system which cost $12,000. The
government chipped in $8000 so the
system cost to me was $4000. I live in
Melbourne and have a north-facing
roof. Each year it generates 1200kWh
of power. Over the last two years I
expanded the system to 3kW total at
an additional expense of $4000, so
I now generate 3600kWh per year.
As I use about 3600kWh per year,
I am now energy-neutral. However,
since I only generate during daylight
hours, 66% of the power I generate
(2400kWh/year) is returned to the
grid. Origin Energy are currently my
supplier and offer a premium feed-in
tariff of $0.66/kWh which is worth
$1600 per year. The remaining 33%
that I generate (1200kWh) saves me
the $0.32/kWh I pay for power.
This is worth $384 so the total
saving is nearly $2000 per year. Thus
the payback period for my $8000
expense is around four years. Last
month, I got a $620 refund cheque
for the nine months’ generation.
The cost of solar panels has
dropped from $5 per watt in 2008 to
around $1 per watt today. You can
now buy a 3kW system for $4500
installed. The tariff for power fed
back to the grid (FIT) varies from
state to state but is now lower than
the my “Premium FIT” rate. It varies from $0.33/kWh nett in Victoria
which has a bag of desiccant beads
(supplied with the initial purchase of
the hearing aids).
The only maintenance that needs
to be done is to change the batteries
(which last just over 1½ weeks) and
clean wax from the tubes every now
and then. My experience has motivated
me to send this note, as I would recommend these hearing aids to others with
hearing loss. I don’t believe you could
get a better hearing aid set at any price.
Ralph Burrow,
Werribee, Vic.
to $0.20/kWh gross in NSW (gross
is for total solar power generated).
Nett power is calculated on an
instantaneous basis so during the
day you are credited whenever you
generate more than you use; nett is
not affected by power used at night.
Many power supply distributors
insist on solar-enabled houses being
on “Time Of Use” metering which
has a high rate ($0.27/kWh) during
the day and a low rate ($0.11/kWh)
at night and weekends. Others offer
fixed rate tariffs (eg, $0.20/kWh). I
have calculated my bill using either
scheme and both systems make
similar returns due mainly to low
“Time Of Use” rates all weekend.
A 3kW system using my usage
profile in Victoria with 3600kWh
gross generation (2400kWh nett +
1200kWh excess) returns $792 +
$324 = $1116 per year. The payback
period is about four years.
With the introduction of the Carbon Tax in July, the cost of electricity will increase significantly so the
payback period will be even shorter.
To future-proof yourself, I recommend that you install enough solar
power to cover your usage.
To calculate size: in Victoria,
divide yearly consumption in kWh
by 1.2 to get the total system size
in watts. In SA and NSW, divide
yearly consumption by 1.3 and for
Queensland divide it by 1.5. System
size is typically 3kW in Victoria and
2.5kW in Queensland.
Peter Kay,
Dromana, Vic.
Motor Speed Controller is now
main-stream technology
Firstly, let me congratulate SILICON
CHIP on the Induction Motor Speed
Controller project (April & May 2012).
This is now certainly a main-stream
technology.
I thought I’d share with you and
your readers some of my experiences
with IM (induction motor) drives for
electric cars (EVs) over the past 40+
years. Developing a fascination for EVs
in the 1960s, I managed to scrounge
(from a disused electric milk-cart) a
siliconchip.com.au
Now Available
DC motor and various other bits that I
put in place of the engine and gearbox
in a small car. Using “dead” batteries
from the local garage, I managed to get
enough range to drive a few kilometres.
That was enough to whet my appetite and I set about thinking how
the resistance-controlled drive system
could be improved. Certainly, DC
choppers were beginning to be talked
about but the idea of using a lighter
and much cheaper squirrel-cage induction motor was appealing. But
how do you drive an IM from a battery
(DC)? Nobody I spoke with in the motor industry had much of a clue then.
However, academic papers describing
the principles of inverter-fed IM drives
were beginning to appear in the USA
and Europe.
The silicon controlled rectifier (SCR)
had only been invented some 10 years
before but was now becoming available
with a high enough power rating for
an EV IM drive. Getting the circuitry
working for the forced commutation
system required by the SCRs required a
bit of trial and error but eventually the
system worked well enough to drive a
converted vehicle that was registered
for road use and used for commuting
between Newport and Manly (Sydney
suburbs) for a time.
The next phase involved fitting a
Bedford delivery van with an IM drive
at the Tasmanian College of Advanced
Education in the late 1970s. There
were no transistors available at that
time to handle the power required
(250V, 400A), so the only practical
option was to use force-commutated
SCRs again. The drive waveforms
were provided by a Motorola 6800
microprocessor taking inputs from
accelerator and brake pedals, forward/
reverse selector and various other
sources. Having to program in machine language was rather laborious,
particularly for calculations such as
a maths division routine to calculate
the varying voltage/frequency relationship required for optimum motor
performance.
At the end of my time in Tasmania
in 1979, I drove the vehicle from
Hobart to Sydney, a road distance of
some 1200km. With the aid of a trailermounted generating system providing
6kW, a daily range of up to 200km was
achieved. Stops at about this interval
siliconchip.com.au
were made at motels where the batteries were charged overnight.
The last stage of my work in IM
drives took place at Sydney University during the 1990s. By this time,
high-powered IGBTs (400V, 400A)
had become available. Microcontroller
development had also moved forward
and a controller from the Intel 8096
series seemed to be a good choice.
Programming was much easier, this
time in assembly language that for a
maths divide routine, for example, a
command div x, y replaced more than
60 machine code instructions used
earlier in the Motorola 6800.
The drive was fitted to a Holden
Rodeo that was used for several years
as a general runabout vehicle. Road
performance was quite adequate
for general city/suburban driving,
speeds of over 80km/h being readily
achievable. Although limited by the
use of lead-acid batteries but helped
by regenerative braking, a working
range of some 75km was achieved on
one charge. With its on-board battery
charger the vehicle could be plugged
into a standard 240VAC outlet whenever parked so a daily working range
of well over 100km could be achieved.
It’s satisfying to see that quite a
number of EVs being produced today
by the automotive industry are using
induction, or more recently, “brushless DC” motors supplied by inverters,
basically of the same type but now
making use of the latest technology
of integrated power circuits and advanced microcontrollers.
I congratulate Andrew Levido for his
achievement and his lucid description
of the IM and its characteristics. The
design looks so simple and elegant
from a hardware point of view, with
all the complexity embodied in the
microcontroller software. For some
time I’ve thought of building a controller for my 3-phase lathe motor and
getting acquainted with the PIC family
of microcontrollers. This project will
allow me to achieve both.
David Gosden,
Bundeena, NSW.
Induction Motor Controller
needs braking for lathes
I read with great interest the article
on the 1.5kW Induction Motor Speed
Controller. I have been an avid reader
Electrostatic Speaker Panel
Evaluation Kit (ESLK-440) from
With over 70 years combined experience in ELS
design and manufacture, we are able to bring
you the spectacularly high quality of
electrostatic sound, for the first time
reproducible in volume at low cost, and only
8mm thick!
This kit is suitable for DIY speakers or for use in
consumer electronics products Suggested applications include hi-fi, home theatre
or integration with flat-panel televisions.
This kit includes 2 of
our framed, high
quality 5th-generation
electrostatic panels
with stands and all the
driving requirements cables, power supplies
and transformers.
Supplied in a padded
carry case.
$495 including GST and 12 Month warranty.
Speaker Panels are available OEM for consumer
electronics development - we can work with you to create
custom sizes to suit your application - call us for details.
Reality Technologies
PH: 03 8581-7638
www.reality-design.com.au
ER Audio
PH: 08 9397-6212
www.eraudio.com.au
DYNE
INDUSTRIES PTY LTD
Now manufacturing the
original ILP Unirange
Toroidal Transformer
- In stock from 15VA to 1000VA
- Virtually anything made to order!
- Transformers and Chokes
with Ferrite, Powdered Iron
GOSS and Metglas cores
- Current & Potential Transformers
DYNE Industries Pty Ltd
Ph: (03) 9720 7233 Fax: (03) 9720 7551
email: sales<at>dyne.com.au
web: www.dyne.com.au
June 2012 7
Mailbag: continued
What was the benefit of
banning incandescent lamps?
Having a need for a couple of highpower motor controllers, I burrowed
my way back to the April 2007 edition of SILICON CHIP and found the
article I wanted. I also happened
to re-read the Publisher’s Letter
entitled, “Banning incandescent
lamps will have a negligible effect
on greenhouse gasses”.
Having had five years of this nonsense now, I wonder if the Government could tell us exactly how
much “greenhouse gas” has been
saved on the planet as a whole but
more importantly, tell us how much
of this magazine since 1990 and was
very pleased to finally see this project
in SILICON CHIP. Well done! However I
must raise a few points on its intended
use. While I’m sure the most likely use
for this controller will be dedicated
use on pool pumps and the like, I do
wonder about its suitability for use
on all but the very smallest workshop
machinery. As a fitter and turner by
trade I have just gone through the
exercise of fitting my own machines
with 3-phase motors and commercial
VFDs and would like to share some of
the pitfalls I encountered.
Typically, lathes and milling machines present the motor with a large
inertial load; lathes especially. In order
not to trip the unit out in an overvoltage or over-current fault, the VFD
must be programmed for a very slow
mercury has been bulldozed into
landfill sites when the fluorescent
“dead” ones have been thrown out
and not recycled.
I guess it goes to prove that the
Liberals were just as idiotic as Labor
in the “global warming” – sorry,
“climate change” – scare-mongering.
The only up-side to the Carbon Tax
that is going to save the world (the
one we were promised we would
never have under this Government),
is that it should ensure the total
demise of Labor at the next federal
election.
John Brown
Bibra Lake, WA.
start-up and ramp down time. However quite often it is desirable to start,
and in particular, to stop the machine
as quickly as possible. If allowed to
trip out on over-voltage during a ramp
down, the machine can run on for tens
of seconds if there is no mechanical
brake. This is particularly important
in an emergency situation where the
machine needs to be brought to a halt
as quickly as possible.
Aside from the safety standpoint
there are a few machining operations
that require the machine to be brought
to a halt (and often then put into reverse) as quickly as possible. The main
one being the threading operation
and in particular when cutting metric
threads on a machine fitted with an
Imperial lead screw (or vice versa), as
in this situation the half nuts cannot be
disengaged at the end of a cut.
This is a particular problem with
small machines fitted with singlephase induction motors as even when
switched directly into reverse, they
will continue to spin in the same
direction!
The solution to this problem is of
course a 3-phase motor and a VFD
fitted with dynamic motor braking.
As you would know, dynamic motor braking involves using a large
suitably-rated braking resistor which
is switched into the DC bus during an
over voltage event to dissipate the inertial energy supplied from the motor.
This allows the VFD to ramp down in
speed much faster and still avoid an
over voltage fault.
In my experience, a VFD that is not
fitted with dynamic braking is pretty
much useless on lathes and to a lesser
extent on mills. Without dynamic
braking, a large load in a heavy 4-jaw
chuck of a lathe going at 1000 RPM
will often trip a VFD into over-voltage
during ramp down, even with a long
ramp down time.
Does the designer have any plans to
include dynamic braking into this or
perhaps a follow-up design?
Lee Trengove,
Carina, Qld.
Comment: as you say, the main attraction for the Induction Motor Speed
Controller will be with pool pumps.
Braking could be incorporated but it
would essentially mean a new design.
Depending on the success of this
published design, we may consider
a design with braking in the future.
However, it will inevitably be more
expensive.
Your Reliable Partner in the Electronics Lab
ab
LPKF ProtoMat E33 – small, accurate, affordable
Hardly larger than a DIN A3 sheet: The budget choice for milling, drilling and
depaneling of PCBs or engraving of front panels – in LPKF quality.
www.lpkf.com/prototyping
Embedded Logic Solutions Pty. Ltd. Ph. +61 (2) 9687 1880
8 Silicon Chip
Email. sales<at>emlogic.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
Induction Motor Speed Controller
peak current concern
It was with more than a little interest that I have read your first article
on the 1.5kW Induction Motor Speed
Controller project (April 2012). As I
have only seen the first part of this
design, I am hesitant to make the following comments. However, some
fundamentals are apparent and beg
closer scrutiny. You state that the
circuit is rated for a maximum output
of 8.5A. That rating is well within the
capabilities of the ST power bridge.
However, your input circuit seems
inadequate for this role.
The mains input is rectified and fed
into three paralleled 470µF capacitors.
With this arrangement, where the
capacitors feed an output of 8.5A to
the load, the input currents become
rather complex, as the capacitors are
only charged near the peak of every
sinewave. Indeed, you cover this very
subject in your article on page 36 of
the same issue.
Accurate calculations are impossible without additional data. However,
siliconchip.com.au
Loud sound in
cinemas & theatres
In regards to the Publisher’s Letter
on loud sound in cinemas and theatres (March 2012), I thought I would
just make a comment from the point
of view of a sound engineer.
I have actually been to “Love Never Dies” and I was with the sound
crew for two performances. One
thing not many people realise is that,
although the sound engineer is the
one running the show, all the levels
are pre-recorded and all decisions on
level are made by the director, sound
designer and producer. So it is not so
simple as “turning it down”.
I find it interesting that Leo found
“Love Never Dies” loud, as I found it
to be quite reasonable, only getting
loud for effect.
In regards to noise limits, I know
“back of envelope” estimates point
to mains input currents of about 35A
peak and 14A RMS. Thus the 230VAC
input wiring must handle a minimum
that the venue and the sound department regularly check the sound
pressure levels in a number of areas.
What you find is that although the
music may peak at 90-95dB, when
it is just speech it probably sits at
around 75-80dB. As such, the average exposure is below that which is
required to be adhered to.
Having said that, on other shows
(such as Rock Of Ages) it is not uncommon for the level to go above
100dB.
Gerard Hook,
Box Hill North, Vic.
Leo Simpson comments: your reaction to the sound level in that show
as being quite reasonable reinforces
my view that sound engineers have
become de-sensitised. It certainly
did get loud, whether or not “for
effect”.
of 14A RMS/35A peak, as do the rectifiers, input fuse, thermistor, EMI filter
etc. Yet your input fuse is rated at 10A
and you specify a maximum input cur-
June 2012 9
Mailbag: continued
Noise exposure
should be displayed
It amazes me that in this day and
age when hearing experts are completely aware of the sound volume
and exposure durations that cause
hearing loss that there are not strict
controls over exposure times. Maybe
it’s the anti “nanny state” idea but
surely it should be fairly simple to
create an “RDI” (recommended daily
intake) and require devices and venues that “create” sound to publish
their adherence to these guidelines.
Theatres, live shows and other
“fixed duration” type environments
should be required to note the RDI
percentage of sound exposure. “Variable duration” environments should
be required to display an RDI percentage over, say, a 4-hour period.
Devices such as iPods and the like
should have the estimated hours of
exposure displayed as the volume
setting is adjusted and then the
device should monitor the actual
sound level and continuously update
the percentage of RDI used on the
display. There’s nothing new or com-
rent of 8.7A. This is one reason that
quality commercial products in this
power range will invariably include
an input PFC stage.
There are additional consequences
plicated here; most devices already
have the necessary hardware, they
just need the software.
In my view, once 100% is reached
the devices should simply turn off
until the 24 hours is up. In reality,
such “looking after our own good
health” features are not available
already, probably, because (a) if the
device didn’t turn off at 100% the
manufacturer would open themselves up to lawsuits and (b) if it did,
no-one would buy their product.
Once everyone was required to
publish the RDI they expose their
patrons to, they would probably also
quickly adjust their volume controls.
A table of volume versus level and
exposure risk can be found at http://
www.etymotic.com/technology/ihp.
html
Note that this table is weekly; not
daily. It makes sobering reading as
I find the recommended exposure
levels to be considerably lower than
what we normally experience in any
“event” environment. I leave you
with this as an “answer” to those who
try to lay any of the blame on “sound
to this. The DC voltage at the 470µF
capacitors will include significant
ripple. With the values shown, this
ripple will be somewhere near 30V
peak-peak at 100Hz. This ripple will
Presensitized PCB
& associated products
engineers” (from http://www.digitalrecordings.com/publ/pubear.html).
There are common misconceptions about “sound engineers” and
sound reinforcement. The assumptions are they know what they are
doing when adjusting sound and
they adjust to safe levels. Both are
not true.
Most so-called “sound engineers”
(about 99%) have no formal training
in acoustics and sound reinforcement. The operation of sound systems does not require any licence
or qualifying exam, yet the operators
are in control of a potentially very
damaging form of energy.
Most sound engineers (about
99%) don’t use sound level meters to
measure intensity. Instead they judge
the sound level “by ear”; an inexact
procedure even if we assumed they
had no hearing loss. Research in Halifax night spots showed in 1986 that
a risk of hearing loss for patrons was
present in 64% of all tested locales
during one hour of exposure and
in 95% during four or more hours
of exposure (a typical evening at a
night club lasts four hours).
Mark Eynden,
Mount Waverley, Vic.
ultimately be transferred to the output, resulting in a significant 100Hz
modulation of the motor current; not
good for the motor!
Additionally, we must also consider
IN STOCK NOW!
•Single Sided Presensitized PCBs
•Double Sided Presensitized PCBs
•Fibreglass & Phenolic
•UV Light Boxes
•DP50 Developer
•PCB Etch Tanks, Heaters & Aerator Pumps
•Thermometers
•Ammonium Persulphate Etchant
•PCB Drill Bits (HSS & Tungsten)
For full range, pricing and to buy now online, visit
38 Years Quality Service
10 Silicon Chip
www.wiltronics.com.au
Ph: (03) 5334 2513
Email: sales<at>wiltronics.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
the effect of all the AC currents on
the 470µF capacitors. They will bear
the brunt of it all. Again, there is insufficient data for accurate numbers
but a good estimate (under full load
conditions) for the total capacitor
ripple current is 16A RMS. Perusal of
industrial grade capacitor data reveals
that this number is likely to exceed
their maximum ratings.
Lastly, I don’t think the power supply
authorities will be impressed to find
that this sort of equipment is connected
to their grid, again for the reasons you
state in your article on page 36. As an
engineer with several decades’ experience in the design of power electronic
equipment, I simply wanted to bring
these issues to your notice.
Name & address supplied
but withheld.
Comment: your back of the envelope
calculations don’t add up. If it was
true that the unit pulled 14A RMS
from the 230VAC mains then the input
power would be around 3kW and the
efficiency would be around 50%, with
at least 1.5kW being dissipated in the
box when driving a 1.5kW load. The
case would melt!
You are possibly making a mistake
in assuming that the 8.5A RMS maximum single phase load current means
that the unit is supplying 2kW. It is not;
the maximum power output is 1.5kW
(you have to allow for the power factor
of the motor load). Nor is there a large
100Hz component across the motor,
as can be seen from the scope grab on
page 20 of the article.
As for the power authorities, they
may well be unhappy but the article
on pages 36-37 of the same issue indicates that it is a widespread problem
with switchmode power supplies being
ubiquitous.
The designer, Andrew Levido,
has made additional comments, as
follows: a typical single-phase 1.5kW
(shaft power) motor draws around 8A
at 240V AC, about 1800W (ie, about
80% efficiency and allowing for power
factor). Ignoring losses for a moment,
at an electrical output power of 1.8kW
and 240VAC mains, the average DC
bus current will be 1800 ÷ (√2 x 240) =
5.3A, and the RMS input current will
be 1800 ÷ 240 = 7.5A (I’m not sure how
the reader got to 14A).
Since RMS is defined in term of power, it is independent of wave shape,
so 7.5A RMS is 7.5A RMS whatever
the shape.
Certainly the input current will be
peaky – with the peaks limited by
the mains source impedance (very
low), the in-rush limiter (about 0.1Ω
at this current), the input filter (“less
than 0.1Ω” according to the data),
the capacitor ESR (0.423Ω each, so
0.14Ω for three in parallel) and any
stray series impedance in the circuit
wiring. This is fairly typical for a large
SMPS or UPS although the electricity
authorities don’t like it much, as you
suggest. If the reader is really worried,
then a suitably-rated input inductor
could be used.
Adding about 50W of losses increases the line current by 200mA and
the DC current by less than 140mA,
not substantively changing the above
picture. There will be a significant
component of 100Hz ripple on the
DC link, which will produce a ripple
current in the capacitors, which are
each rated for 1.99A RMS. With three
capacitors in parallel we have a ripple
current capability 6A.
Note that there will be a component
of ripple current in the capacitors
related to the output current as well.
My calculations suggest that at the
absolute worst case (when input and
output frequencies are matched but
out-of-phase by 90°) the ripple current
will be 4A RMS and a typical value
will be closer to 3A RMS. That said,
these capacitors have a stated life of
2000 hours and so won’t last forever
whatever we do.
The motor may see a small 100Hz
ripple component superimposed on
the nominal frequency but I disagree
with the reader’s statement that this is
“not good for the motor!”. I imagine
this might produce a very small torque
ripple (after the filtering effect of the
rotor’s inertia) but I can’t see how this
could damage the motor in any way.
SC
This is an AC motor after all.
Australia’s Lowest Priced DSOs
Shop
On-Line
at
emona.com.au
Now you’ve got no excuse ... update your old analogue scopes!
Whether you’re a hobbyist, TAFE/University, workshop or service
technician, the Rigol DS-1000E guarantee Australia’s best price.
RIGOL DS-1052E 50MHz
RIGOL DS-1102E 100MHz
50MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch
1GS/s Real Time Sampling
512k Memory Per Channel
USB Device & Host Support
100MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch
1GS/s Real Time Sampling
512k Memory Per Channel
USB Device & Host Support
ONLY $
Sydney
Melbourne
Tel 02 9519 3933
Tel 03 9889 0427
Fax 02 9550 1378
Fax 03 9889 0715
email testinst<at>emona.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
Brisbane
Tel 07 3275 2183
Fax 07 3275 2196
362
Adelaide
Tel 08 8363 5733
Fax 08 8363 5799
inc GST
Perth
ONLY $
Tel 08 9361 4200
Fax 08 9361 4300
web www.emona.com.au
439
inc GST
EMONA
June 2012 11
Microcontrollers:
feature-laden, fast and furious
The microcontroller scene is certainly on the boil, with a host of new
products competing for the lowest power consumption, best performance and
best value. Here is a brief look at what’s new in the microcontroller world,
some already available and some soon to be released...
E
lsewhere in this issue we present the second and few analog input pins (or in some cases, none) and maybe
final instalment of our PIC/AVR Microcontroller two or three basic PWM outputs.
Newer chips can have a dozen or more analog inputs,
Programming Adaptor board, which allows the user
to program over 450 different types of microcontroller from some with built-in programmable gain amplifiers, six or
more PWM outputs with advanced modes designed to drive
Microchip and Atmel.
That seems like a lot – how many more microcontrollers brushless motors and Mosfet bridges, configurable serial
buses capable of high speed operation and so on.
can there be than that?
One good example is the dsPIC33E/PIC24E series. These
Actually, 450 is only a drop in the bucket. At one major
supplier, we counted over 20,000 different micro types are more or less compatible with dsPIC33Fs/PIC24Fs, which
we have occasionally used in the past.
presently available!
But they are substantially more powerful, running at two
Some of these are the same chip in a different package
(DIP, SMD etc) but even when you take that into account, or three times the speed and with more advanced peripherthere are still thousands of different microcontrollers from als as standard. We’ll take a look at these later in this article.
scores of suppliers.
Even among the types that our readers will be familiar Benefits
Having said all that, even a bog- standard micro lets us do
with, such as PICs, there has been very significant progress
things that would be much harder with discrete logic chips.
over the last few years.
Prices have dropped, processing power has increased Virtually any digital circuit can be built using discrete logic
and the integrated peripherals have been substantially but the cost and complexity can quickly become prohibitive
for all but the most simple tasks.
enhanced.
by NICHOLAS VINEN
Consider what you get when you buy
Until recently, most micros had just a
12 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
Microcontrollers vs Microprocessors
the cheapest microcontrollers, which may be just a couple
of dollars: you get thousands of logic gates whose function
can be reconfigured virtually at will.
You also get dozens of digital input buffers and output
transistors and usually a 10-bit or 12-bit ADC with input
multiplexer, several configurable PWM generators plus
some serial interfaces and other goodies.
Not only is the resulting hardware a lot easier to design
but fixing a bug in software can be a lot easier than fixing
hardware errors; much easier to fix a few lines of code than
do a re-design of a PCB, get a new prototype, assemble and
test – and hope like crazy it behaves as it’s supposed to!
One example of a recent project which would have been
prohibitive without a microcontroller is the 1.5kW Induction Motor Speed Controller (SILICON CHIP, April-May 2012).
This uses a dsPIC33 chip designed for motor control. It
can generate three in-phase centre-aligned PWM signals
with glitch-free updates. The micro also manages the motor
speed so that it varies smoothly, synthesises the sinewaves
with which to drive the motor windings, monitors the
circuit for faults and so on.
Another example is the Maximite microcomputer, which
demonstrates how much the line between microcontrollers
and microprocessors has become blurred (see panel).
This small computer connects to a keyboard and VGA
monitor, uses a memory card for storage and can be programmed using BASIC. It’s based on a PIC32 microcontroller
which has surprisingly good performance for a relatively
cheap chip, at around 125MIPS (million instructions per
second).
Also in this issue is the first part of our new Wideband
Oxygen Sensor Controller. One of the many changes compared to the last incarnation is that we are now using the
PIC16F1507, a new part from a long-running series.
While its CPU core is much the same as other PIC16s, it
has more ADC channels (12), a built-in voltage reference
with three selectable levels, four PWM modules, two Configurable Logic Cell modules (which can replace external
digital logic ICs), a Numerically Controlled Oscillator (NCO)
and a Complementary Waveform Generator (CWG).
All these features make the new Wideband Oxygen
Controller simpler but more capable.
Of course, we tend to stick with tried-and-true chips
when they suit the task at hand. One of the main benefits of
commonly used chips is their wide availability. But in some
cases, the application calls for a newer, more advanced IC.
Overleaf, we examine some of the newer and more interesting microcontrollers on the market.
siliconchip.com.au
So just what is the difference between a microprocessor
(as found in a computer) and a microcontroller? These
days, not much.
The main difference is that microcontrollers generally
require less support circuitry, making them more convenient for use in embedded designs.
By contrast, a microprocessor usually needs to be
connected to RAM (random access memory) and ROM
(read-only memory) chips. The RAM is used as working
space storage while the ROM provides the initial instructions for the processor.
Microprocessors also tend to have fairly strict supply
voltage requirements to work reliably at their rated speed
and they are usually designed to interface with other
complex ICs which handle their input/output needs and
provide for connection to a keyboard, mouse, monitor,
network and so on.
By comparison, the majority of microcontrollers these
days have internal RAM and flash memory for instructions.
This reduces cost and also dramatically reduces the
number of pins required and hence the size and cost of
the IC package. It saves on PCB space and avoids the need
to route dozens or even hundreds of memory bus tracks.
Microcontrollers usually can run from a wide range of
supply voltages, eg, 2.7-5.5V so they can run direct from
a battery or a variety of different power supplies. Some
will run from 1.8V or less while a few are designed to run
off 12V or more, so that they can powered from multi-cell
batteries without the need for a regulator.
Unlike most microprocessors, a microcontroller has a
fair bit of on-board “peripheral” circuitry such as analogto-digital converters, PWM (pulse width modulation)
outputs, USB and in some cases Ethernet, allowing it
to interface to other circuitry without the need for many
additional ICs.
Microprocessor peripherals are usually limited to serial/parallel data communication with other digital ICs.
Having said all that, there is increasing convergence
between microcontrollers and microprocessors.
The most powerful microcontrollers, such as those
used in MP3/MP4 players, smart phones and so on, can
run at 1GHz or more, access large amounts of RAM, have
graphics acceleration features and so on.
In fact, they are more capable than the microprocessors
that were available not much more than ten years ago.
On the other hand, computer microprocessors have
started to branch out into the same space.
For example, there is the Intel Atom and the AMD
G-series of microprocessors. Both are derived from
mainstream CPUs (central processing units) and both
offer low power consumption and a high level of system
integration. For instance, they have on-board graphics
controllers and memory controllers. They also come in
smaller, thinner packages than traditional CPUs, for use
in portable electronic devices.
With the popularity of smart phones and portable media
players, expect to see more improvements in microcontroller performance and features over the next few years.
June 2012 13
ARM Cortex-M0
ARM Cortex-M4
This is latest addition
to the 32-bit
ARM line-up
of microcontroller cores. It
is notable for
especially low
power consution figures
combined with
good performance.
Core power
consumption
is just 32µW
per MHz for chips built on a
90nm silicon process, with a
1.2V core supply (peripherals
consume additional power).
The Cortex-M0 has an optional single-cycle 32-bit multiplier and
runs up to 50MHz, with a performance of 42 Dhrystone MIPS at
full speed.
The Cortex-M0 was introduced following the more powerful M3
series and at around the same time as the M4 series. These all use
the “THUMB-2” instruction set which mixes 16-bit and 32-bit instructions for improved code density, compared to the original ARM
instruction set which is 32-bit only. The M0 supports a subset of
THUMB/THUMB-2 to keep the core small and minimise power usage.
ARM do not manufacture the chips; they license the design to
manufacturers. Chips based on the Cortex-M0 are currently available
from NXP (LPC11xx and LPC12xx), ST Microelectronics (STM32M0
and upcoming STM32F0 series), Energy Micro (EFM32 ZG-series)
and Nuvoton Tech (NuMicro series). These are all SMDs (surface
mount devices).
The Cortex-M0+ is the same as Cortex-M0 but its pipeline has
two stages rather than three, which reduces branch penalties. Chips
based on this core will be made by NXP and Freescale Semiconductor (Kinetis L series).
Since these chips use the same instruction set as a large number
of existing 32-bit microcontrollers, there are already many suitable
compilers, debuggers and development environments. In fact, code
written for Cortex-M0 processors will run on Cortex-M3 and CortexM4 processors without modification.
Readers interested in getting into Cortex-M0 programming might
want to try the NXP LPC11U24 Cortex-M0 “mbed” embedded development board from RS components (see photo).
This has an on-board power supply and USB programming port.
It breaks the SMD chip’s pins
out to pin headers, suitable for
use with breadboards and
protoboards.
Another option is the
LPC1114 Cortex M0 Stamp
board. Available for around 18
Euros, this small breakout board
has an NXP chip with 32KB flash,
8KB RAM, an 8-channel 10-bit ADC and
a USB serial port. Its I/Os are broken out
to a pair of pin headers and it also has a USB
bootloader and on-board power supply.
The Cortex M4 is at the other end of the spectrum from the M0
and includes everything but the kitchen sink. The M4s include a
single-precision floating point unit (FPU) with some DSP instructions,
including 8-bit and 16-bit SIMD (single instruction, multiple data),
multiply-accumulate instructions and a hardware divide unit. They
also include a memory protection unit (MPU).
The result is around 1.25DMIPS/MHz and with speeds up to about
160MHz, M4s are capable of 200MIPS+ and can typically handle
supply voltages anywhere between 1.8V and 3.3V.
In keeping with the core, Cortex M4s also typically have a rich set
of peripherals. One of the best examples is the STMicro STM32F4
series. These are available in 64-176 pin SMD packages and include
12 timers with around 40 PWM channels, up to 1MB of flash memory
and 192KB of RAM, up to 24 analog-to-digital converter inputs, two
digital-to-analog converter (DAC) outputs, hi-speed USB On The
Go (OTG), 100Mbit Ethernet, multiple serial controllers and so on.
These are among the most powerful microcontrollers available
which do not require external flash or RAM. In fact they only need
a handful of bypass capacitors and little else. Other useful features
include a built-in random number generator, hardware checksum
calculation unit and a digital camera interface which can handle data
rates up to 54Mbites/s.
The STM32F4 Discovery evaluation board is available at a
surprisingly modest price – around $20-25.00 This has a 100-pin
microcontroller (1MB flash), USB programmer, power supply, 3-axis
digital accelerometer, microphone, audio DAC, class D amplifier and
USB OTG connector plus some pushbuttons and LEDs. All the spare
I/O pins are broken out to one of two 50-pin headers along with the
power supply pins.
Cortex M4 microcontrollers are
also available from
NXP (LPC43xx-series), Texas Instruments (LX4-series),
Freescale Semiconductor (Kinetis M
and P-series) and
Energy Micro (EFM32
L-series). Of these,
the Freescale Semiconductor parts are
notable for their
high-precision 16bit ADCs.
14 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
Microchip dsPIC33E & PIC24E
Microchip recently added two new, related series of 16-bit processors to their microcontroller line-up: the dsPIC33E and PIC24E
series. In the past, while the PIC24 and dsPIC33 lines were both
16-bit micros, there were many differences between them. With
these new lines, the features have been all but merged, giving us
the best of both worlds.
The biggest difference from those earlier micros (dsPIC33F,
PIC24F/H) is the much higher performance of the E-series. These
can achieve up to 70MIPS at 70MHz (60MIPS/60MHz for the extended temperature range). By comparison, the dsPIC33F-series
goes up to 40MIPS/40MHz while the PIC24F-series only manages
16MIPS/32MHz.
As well as having two or three internal comparators, these chips
also feature the same number of internal op-amps which can either be
used to give true differential ADC (analog-to-digital converter) inputs
or as general purpose devices connected to an output pin. Some
PIC24E and dsPIC33E chips also have a USB On-the-Go interface,
which was not available for the dsPIC33F series.
These chips retain many of the useful features of the earlier series chips including a fast and flexible ADC, with 4-channel 10-bit
resolution mode at up to 1.1MSPS (megasamples per second) and
single-channel 12-bit resolution mode up to 500kSPS. They also add
some new features such as configurable pull-down resistors on each
I/O pin (in addition to the configurable pull-ups).
Both new series have the 40-bit accumulators with single-cycle
multiply/accumulate instructions and hardware divide unit, as for the
dsPIC33F series. In fact the only difference between the dsPIC33Eand PIC24E- series processors is that the dsPIC33Es have ECAN
(Extended Controller Area Network) support.
The Motor Control (xxxMCxxx) chips in this series feature highspeed PWM modules with ~7ns output pulse resolution and a number
of different modes to suit different motor types. These devices also
have a Quadrature Encoder interface.
The dsPIC33Es and
PIC24E are available
in DIP and surface
mount packages. Microchip also sell a
dsPIC33E USB Starter
Kit which features
a sur face mount
dsPIC33e chip, an onboard USB programmer and separate USB
connection for direct
communication with
the micro. It also
has an I/O expansion
header.
16 Silicon Chip
Atmel SAM3U
SAM3U is a series of microcontrollers based on the ARM Cortex
M3. The main difference between the M3 core and the aforementioned M4 is that the M3 does not have a floating point unit (FPU).
What makes the SAM3U series unusual is on-chip hi-speed USB.
This allows much higher data transfer rates than full-speed USB;
480Mbits/s compared to just 12Mbits/s.
While some other ARM-based microcontrollers have hi-speed
USB controllers (eg, the STM32F4), they usually require an external
hi-speed USB PHY (physical layer) chip. This increases the total cost
and takes up more board space. By contrast, the SAM3U has an
integrated hi-speed PHY and its cost is comparable to other Cortex
M3 based parts.
SAM3U series microcontrollers operate at up to 96MHz/120MIPS.
They are available with 64-256KB flash memory, 16-48KB RAM and
in 100/144 pin SMD packages.
Extra features include a memory protection unit, dual-bank
flash for safe self-programming, multiple low-power modes, an
8-channel 12-bit 1megasample/s ADC with differential inputs and
programmable gain plus an 8-channel 10-bit ADC and up to nine
serial controllers.
siliconchip.com.au
Texas Instruments MSP430
Microcontroller Glossary
ADC (Analog-to-Digital Converter): a circuit where the input is
a voltage level and the output is a binary number. Allows digital
circuits such as microcontrollers to sense voltage levels and
measure analog signals. The resolution is specified in bits (eg, 12
bits); with more bits, it measures the voltage in smaller steps, for
greater accuracy. ADCs also have a maximum sampling rate, often
specified in kilosamples per second (kSPS) or megasamples per
second (MSPS). This indicates how often the ADC’s binary output
can be updated to reflect changes in the input voltage. ADCs are
often fitted with input multiplexer and sample-and-hold buffers.
See also: multiplexer, sample-and-hold buffer, DAC.
ARM (Advanced RISC Machine): one of the most common types
of 32-bit microprocessor/microcontroller, ARM is a processor
architecture which was introduced in 1987 and has been upgraded
many times since. Most ARM microcontrollers are based on the
ARM7, ARM9 or Cortex designs. ARM Holdings designs the ARM
core design cores and licenses them to manufacturers who then
add peripherals, memory and other support circuitry.
TI is lifting its profile in the microcontroller world with the
MSP430G2 “Value Line” series of low power, low cost 16-bit microcontrollers.
These are available in speed grades from 8MHz to 25MHz and with
1-256KB of flash memory. They have an array of optional features such
as ADCs, DACs (digital-to-analog converters), hardware multiply unit,
UARTs, LCD controllers, PWM outputs and so on. MSP430-series
chips are available in DIP and surface mount packages.
The MSP430 series features an innovative DCO (digitally controlled
oscillator) for clock generation which allows the chips to run over a
large range of speeds from a low-power internal oscillator. This can
wake up fast from low power “sleep” modes (around 1µs).
As one example, the MSP430G2553 has 16KB of flash and 512B
RAM, runs at up to 16MHz from a 1.8 to 3.6V supply and consumes
around 230µA/MHz. It has two 16-bit timers with three PWM outputs
each, serial ports (UART, SPI and I2C), JTAG, an 8-channel, 10-bit
200kSPS ADC, a real-time clock type function and up to 24 GPI/O
pins (in 28-pin SMD package; 16 for the 20-pin DIP package).
The MSP430 Launchpad is a small pack with a USB programmer/
debugger, 20-pin IC socket and pin headers which, in combination
with a free Windows development environment, allows for easy
programming and experimentation with MSP430 series processors.
Two 20-pin DIP micros are included with each Launchpad. It is a very
low-cost way to get into MSP430 programming.
Also available is an MSP430-based Wireless Development Tool
(eZ430-RF2500) to make the development of projects with 2.4GHz
digital wireless links easy. Then there is the MSP430 USB Stick
Development Tool (eZ430-F2013) which has a USB programmer/
debugger, MSP430 chip and I/O pads all in a USB stick form factor.
AVR: A line of 8-bit and 32-bit microcontrollers from Atmel; the
first microcontrollers to feature internal flash memory for program
storage.
CAN (Controller Area Network): a serial bus standard, designed for
use in vehicles, developed by Bosch.
ECAN (Enhanced CAN): a CAN peripheral which performs much
of the work to implement the CAN protocol, so that the processor
doesn’t have to.
Centre-aligned PWM, dual-ramp PWM: a form of pulse width
modulation which, unlike traditional edge-aligned PWM, does not
place the rising edge at the same point in each cycle for different
duty cycles. Can result in less electro-magnetic interference than
edge-aligned PWM.
Clock rate: the frequency of the clock signal used to drive the CPU
core. This determines the rate at which instructions are executed.
See: MIPS.
Code, Instruction code: the set of instructions which tell a
microprocessor or microcontroller what to do. The code therefore
defines its function.
Code density: this is a measure of how much memory the
instructions take up for any given task. An instruction set with high
code density takes less space to store the instructions required for
a given task than one with a low code density.
Core: the part of a microprocessor which loads instructions from
memory and then acts on them. This is the most fundamental part
of a microprocessor or microcontroller. Other parts include RAM,
ROM, flash and peripherals. Also known as an execution unit.
CPU (Central Processing Unit): the main microprocessor in a
computer.
DAC (Digital-to-Analog Converter): a circuit where the input is a
binary number and the output is a voltage level. Allows digital circuits such as microcontrollers to control a voltage level or generate
an analog signal. Resolution is specified in bits (eg, 12 bits); with
more bits, its output voltage changes in smaller steps. DACs also
have a maximum sampling rate, often specified in kilosamples per
second or megasamples per second. This indicates how frequently
the DAC’s analog output can be updated. See also: ADC.
siliconchip.com.au
JJune
une 2012 17
Microcontroller Glossary. . . continued
DCO/NCO (Digitally-Controlled Oscillator or NumericallyControlled Oscillator): an oscillator where the frequency can be
changed by the software. Typically used to generate the instruction
clock, so that the software can switch between high-speed and lowpower modes.
DIP (Dual In-line Package): the package used by virtually all
through-hole microcontrollers. The chip is encapsulated in a
rectangular body made from ceramic or more commonly plastic, with
a row of right-angle leads projecting from the two long edges.
DMA (Direct Memory Access): a method where peripherals share
access to RAM and are able to read/write data in the RAM without
the core being involved. This improves performance since it allows
the core to perform other tasks simultaneously with the peripherals
without constant interruption. See also: peripheral.
DMIPS (Dhrystone MIPS): a standard (though not infallible) method
for measuring processor performance. Superficially this resembles
MIPS but it is calculated by performing a task which is expected
to take a certain number of instructions and measuring how long
it took. This reveals not only the processor’s clock rate but also
its processing efficiency. For example, a 1MHz processor may
achieve 0.9DMIPS, 1.25DMIPS or some other value. The processor
with 1.25DMIPS can on average do more work per clock pulse
than the one which only achieves 0.9DMIPS. 1DMIPS is defined
as the processing power of an (ancient!) VAX 11/780 running at
1MHz. However,processors can be designed to look good in such
benchmarks.
dsPIC: a line of signal controllers from Microchip. These are
effectively powerful 16-bit microcontrollers with built-in DSP
instructions. See also: DSP, PIC.
DSP (Digital Signal Processor): a specialised variant of a
microprocessor with powerful mathematical functions such as fast
multiply-accumulate, floating point, SIMD and so on. Used for tasks
such as spectrum analysis, filtering and signal analysis.
EEPROM (Electrically Erasable Programmable Read-Only
Memory): a type of non-volatile memory which can be erased and
re-written. EEPROM usually withstands more re-write cycles than
flash memory but is otherwise very similar. See also: flash memory.
Ethernet: a series of network standards which allow data to be
transmitted over twisted-pair cable at speeds of 10Mbit, 100Mbit,
1Gbit or 10Gbit.
Flash, flash memory: a type of non-volatile memory where data
can be stored for many years. While flash memory can be re-written
many times, it has a finite life-span and so is normally used for
storing data that changes seldom, eg, program code. Also, the
read speed of flash is much higher than the write speed. Flash
must be erased before it can be re-written and for this reason it is
typically arranged in blocks, which can be erased one at a time or
simultaneously. See also: EEPROM.
FPU (Floating Point Unit): the section of a processor which
performs mathematical operations on floating point numbers. This
makes it much easier and often faster to manipulate fractional
numbers, especially those which can have a wide range of values.
GPI/O (General Purpose Input/Output): refers to a processor pin
which is capable of being a digital output, which the software can set
to either a low or high voltage level, or a digital input, in which case
the pin has a high impedance and the software can sense whether
the voltage level at that pin is low or high.
18 Silicon Chip
I2C (Inter-Integrated Circuit): a two-wire serial bus consisting of
two lines (SDA for data and SCL for clock) plus ground. Uses opencollector signalling to allow up to 1024 slaves to share a single I2C
bus with speeds up to 5MHz.
Instruction: a single command which instructs a microprocessor
core to perform a mathematical operation. A series of instructions
defines the program code which determines what the processor
does. A typical instruction might store a number to a particular
location in memory, add two numbers, send a control message to a
peripheral and so on.
Instruction set: the variety of different instructions which a CPU core
is able to handle. This affects the efficiency of a processor as well as
how easy it is to program.
Interrupt: a way for an external event or peripheral to trigger a
particular set of instructions in the processor core. When an interrupt
is triggered, the instruction flow of the core is interrupted and
diverted to a specific set of instructions which are to be triggered on
that event (the interrupt handler). When the interrupt handler’s task is
completed, the processor returns to executing the instruction that it
was about to process before the interrupt occurred.
JTAG (Joint Test Action Group): a five-wire daisy-chain serial
protocol designed for testing, debugging and programming
hardware. Used by many of the more powerful microcontrollers to
allow in-circuit debugging and re-programming.
Logic gate: a small circuit which performs a basic digital function.
All digital ICs, including microprocessors are built from logic gates.
A large processor could contain millions. These days, logic gates are
typically designed using Mosfets.
MPU (Memory Protection Unit): digital logic circuitry which
interfaces the processor core to memory. Used primarily with multitasking operating systems, the MPU is programmed with information
regarding which process “owns” which sections of memory by the
operating system and then prevents any process from accessing the
memory of other processes unless explicitly permitted. Detects and
prevents both accidental memory corruption due to software bugs
as well as preventing malicious software from interfering with other
processes or stealing sensitive data from their memory.
Micro, microcontroller: a small, low-power computer chip. They
usually have memory and interface circuitry within the chip.
Microcontrollers are built into vehicles, appliances and so on. As the
name suggests, are used to control the functions of those devices.
Microprocessor, processor: a computer chip, consisting of an
instruction core and support circuitry. The heart of all computers,
often referred to as a CPU or Central Processing Unit. See also:
microcontroller.
MIPS (millions of instuctions per second): a measure of processor
speed, the number of instructions that a processor can execute
in a second. This is related to the clock rate; for most modern
processors, the clock rate and MIPS figure are identical since they
can dispatch one instruction for each core clock pulse. Useful for
comparing performance between different chips of a similar design,
but not necessarily between different designs due to differing
instruction set efficiency. See also: DMIPS.
Multiplexer: a circuit which feeds one signal (analog or digital) to
one of several inputs or outputs of another circuit. These can be used
to expand the number of effective inputs of an ADC, by connecting
different signal sources to the ADC’s input at different times. They
siliconchip.com.au
can also be used to allow a microcontroller pin to have several
different functions, with the software instructing the multiplexer to
select which function should be connected to that pin.
Multiplier: the part of a CPU core which can calculate the result
of multiplying two numbers. Multiply is a very common operation
in some pieces of software and the multiplier performance
can determine the overall performance of the software. A 32bit multiplier is one which can multiply two 32-bit numbers.
Faster multipliers take up more space on the chip; a single-cycle
multiplier is fastest but also large.
Multiply-accumulate: an instruction which multiplies two
numbers and then adds the result to a third number before storing
it. A common instruction found in DSPs, sometimes with an
option to “saturate” the result (ie, prevent it from rolling over if
it gets too large). Used, for example, in Fast Fourier Transform
algorithms for spectrum analysis.
NXP (NXP Semiconductors): semiconductor design and
manufacture company, previously owned by Philips.
Peripheral: circuitry within a microcontroller which is controlled
by, but acts independently of the micro itself. Peripherals perform
tasks which are difficult to do with software or that would take
up disproportionate amounts of the micro’s processing power
to perform. They also allow the micro to do several things
simultaneously. Examples include ADCs, DACs, PWM outputs
(timers) and serial peripherals (SPI, I2C, etc).
PIC: A line of 8-bit, 16-bit and 32-bit microcontrollers and signal
controllers from Microchip. See also: dsPIC.
PICAXE: a range of budget microcontrollers from Revolution
Education (UK), based on PICs but pre-programmed with an interpreter using internal EEPROM. Programmed in BASIC language.
PHY (Physical layer): the part of a digital communication
device which provides the electrical interface, as opposed to
the controller which deals with the protocol itself. This term is
typically used in reference to USB or Ethernet interfaces.
PWM (Pulse Width Modulation): a scheme where a fixedfrequency square wave is generated with a variable ratio of ontime to off-time. This affects the average level of the PWM signal
and this can be used to vary the power delivered to a load (eg, a
heater element or motor).
Quadrature Encoding: a method for signalling rotation using two
digital signals. Consists of two square waves, one of which is
phase-shifted by 90°. Commonly used with rotary encoders, for
motor or wheel rotation feedback or as part of a user interface
(eg, a jog wheel).
RAM (Random Access Memory): circuitry where an array of
numbers are stored that can easily be changed. RAM is volatile so
its contents are lost when power is removed, so it is only used for
storing temporary data. RAM is fast to read and write. See also:
register.
Register: A type of very fast RAM embedded in a processor. Used
for storing numbers which are being worked on. There are usually
a limited number of registers (eg, 16); when working on larger
sets of numbers, their contents are shuffled into and out of RAM.
RISC (Reduced Instruction Set Count): a type of processor
instruction set which is designed to have few instructions, to allow
siliconchip.com.au
the processor to be smaller, cheaper and run at higher speeds.
ROM (Read Only Memory): memory which can be read but never
changed. ROM is used to store things like a processor’s type, unique
identification number and fixed sets of instructions for performing
specialised tasks.
RS-232: a two-wire serial interface with a typical speed of up to
115.2kbps. Works over longer cables than SPI or I2C.
RTC (Real-Time Clock): a circuit comprising a low-power oscillator
(usually crystal locked) and a timer which keeps track of the number
of seconds that pass. RTCs often have battery-backup so that even if
the processor loses power, it can still keep track of time.
Sample-and-hold: a circuit which freezes an analog voltage at a
particular level and holds it there for a certain period. Used in an ADC
so that the voltage being converted to a digital format represents
the input voltage at a specific point in time, ie, the voltage being
converted does not change during the conversion, which could
produce an incorrect result.
Serial bus: a method of data communication between two or more
ICs that only requires a few wires. Data is sent on a serial bus one
bit at a time. Some serial buses are unidirectional and some are
bidirectional. The number of wires required varies between one and
five or so; with more wires, higher speed communication is possible
and data overhead is lower. See also SPI, I2C, RS-232.
SIMD, Single Instruction Multiple Data: a method to speed up
mathematical operations on large amounts of numerical data by
processing more than one number at a time. A SIMD instruction
typically performs the same operation on two, four or eight numbers
at once.
SMD (Surface Mount Device): electronic components which are
designed to be mounted on the surface of a PCB rather than with
leads passing through holes. SMDs are typically much smaller than
through-hole parts and because they don’t require holes, can be
fitted on both sides of the PCB. SMD microcontrollers come in a
large variety of packages, including both leaded and leadless types
(eg, BGA or ball grid array).
SPI (Serial Peripheral Interface): a simple, high-speed serial
communication bus consisting of three wires (clock and bidirectional
data) plus ground and a chip select line for each slave. Data rates in
excess of 10Mbit are possible, over short distances.
Timer: an on-chip counter which can be configured to count in a
variety of ways. These can be used to keep track of time, generate
PWM outputs, generate periodic interrupts and so on. See also:
PWM, RTC, Interrupt.
UART (Universal Asynchronous Receiver-Transmitter): a serial
peripheral which can be programmed to communicate on a variety of
serial buses such as SPI, I2C, RS-232 and so on.
USB (Universal Serial Bus): a serial bus designed for connecting
accessories to a computer. USB carries bidirectional serial data and
a 5V power supply over four pins. The original USB had low-speed
(1.5Mbps) and full-speed (12Mbps) modes. USB 2 added a hi-speed
mode (480Mbps) and USB 3 adds a 5Gbps mode.
USB OTG (USB On-The-Go): a variation on USB which allows a
single chip to act as either a host or a device. In other words, you
can either plug a device into it (such as USB flash drive) or you can
plug it into a computer. This requires a special plug that can take
either type of cable.
SC
JJune
une 2012 19
WiNRADiO
®
By Maurie Findlay,
MIEAust
Excalibur
A revolutionary radio receiver
In the legend of King Arthur, “Excalibur” was a sword with magical
properties. It is an appropriate name for the latest Software-Defined
High Frequency Receiver from WiNRADiO of Melbourne, Australia.
Like its namesake, Excalibur is immensely powerful and – dare we
say it – almost magical in performance!
S
ixty years ago, communication
receivers used vacuum tubes
and came with precision mechanical dials in big metal boxes.
Thirty years ago, transistors and
integrated circuits had replaced the
valves and the boxes were smaller.
Today, this new receiver does a great
deal more than any of the former and
comes in a very small sealed metal
container – just 156 x 97 x 41mm.
A purchaser receives a professionally presented package which includes
20 Silicon Chip
the receiver, power supply, cables,
user’s guide, an SMA/BNC adapter
for the antenna socket and a CD-ROM
with the application software.
It is assumed that a computer, essential to the operation of the receiver,
is already on hand.
The user’s guide discusses the requirements for the computer. The one I
used is a four year old laptop, Compaq
Presario V6000 running Windows XP,
and is about the minimum standard
suitable for the job. Windows 7 or
Vista would be the operating system
in more modern computers. The hard
disk must have at least 20MB of free
space to hold the information from
the CD-ROM.
After connecting the receiver,
loading the CD-ROM and attaching a
random (short) length of wire to the
antenna socket, I followed the user’s
guide and within five minutes was
hearing my local station on 702kHz,
through the speakers in the computer.
Another five minutes and I was able,
siliconchip.com.au
one by one, to tune in all my local
stations on the default AM setting of
the receiver.
Yet another five minutes with the
guide and I was able to receive the
local stations in the USB (upper
sideband) and LSB (lower sideband)
modes. That is, with the receivergenerated carrier substituted for the
incoming carrier.
It is that easy to get started.
The 107-page User’s Guide is packed
with well written information. Most
owners, new to software-defined high
frequency receivers, will take several
weeks to fully appreciate the facilities
offered by Excalibur.
In addition to the manual, there a
great deal of helpful information on
www.winradio.com
DDC? DDS? SDR?
Although I have a background in the
design and manufacture of commercial
siliconchip.com.au
radio equipment ranging from the
valve days to high performance types
using semiconductors, I am one
of those new
to this technology.
For the
first time,
in the
guide,
I came across abbreviations such as
DDC, DDS and SDR. For the uninitiated (like me!) these stand for digital
down-conversion, digital direct sampling and software-defined receiver.
While these are explained early in
the guide, it would have been easier
to study if these abbreviations
had been spelled out at the
beginning of each section
where they occur. A detailed index at the rear
would have made
the job of finding information
easier. There is
a 3-page table
of contents at the
front.
The initial screen is shown above.
It is pin sharp and full of detail. The
panel at the top left indicates the frequency to which the receiver is tuned,
in this case 1278kHz; towards the
high frequency end of the
standard medium wave
band. To the right of
the frequency indication is a knob which
can be operated
by the computer (mouse) to
change the
End-on view of the WiNRADiO Excalibur WR-G31DDC HF receiver, shown here
close to life-size. Controls on the box are non-existent; everything is done by the
attached computer.
June 2012 21
ated by the press-to-talk switch, is
not satisfactory because the proximity
of the active arm of the relay and the
receiver contact will allow appreciable
power to be transferred. A specialised
antenna changeover circuit, designed
for the task, should be used.
Audio quality, particularly the
lower end of the range, is limited
by the small speakers built into the
computer. For many users this will
be all that is required. However all
computers these days have an audio
output jack which can be used to feed
a better quality audio system.
Modes
G31DDC receiving a broadcast station on 1278kHz with the spectrum displayed
in the “Waterfall” mode. It makes a colourful change!
frequency. Alternatively, the frequency can be entered from the keyboard.
The receiver covers the range from
9kHz to just below 50MHz.
To the right of the knob is a meter
indicating the strength of the incoming carrier: in this case -28dBm. The
buttons below the meter allow the
strength to be indicated in dBm, µV
or “S” units, the last being the usual
means of reporting signal strength on
the amateur bands.
Buttons at the top right, accessed
by the mouse, allow the receiver to
be set for nine different modes of
reception: AM, AMS, LSB, USB, CW,
FMN, FSK, UDM (user-defined mode)
and DRM mode (optional). Below them
are a further eight buttons which access other functions including volume,
squelch and noise blanker.
Spectrum analyser
Across the bottom of the screen is a
spectrum analyser display, in this case
set to cover 0 to 30MHz. Strong signals
in the AM broadcast band appear to
the left. Above that is the spectrum,
expanded to cover the band from 0.5 to
2MHz. Individual carriers of the local
stations can be picked out very clearly.
A third display, to the centre right,
covers only 50kHz and allows the audio spectrum of the incoming signal
to be seen. The shaded area indicates
the receiver bandwidth and can be
changed by clicking the “BW presets”
button above that display.
So in addition to being a high performance communication receiver,
22 Silicon Chip
Excalibur is a very useful spectrum
analyser.
It is designed to match an antenna
with a source impedance of 50Ω and
the short length of wire I used initially
is not very efficient. The receiver can
be used for general shortwave listening
with a long length of wire, attached to
the antenna terminal and preferably
outside the building but even this does
not give the best results.
WiNRADiO are able to supply an
aerial transformer which gives better
results with random lengths of wire.
The transformer is connected to the
receiver via coaxial cable and can
be placed well away from any local
sources of interference. A ground point
can be connected to the transformer.
Commercial users and amateur
radio people using the receiver will
normally have tuned 50Ω antennas
which can be directly connected to
the antenna terminal. In this case, of
course, it will only work efficiently for
the particular band and the spectrum
analyser will clearly indicate the resonance of the antenna.
Because of the spectrum analyser
presentation and many other features,
amateur (and perhaps even professional) radio operators may use the
WiNRADiO Excalibur to replace the
receiver section of an older transceiver. Great care must be taken with
the switching arrangement to ensure
that radio frequency energy from the
transmitter does not reach the receiver
antenna terminal.
A simple changeover relay, oper-
Modes of reception for the receiver
include the conventional AM (amplitude modulation), LSB (lower sideband), USB (upper sideband, not to be
confused with the universal serial bus
USB) and CW (continuous wave - for
Morse code). In addition, AM can be
received as AMS (amplitude modulation - synchronous demodulation)
in which case the received carrier is
replaced by a locally generated carrier.
One or both sidebands can be selected.
This results in a reduction of the
distortion caused by selective fading,
particularly with weak signals on the
shortwave broadcast bands.
Narrow band FM (frequency modulation) signals can also be received.
Digital, frequency shift keying and
user-definable modes are also discussed in the User’s Guide.
Selectivity is variable in fine increments from a bandwidth of 50kHz to
10Hz. The former is suitable for wideband AM and the latter for CW under
difficult conditions. The standard
mode for voice communications on
the high frequency bands is SSB and
a bandwidth of around 3kHz can be
selected for best signal-to-noise ratio.
Upper sideband is normal, although
radio amateurs use lower sideband on
frequencies below 9MHz. There is no
special technical advantage in using
LSB; it goes back to the early history
of the development of sideband on the
amateur bands.
Tuning accuracy is given as 0.5
parts/million <at> 25°C but the sample
provided for review was better than
that.
Furthermore, the User’s Guide
shows a method of adjusting the internal crystal oscillator against an external standard. This is of immense value
when using the WiNRADiO Excalibur
siliconchip.com.au
WiNRADiO WR-G31DDC ‘EXCALIBUR’ SPECIFICATIONS
Receiver type:.....................................................................................Direct-sampling, digitally down-converting software-defined receiver
Frequency range:................................................................................9kHz to 49.995MHz
Tuning resolution: ..............................................................................1Hz
Modes:................................................................................................AM, AMS, LSB, USB, CW, FMN, FSK, UDM (user-defined mode) DRM mode (optional)
Image rejection:..................................................................................90dB typical
IP3 (intercept point 3rd order):...........................................................+31dBm typical
Attenuator:..........................................................................................0 - 21dB, adjustable in 3dB steps
SFDR (spurious free dynamic range):.................................................107dB typical
Noise figure: .......................................................................................14dB
MDS (minimum discernible signal): ...................................................-130dBm <at> 10MHz, 500Hz BW
Phase noise: .......................................................................................-145dBc/Hz <at> 10kHz
RSSI (received signal strength indication) accuracy:..........................2dB typical
RSSI sensitivity: .................................................................................-140dBm
Processing and recording bandwidth (DDC bandwidth):....................20kHz - 2MHz (selectable in 21 steps)
Demodulation bandwidth (selectivity): ...............................................10Hz - 62.5kHz (continuously variable in 1Hz steps)
Spectrum analysers:...........................................................................Input spectrum/waterfall, 30MHz or 50MHz wide, 1.5kHz resolution bandwidth
...........................................................................................................DDC spectrum/waterfall, max 2MHz wide, 1Hz resolution bandwidth
...........................................................................................................Channel spectrum, max 62.5kHz wide, 1Hz resolution bandwidth
...........................................................................................................Demodulated audio, 16kHz wide, 1Hz resolution bandwidth
ADC (analog/digital converter):...........................................................16 bit, 100 MSPS (mega-samples per second)
Sensitivity (typical <at> 10MHz):............................................................AM -101dBm (2.00 µV) <at> 10dB S+N/N, 30% modulation
...........................................................................................................SSB -116dBm (0.35 µV) <at> 10dB S+N/N, 2.1kHz BW
...........................................................................................................CW -123dBm (0.16 µV) <at> 10dB S+N/N, 500Hz BW
...........................................................................................................FM -112dBm (0.56 µV) <at> 12dB SINAD, 3kHz deviation, 12kHz BW,
...........................................................................................................audio filter 300-3000Hz, de-emphasis -6dB/octave
Note: Below 200kHz, the sensitivity gradually drops.
Typical figures (CW, 500Hz BW, 10dB S+N/N) are as follows: .......200kHz -123dBm; 100kHz -116dBm; 50kHz -112dBm; 25kHz -97dBm; 10kHz -81dBm
Tuning accuracy:.................................................................................0.5 ppm <at> 25 °C
Tuning stability: ..................................................................................2.5 ppm (0 to 50 °C)
MW filter: ...........................................................................................Cut-off frequency 1.8MHz <at> -3dB; Attenuation -60dB min <at> 0.5MHz
Antenna input: ....................................................................................50Ω (SMA connector; SMA to BNC converter supplied)
Output:................................................................................................24-bit digitised I&Q signal over USB interface
Interface: ............................................................................................USB 2.0 Hi-speed
Dimensions:........................................................................................156 x 97 x 41mm
Weight: ..............................................................................................430g
Power supply (operating): ..................................................................11-13V DC <at> 500mA (typical, operating); 45mA (typical, power save)
Operating temperature:.......................................................................0 to 50 °C
as a communication receiver because the boys”. First is sensitivity – the abilthe transmissions are frequently too ity to receive very weak signals; the
short to give time for retuning. With other is blocking performance – the
this accuracy, you can be sure of clear ability to receive those weak signals in
audio even with SSB at the higher the presence of strong signals on adjafrequencies.
cent frequencies. This is particularly
A feature of the receiver is the abil- important on the crowded amateur
ity to receive three signals at the one bands.
time provided that they fall within the
There are a number of accepted tests
range of the DDC (digital down con- for sensitivity and blocking. I decided
verter) analyser which has a maximum
to apply a simple test, that I have used
bandwidth of 2MHz.
previously in my own laboratory, to
This could be of value on the ama- the Excalibur receiver.
teur bands; however most
of the allocated channels
25
25
for the marine, flying doctor
and VKS-737 high frequency
SIGNAL
RECEIVER
GENERATOR
UNDER TEST
networks, that you may wish
1
to monitor at the same time,
are separated by more than
25
25
2MHz.
Sensitivity & blocking
There are two features of
communication receivers
which separate “the men from
24 Silicon Chip
It was tuned to 10,000.0kHz SSB
(upper sideband), with a bandwidth
of 3kHz, and a signal at 10.001.5kHz
applied to the antenna terminal. The
signal generator has a source impedance of 50Ω and the receiver a nominal
input impedance of 50Ω.
The attenuator of the generator indicates the signal level at the receiver.
(The audio output of the receiver is a
tone at 1,500Hz.) The output of the
signal generator was reduced until the
signal plus noise to noise ratio of the
output was 10dB. The signal
level at the antenna terminal
was -112dBm (0.5 µV).
Now for the hard one. A resistive network was arranged so
that two signal generators could
be connected to the receiver,
both generators being correctly
SIGNAL
AUDIO
terminated and the source reGENERATOR
LEVEL METER
50
2
sistance, as seen by the receiver,
still 50Ω. The level of the first
generator was increased so that
The test setup I use for communications receivers. It
revealed an outstanding result.
the S+N/N was still 10dB.
siliconchip.com.au
The second signal generator, tuned
to 10,020Hz, was fed into the network
and the level adjusted until the S+N/N
changed by 3dB. The level at the receiver terminal when this happened
was -7dBm (0.1V). That is, 105dB
above the wanted signal.
All these tests were done without
the input attenuator of the Excalibur
in operation.
A figure of 90dB was considered the
norm for high-standard communication receivers when I was involved
in their design and manufacture – so
at 105dB this receiver is very good
indeed; exceptional, in fact.
However, it could be even better:
discussions with WiNRADiO engineers suggest that shortcomings of
the signal generators I used may have
influenced the test so that the real
blocking figure may well be greater
than 105dB.
Interference? Notch it out!
The Excalibur has another trick up
its sleeve, for dealing with high level
adjacent channel blocking signals, in
the form of a notch filter. This can be
brought into operating by clicking the
Notch button when the frequency and
width of the notch can be adjusted.
(The interfering signal can be seen on
the analyser display.)
Space in the User’s Guide is devoted
to the elimination of interference,
particularly that from the computer,
which is an essential part of the receiving setup. When I initially operated the
receiver, with a short length of wire
close to the computer for an antenna,
the interference was obvious.
However, when an outside length
of wire or a tuned antenna was used,
computer noise was swamped by the
incoming signals (as you would expect). Obviously, the noise generated
by various computers will be different
but with my “typical” PC, performance
was outstanding.
It is not true to suggest that newer
PCs may be better in the noise department than older models – some recent
PCs (escpecially plastic-cased laptops
and notebooks) have been woeful in
this regard compared to their forebears. But I am confident in suggesting
that with rare exceptions (and a proper
antenna) computer noise should not
be an issue.
Software control of the receiver
makes possible a large number of useful adjustments and displays which
would be quite impractical with the
conventional design. One of the most
important is the ability to vary the
bandwidth in small increments.
A conventional superhet may have
a crystal filter with a bandwidth of
6kHz for AM and another with 3kHz
bandwidth for single sideband but
there will be times when different
selectivity will allow better reception.
The Excalibur has a conventional
spectrum analyser, which plots
frequency against amplitude (ie,
frequency domain), while frequency
may be plotted on a linear scale in the
horizontal and amplitude on a vertical logarithmic scale. It also offers the
alternative of a “waterfall” display,
which some users may prefer.
Other facilities offered by the Excalibur include the ability to record
various settings and also received
programs.
Would you like to work for
this innovative company?
WiNRADiO
®
is seeking bright,
enthusiastic Electronics and
RF Technicians/Engineers
for R&D work, prototyping,
testing and production.
Interested? Then send us
your application with your
professional background
addressed to:
careers<at>winradio.com
WiNRADiO Communications
15 Stamford Road
Oakleigh, Vic 3166
Ph (03) 9568 2568, ext 0204
Conclusion
The WiNRADiO G31DDC Excalibur offers a tremendously powerful
performance at a cost less than that
of a conventional communicationsstandard superhet receiver.
This is the way of the future.
It is sold direct from WiNRADiO’s
online store in Australia or through a
number of specialist communications
distributors overseas.
For readers who don’t have Windows-based PCs, WiNRADiO also have
available MacRadio and LinRadio
(Linux) versions.
Acknowledgement:
We gratefully appreciate the assistance of
Helmut Riexinger of WiNRADiO Communications in the preparation of this review. SC
Where from, how much:
The WiNRADiO Excalibur WR-G31DDC
receiver is made in Australia by
WiNRADiO Communications,
15 Stamford Road,
Oakleigh, Vic, 3175.
Phone: (03) 9568 2568
Web: www.winradio.com
Recommended retail price is
$995.00 +GST
The spectrum analyser displaying the demodulated signal from a broadcast
station. The shaded area indicates the sidebands, each side of the carrier (the
peak in the centre), which are passed on to the audio amplifier.
siliconchip.com.au
Readers in Australia should contact
WiNRADiO direct via their website or
phone; readers in other countries can
contact their local distributors (details
on the WiNRADiO website)
June 2012 25
Crazy
Cricket
. . . or
Freaky Frog!
Love the sound of crickets and frogs (and who doesn’t)? Maybe you
will revise your judgement after exposure to Crazy or Freaky – the
(very) pesky cricket and equally annoying grenouille.
D
esigned to imitate the chirping
noise of a cricket or the gentle
croaking of a frog, Crazy/Freaky
loves to sing in the dark and happily
chirps/croaks away, much to the annoyance of others.
When disturbed by light, he immediately shuts up, remaining stealthy
and silent. He keeps his location secret
until conditions become favourable
when he begins to chirp again.
To make life simple, we’ll just refer
to Crazy – but remember every other
time you turn him on he becomes
Freaky.
He’s sneaky!
Crazy does not immediately begin
to chirp when darkness falls. He may
wait a second or two or he may delay
his singing for up to 40s. By this time
you may think he has (thankfully)
moved away. But start to chirp (he
eventually will) and you will then
know that Crazy is a very happy little
insect. Call him pesky, call him annoying but we just call him Crazy.
26 Silicon Chip
You may think that this behaviour
is just like any ordinary cricket or
frog, but naturally Crazy is different.
Ordinary crickets make sounds to
establish their territory or attract a
mate. And their chirping sounds are
produced by rubbing a coarse section
of one wing against a scraper located
on the other wing. This process is
called stridulation.
Crazy does not stridulate! Nor does
he need to attract a mate (well, not
that we’ve noticed). However, he does
claim his territory. This territorial
claim remains until he is discovered
whereupon his final fate remains
uncertain.
There may be search-and-destroy
missions to locate Crazy but he is
very elusive. One thing against him
is that his eyes glint in the dark and
this may reveal his position. More than
likely though, his eyes will terrify the
unwary.
by John (Chirpy) Clarke
While ordinary crickets are made
from biological materials, Crazy is
an all-electronic insect manufactured
from numerous elements including
silicon, iron, copper, carbon and silica.
He also incorporates man-made plastics in his construction that are rather
difficult to pronounce for a cricket.
When attempting to pronounce his
material make-up he is sometimes
heard expressing just the word “chip”.
It’s derived from the longer expression
“silicon chip”.
Whether this expression sets Crazy
apart as being more highly evolved
than his biological counterparts is
unknown.
As Crazy says, he does include a
silicon “chip” in his make up. In this
design the chip is a PIC microcontroller and that vastly simplifies his
circuitry.
Just as crickets evolve in nature, this
makes this new design an evolutionary
improvement over the previous but
ever popular “Clifford the Cricket”
from December 1994. In that circuit a
siliconchip.com.au
Easy to build but hard to
ignore – Crazy Cricket,
shown here in 3D, chirps
away in the dark and
flashes his LED eyes .
. . until you turn the
lights on. Then he shuts
up until it gets dark
again. We’ve shown
Crazy here with resistor
“legs” coming from the
underside of the PCB –
while this is perfectly
acceptable, they could
just as easily come from
the top side and bent
over the edge of the
board. Or indeed, they
could have been made
from tinned copper
wire. The PIC micro is
also programmed with
Crazy’s alter-ego, Freaky
Frog. Each is selected in
an alternate fashion on
each supply power-up.
CMOS hex inverter was used instead.
Further improvements over the
previous 1994 design include reduced
component count, smaller and more
compact construction and significantly lower current drain.
This low current allows the use of
a lithium 3V cell. That’s in contrast
to the 1994 version that used a rather
large 9V battery. That battery acted
more like a convict’s ball and chain,
with the weight often restricting Clifford from his annual winter migration
northward to a warmer climate.
The 1994 chirping sound was rather
limited and comprised a 2kHz tone
modulated at 160Hz and at 25Hz. This
didn’t simulate a real cricket.
He’s real (almost)!
For this latest version, we wanted
Crazy to sound more realistic, so the
sounds made by Crazy are based upon
a real cricket’s chirping. Typically, a
cricket produces three close-together
chirps each separated by silence – then
an even longer silence, before repeating these triplet chirps.
Fig.1 shows a typical cricket chirping waveform. Each individual chirp
comprises a tone of about 4kHz that
lasts for around 50ms. The spacing between each chirp is also around 50ms.
A much wider spacing is between each
triplet at around 250ms. As expected,
without arms (he has six legs!) a cricket
does not have an accurate timepiece
to set these periods precisely and so
these periods do vary a little.
Fig.1: typically, a cricket produces three close together chirps each separated by a silent space, then a wider spacing of no
sound before repeating these triplet chirps. The scope grab on the left is a close-up of the drive waveform fed to the piezo
sounder. Channels 1&2 (yellow and green) are at either end of the piezo while the mauve trace shows the difference – that
is, the full 6V across the piezo while that on the right shows one burst of cricket sound.
siliconchip.com.au
June 2012 27
J1
POWER
100nF
470k
4
3V
LITHIUM
BUTTON
CELL
K
D1
1N4004
A
1
Vdd
GP2
GP3/MC
GP4
LDR
6
IC1
PIC12F675
GP1
GP5
GP0
100
5
PIEZO
TRANSDUCER
3
2
7
330
330
A
K
A
K
LED1
LED2
Vss
8
SC
2012
CRAZY CRICKET/FREAKY FROG
K
A
LEDS
1N4004
A
K
Fig.2. the circuit is very simple with just a single, cheap PIC microcontroller
(IC1) and a few other components. IC1 monitors the LDR that in turn
monitors the ambient light. IC1 also drives the piezo transducer that emits all
the chirping noise and the LEDs flash while ever Crazy chirps.
The tone of the chirp, however, does
not appear to vary by any noticeable
degree.
Crazy simulates the cricket chirp
by producing the three 4kHz chirps
separated by the longer spacing. When
reproducing this waveform, we found
that a 50ms chirp with 50ms gap for
each chirp triplet tended to sound more
like an umpires whistle (NOT a cricket
umpire . . .) than a cricket!
Clearly there is a difference between
a real cricket’s stridulation and a
generated waveform driving a piezo
transducer. In order to sound more
realistic, the simulated chirps were
reduced to 20ms wide with 20ms gaps
between them. The standard cricket
250ms spacing between the three
chirps, however, is incorporated into
Crazy’s voice.
Variations
As mentioned, a cricket does not
produce precise periods in its chirping.
To simulate this variation, Crazy has
his chirping periods varying randomly
over a limited range. The variations are
weighted so that the 20ms and 250ms
periods are more common compared
to rarer wider and narrower periods.
The variations in the periods provide
a more natural cadence to Crazy’s
chirping. The variations prevent the
simulated cricket sound from being
too regular, relentless and artificial.
Physical appearance
Crazy is made up using a small
PCB (printed circuit board) with the
components mounted onto this. Most
28 Silicon Chip
parts are mounted on the top of the
PCB including the cell holder and eyes,
made from 3mm diameter red LEDs.
The piezo transducer that produces
the cricket sound is slung beneath the
PCB. Legs; six in all, are fashioned
from spare resistors – or you could use
tinned copper wire.
The circuit
As shown in Fig.2, Crazy’s circuitry
is very simple, comprising a PIC microcontroller, IC1 and just a few associated
components.
It’s powered by a 3V lithium cell,
switched via a jumper link JP1. The
jumper is removed when Crazy is not
used to save any power draw from the
cell. The circuit does not draw much
current anyway – typically only 3µA
when Crazy is dormant in lighted conditions. Current drain while chirping
is 1mA.
Diode D1 is included as a safety
measure to prevent damage to IC1
should the cell be connected incorrectly somehow. This could happen if
the cell holder is installed the wrong
way round.
If the polarity is wrong, diode D1
will shunt the reverse current. If the
cell holder is installed correctly, then
because of the way the CR2032 cell is
made, there is no way that it can be inserted back-to-front. At least that is true
for the particular cell holder we used.
IC1’s power supply is bypassed with
a 100nF capacitor and IC1 runs using
its internal 4MHz oscillator. When
Crazy is dormant and awaiting darkness, this oscillator is shut down (put
into sleep mode) to save power.
A low frequency watchdog timer
is set running to waken IC1 approximately each half second. During the
woken period, IC1 checks the ambient
light level from the light dependent
resistor (LDR1).
Normally, IC1’s GP1 output is set
high (3V) and so there is no current
flow through the 470kΩ resistor and
the LDR. Again, this is done to minimise current drawn from the 3V cell.
When IC1 is awake, it sets output GP1
low (0V) and the LDR forms a voltage divider in conjunction with the
470kΩ resistor across the 3V supply.
The voltage across LDR1 is monitored
at input GP3.
In darkness, the LDR resistance is
high (above 1MΩ) so the voltage at
input GP3 is more than 2V due to the
voltage divider action of the LDR and
the 470kΩ resistor. This voltage is detected as a high level by IC1. The high
level tells IC1 that Crazy is in the dark.
With bright light, the LDR will drop
in resistance, down to around 10kΩ,
which produces a low level at input
GP3. IC1 recognises this as Crazy being
located in a lighted area.
Output GP1 is only held low for a
short duration, sufficient for ambient
light readings from the LDR. GP1 then
returns high to save power.
Software solutions
Note that the GP3 input in many projects is often configured as the MCLR
input (master clear), which allows the
microcontroller to have an external
power on reset. However, for our circuit we need to use this as a general
purpose input for monitoring the LDR.
When MCLR is set up as an input,
the MCLR operation is switched to
an internal connection within the
microcontroller so the master clear
power-on-reset function is not lost.
One disadvantage of using this as a
general purpose input is that it is not
a Schmitt trigger input.
The lack of a Schmitt trigger input at
GP3 can mean that, at a particular ambient light level, the input to GP3 could
be read as either a high or low input
level by IC1’s software. At this threshold, Crazy could produce strange sets
of chirping as IC1’s software switches
on and off the chirping, undecided as
to the ambient light level.
We solve this by making sure that
once Crazy is switched on (in darkness), he is not switched off until the
siliconchip.com.au
PIEZO TRANSDUCER
UNDER PCB
LED1
K
IC1
D1
PIC12F675
470k
100nF
4004
LEGS
+
LDR1
PIEZO
100
JP1
330
CR2032
BUTTON
CELL
HOLDER
330
LEGS
LED2
A
K
© 2012
A
Fig.3: all parts mount on the PCB. Take care that
the cell holder, IC1, D1 and the LEDs are oriented
correctly. The piezo is under the board. The six legs
can be any value resistor or even lengths of tinned
copper wire. Note the turned-back and soldered safety “feet” in the photo above.
PIEZO
ambient light reaches a significantly
higher level. This difference in level
is called hysteresis.
Hysteresis is implemented by pulsing the GP1 output momentarily high
when checking for a high ambient light
level. High ambient light means that
the LDR resistance is low, so the GP3
input is a low voltage. The momentary
high pulse level effectively raises the
GP3 voltage slightly since this pulse is
filtered due to the internal capacitance
at the GP3 input of 50pF or less. The
raised voltage means that the LDR is
required to have a lower resistance (ie
have more light shining on it) to bring
the GP3 voltage low enough for a low
input reading by IC1.
The second disadvantage of using
the MCLR pin as a general purpose
input is that there can be a problem
when programming the microcontroller. This problem occurs when the
internal oscillator is also used to run
the microcontroller (which we do). We
solve this problem in the software and
the solution is discussed later under
the ‘programming’ subheading.
Output drivers
Outputs GP0, GP2, GP4 and GP5
on IC1 are used to drive the LEDs and
piezo transducer.
The piezo transducer is driven via
both the GP2 and GP4 outputs. When
output GP2 is high, GP4 output is low
and when output GP2 is taken low,
output GP4 is taken high. This provides
a full 3V peak square wave drive to the
transducer.
A 100Ω resistor limits peak current
siliconchip.com.au
at the switching of the outputs.
LED1 and LED2 are independently
driven via outputs GP5 and GP0 respectively, via 330Ω resistors. These
LEDs are driven for short bursts while
Crazy is producing a tone. Only one
LED is driven at one time to limit the
peak current drawn from the battery,
to extend its life.
Construction
Crazy is constructed on a PCB coded
08109121, measuring 30 x 65mm. He
is presented as a bare PCB with wire
legs upon which to stand. Check the
PCB for any problems such as undrilled
holes or breaks in the tracks. Faults are
unlikely since PCBs these days are generally of excellent quality, particularly
if you are using a board supplied by
SILICON CHIP or any of the kit suppliers.
Fig.3 shows the PCB overlay. Begin
construction by installing the resistors,
using a multimeter to check the value
of each before inserting into the PCB.
You might note that for this project we
have also shown the individual resistor
colours on the PCB overlay.
As mentioned earlier, the legs can
be either spare resistors or lengths of
tinned copper wire. We prefer resistors but please yourself! Of course,
the resistor values for the legs doesn’t
matter to anyone except, perhaps,
Crazy (would you like it if you had six
different legs?).
Diode D1 can now be installed, taking care to orient correctly. The 100nF
capacitor can be soldered in next and
it can be positioned either way round.
Then solder in the 2-way pin header
along with the cell holder – make sure
the plus terminal is oriented toward
diode D1 on the PCB.
LED1 and LED2 are mounted raised
off the PCB by about 10mm. The
leads can be bent so that each LED
sits horizontally and faces outward
toward their corner of the PCB. Make
sure the longer lead of each LED (the
anode) is inserted in the “A” position
on the PCB. The LDR is mounted about
5mm above the PCB surface and sits
horizontally.
Whether you use resistors or wire for
the legs, they should be cut to about
35mm long, with a small loop formed
on the outer ends so that the wire end
is not sharp. These loops can be filled
with solder. Bend the legs so that Crazy
can stand upright.
The piezo transducer is mounted on
the underside of the PCB supported
on TO-220 insulating bushes used as
spacers and secured with short M2
screws and nuts. The wires can be
soldered to the underside of the PCB
(the positions are marked ‘piezo’)
or brought around to the top of the
PCB and soldered in the normal way.
Heatshrink tubing over the wires to the
PCB will help prevent the wires from
breaking off.
While the piezo will probably come
with red and black wires, indicating that it is polarised, in this case it
Freaky Frog
Crazy has an alter-ego (or should that be alternate ego?), Freaky Frog, who
produces frog “knee-deep” sounds instead of cricket sounds. If you prefer
frogs to crickets or tire of Crazy and want a change, then replace all references in this article to Crazy with Freaky.
Freaky has a different cadence to Crazy and produces a set of 10 chirps
10ms long with 2ms gaps. This is followed by a 30ms gap and then another
set of 3-chirps 10ms long with 2ms gaps. The 10/3 sets are separated by
between 200 and 1200ms that varies irregularly. The frequency of the chirps
is set at around 2kHz.
Both Crazy and Freaky are in the PIC program – each time you turn it on,
the alternate program runs.
June 2012 29
Parts list –
Crazy Cricket/
Freaky Frog
1 PCB coded 08109121, 30 x 65mm
(available from SILICON CHIP for $10
plus p&p – see pp 96-97)
1 20mm button cell holder
(Jaycar PH-9238, Altronics S 5056)
1 CR2032 Lithium cell (3V)
1 30mm diameter piezo transducer
(Jaycar AB-3440, Altronics S 6140)
1 LDR 10kΩ light dependent resistor
(Altronics Z 1621; Jaycar RD-3480)
(LDR1)
2 TO-220 insulating bushes
1 DIL8 socket
2 M2 x 8mm screws with nuts
1 2-way pin header (2.54mm pin
spacing) with jumper shunt (J1)
1 25mm length of 2mm heatshrink
tubing
Semiconductors
1 PIC12F675-I/P programmed with
0810612A.hex (IC1)
1 1N4004 diode (D1)
2 3mm high brightness red LEDs
(LED1,LED2)
Capacitors
1 100nF 63V or 100V MKT polyester
Resistors (0.25W, 1%)
1 470kΩ
2 330Ω
1 100Ω
6 resistors for legs or
250mm 0.7mm tinned copper wire
doesn’t matter – either wire can be
soldered to either “piezo” position.
Note that if you intend to program
the PIC yourself, hex file 0810612A.
hex can be downloaded from the SILICON CHIP website. Also see the section
under programming for details about
how to do this.
Solder in either the IC or the IC
socket, making sure it is oriented correctly. If using a socket, place the IC in
it now – watch out that you don’t bend
the pins! Now install the CR2032 cell
in its holder and place the jumper link
onto the 2-way header (JP1). If all is
well, the LEDs will momentarily flash
after about 3s to acknowledge power
has been connected.
An acknowledgement by a brief
flashing of the LEDs also occurs when
a low light level is detected. Low light
can be simulated by covering over the
LDR. Crazy will then begin chirping
after a delay of about 10 seconds,
providing the low light level remains.
30 Silicon Chip
From then on, Crazy will randomly
vary his waiting period before chirping
begins at the onset of darkness.
grammed, it will begin executing its
program. A typical program initially
sets up the microcontroller with the
general purpose (GP) lines set as inputs
Modifications
or outputs (I/O). This conflicts with the
Crazy has a loud chirp so that he will programmer needing to use the clock
be heard effectively even if hidden in and data programming I/O lines for
a dark cupboard. If you require less program verification.
volume, then change the 100Ω resistor
This problem does not happen if the
in series with the piezo transducer to MCLR pin is set as the external MCLR
a higher value such as 4.7kΩ or 10kΩ input because the programmer then
for a nominal reduction in perceived has control over the microcontroller,
volume by about 50%. Higher values stopping it from executing the proagain will give even less volume.
grammed code.
The light level threshold can be
Note also that in order to run the
altered by changing the 470kΩ resis- code, the microcontroller has to have
tor in series with the LDR. A lower the internal oscillator configured
resistance value (say 100kΩ) will have instead of an external crystal, RC or
Crazy chirping at a higher ambient external clock oscillator.
light level. By contrast, increasing the
The programming problem is solved
resistance value will mean that Crazy in the software provided by including
will need a darker light level before he a three second delay at the start of the
begins chirping.
program. This delay is before the I/O
lines are set as inputs or outputs. The
Programming
I/O lines therefore remain as high imIf you are programming the mi- pedance inputs while the programmer
crocontroller yourself, you may be verifies the internally programmed
presented with a warning by the pro- code using the clock and data programgrammer stating that programming is ming lines.
not supported when both the MCLR is
A warning from the programmer will
set as a general purpose input and with still be issued but the microcontroller
the internal oscillator set.
can be programmed successfully and
However, you will be able to pro- correctly verified by the programmer.
gram the microcontroller successfully,
Note that the PIC12F675 also needs
ignoring the warning. That’s because special programming due to the fact
any problems associated with this
that it has an oscillator calibration
configuration is already solved by a value (oscal) that is held within the
software solution. Read on if you want PICs memory. This calibration value
more details.
is individually programmed into each
As mentioned, we set MCLR as a PIC by the manufacturer and provides
general purpose input and utilise the a value that allows setting of the PIC
internal oscillator within IC1. This to run at an accurate 4MHz rate using
can present problems for a program- the internal oscillator.
mer during the process of verifying
This value must be read before erasthe software code after programming.
ure and programming so that it can
The problem lies in the fact that as be included with the rest of the code
soon as the microcontroller is pro- during programming. If this procedure
is not done, then the oscillator frequency could be offfrequency. That will have an
effect on Crazy’s chirp.
Most PIC programmers
will automatically cater
for this oscal value – but it
is worthwhile checking if
your programmer correctly
handles this, especially if
you have difficulties.
Finally, be aware that the
PIC12F675 requires a 5V supply for programming, even
Fig.4: if you see this warning (or similar) when
though it happily runs at 3V
attempting to program the PIC, simply ignore it
in the circuit.
(ie, just press OK).
SC
siliconchip.com.au
WE ARE MOVING
There may be some delays to deliveries.
Please be patient and allow a little extra time
for delivery of your order during June.
K318 10W WEATHER-PROOF ULTRA-SONIC PARKING RADAR
This kit comes with all parts required and
FLOODLIGHT KIT
includes cables and connectors. The driver's
This kit comes
complete with 1 X 10W
LED, 1 X 10W LED
driver kit, 1 X
Weatherproof, diecast
aluminium housing
ONLY
display shows distance (max 2.5M) via a 7
segment display, left & right LED bar-graphs
and audible alarm. The distance displayed is
surprisingly accurate and has a 100mm
resolution. Paint and moisture don't seem to
bother the sensors and the radar will work with
1, 2, 3 or 4 sensors. [K304] $35
$
29
As rev
ie
Silicon Ch wed in
ip Magazin
e
+
+
.
2 lamps wired in series with our 24V PSU.
2 X LED FLOODLIGHT KITS + 1 X 24V
POWER SUPPLY [K318P] $60
3W per 500mm
These LED strips are designed to operate from
nominal 12VDC regardless of length Ideal for
use in cars, boats. caravans and sheds etc.
With a self adhesive backing and a clear PVC
front coating. These strips can be easily joined
or connected by wire to form greater lengths or
can be cut into multiples of 100mm. [LS500R]
$50 PER 5M roll or [LS500] $7 per 500mm
BARGAIN LOW VOLTAGE
LIGHTING PACKAGE
This package contains 5
12V-24V, 4Watt LED
"PURE WHITE" MR16
replacement lamps + a
240VAC - 24V / 1A switch
mode power supply that
can power all 5 lamps.
$4
4
[K293PP]
K320 3W LED AND DRIVER
$1
0
+
The LED colour is called
"Pure white", 240Lum.- 3 X
80Lum. The Driver has a
on-board rectifier so
polarity is not important.
fo
r3
The LED circuit board
should be mounted on a
metal surface as it requires
additional heat-sinking
(silicon Heatsink paste inc.).
+
ts
ki
www.oatleyelectronics.com
High quality Waterproof, Aluminium framed
12V/62W Solar Panels. These employ 40 cells
instead of the usual 36. This results in a higher
output at low light levels, and at higher
temperatures. 678X870X35mm, Voc:22V,
Isc:3.76A, Vmp:17.27V, Imp:3.59A. With each
panel you will receive our K009E Solar regulator
kit for only [SP62PK1]
ICE KIT
R
R
P
W ATO
O
L UL
L
A
I REG 0
C
E E
5
SP FRE $1
TH
WI
10W LED FLOOD LIGHT KIT PACKAGE
FLEXIBLE 12VDC LED STRIP
WATERPROOF (IP65)
***SPECIALS***
62W SOLAR PANELS + Reg.$150.00
20W LED + DRIVER SPECIAL
This kit comes with a...
20W, 2000lm "PURE WHITE" LED
plus a 12Vdriver kit plus a small fan. The LED
will need to be mounted on a small plate or
heatsink.
[20WP]
$30
COLOUR HD DVR
IDEAL FOR CAR.
2.5" TFT Colour monitor.
LED's for night time
vision. 120deg.viewing
angle. Rotating screen,
270 deg. Res.
1280x960, 720x
480 or 640x480.
MICRO SD card
up to 32GB. Records
automatic-ally on power
up. Time & Date display on
video. Cycled recording.
Car charger:12 or 24V.
Interface: USB
2.0.
Li-ion battery.
Video Form
8GB RD
h
t
i
A
at: AVI.
W
SD C
Still image format:
O
R
JPEG
MIC
Comes with...8GB
MICRO SD card, Car
DVR, 1 x Suction
Mount, 1 x USB Cable,
1 x Car Charger,
1 x Manual,
1 x Battery. [HDDVR]
9
6
$
This auto detect
12/24V-15A Maximum
Point Power Transfer
(MPPT) switch mode
controller will increase
the charging rate by
10-30%! ie. it will
deliver 100W into a
10V battery (Flat) from
a panel with a
maximum output of
100W at 17V. Also inc.
a 15A Low Voltage
Cut-out for voltage
sensitive loads.
MPPT SOLAR
CHARGE
CONTROLLER
[MPPT] $65.00
DOWN LIGHT SPECIAL
LIMITED STOCK
[LEDDL]
This Crompton
brand down light
has a built in
240V-12V switch
mode power
supply. It has a
swivel head and
is supplied with
a 4W LED
MR16 style
lamp.
ONLY
$15
Orders: Ph ( 02 ) 9584 3563, sales<at>oatleyelectronics.com, PO Box 89 Oatley NSW 2223
major credit cards accepted, Post & Pack typically $7 Prices subject to change without notice ACN 068 740 081 ABN18068 740 081
SC_JUN_12
Wideband Oxygen
Sensor Controller Mk.2
Accurately measure air/fuel ratios with an improved
oxygen sensor
Are you involved in car modifications? Have you improved the inlet
air-flow or modified the exhaust line with new mufflers? Has your
engine been “re-chipped” to improve the timing and fuel parameters
or have you fitted bigger injectors? If you answered yes to any of
these, then you need to check that your engine is not running too
lean or too rich. To do that you need to fit a wideband oxygen sensor
and build our improved Wideband Oxygen Sensor Controller.
B
ACK IN SEPTEMBER and October
2009 we published the original
and very popular Wideband Oxygen
Sensor Controller. This was designed
for use with the Bosch LSU4.2 wideband oxygen sensor. In this substantially revised design, we use the
much-improved Bosch LSU4.9 sensor
which supersedes the LSU4.2. This
has necessitated an upgraded microcontroller, the addition of a sensor to
monitor exhaust pipe pressure and a
re-designed LED display module.
32 Silicon Chip
Most modern vehicles include a
narrowband oxygen sensor so that the
engine control unit (ECU) can control
the air/fuel ratio. Unfortunately, that
sensor is only accurate when the fuel/
air mixture is stoichiometric, ie, when
the mixture is exactly right to give
complete combustion and with all the
oxygen used in the burning process.
The engine control unit (ECU) normally adjusts the fuel mix to maintain
an oxygen sensor signal that’s close
to 450mV, the stoichiometric point.
In practice, a narrowband sensor has
a very sharp voltage change around
the stoichiometric point and so the
sensor voltage is continually cycling
above and below 450mV as the ECU
maintains the fuel mixture.
This is referred to as “closed loop”
operation. It does not matter to the ECU
that the narrowband sensor is inaccurate and non-linear outside closed
loop operation.
To explain further, Fig.1 shows the
typical output from a narrowband
siliconchip.com.au
Pt.1: By JOHN CLARKE
oxygen sensor. It has a very sharp
response either side of the stoichiometric point (lambda of 1), ranging
from about 300mV up to 600mV; the
classic “S” curve. For rich mixtures, it
ranges from around 600mV to almost
900mV (lambda up to 0.8), is quite
non-linear and varies markedly with
temperature. It is similarly non-linear
for lean mixtures, ranging from around
300mV down to a few mV (lambda of
about 1.15).
To learn about lambda, refer to the
explanatory panel later in this article.
The ECU uses its own factory preset
values to set rich mixtures for acceleration or lean for cruise conditions. This
is referred to as “open loop” operation
because the oxygen sensor is not capable of providing accurate feedback
about the actual fuel mixture.
Now if you haven’t changed anything on your vehicle, then there is
little reason to worry about the actual
fuel mixtures at any time; the ECU
takes care of it all. But if you have
made any changes to the vehicle to
improve its performance (eg, inlet
air filter, throttle body and plenum,
injectors, MAP or MAF sensor, custom
ECU chip, supercharger or turbocharger, catalytic converter, exhaust
manifold, mufflers and resonators, in
short, anything that’s likely to result
in significant changes to fuel mixtures
and oxygen sensor readings) then you
need a wideband oxygen sensor and a
companion controller.
Bosch LSU4.9 oxygen sensor
As stated, our new controller is designed to work with a Bosch LSU4.9
wideband oxygen sensor. This sensor
is now used in some late-model cars
to measure and control the mixtures
over the full range of engine operation.
Main Features
•
Accurate lambda measurements on 3-digit display
•
•
Pre-calibrated sensor
•
S-curve (narrow band sensor)
simulation output for ECU
•
•
Heat/data/error indicator LED
•
Correct sensor heat-up rate
implemented
•
Heater over and under-current
shutdown
Pressure and temperature
correction of lambda reading
Adjustable engine-started battery voltage threshold
Fig.2 shows the wideband controller
output using the Bosch LSU4.9 sensor
over a wide range of air/fuel ratios from
0.7 lambda to 1.84 lambda.
Our Wideband Oxygen Sensor Controller is housed in a small plastic case,
as shown in the accompanying photo.
As well as providing an 8-pin socket
(CON5) for the wideband oxygen
sensor, it has two jack sockets. One
of these (CON3) drives a companion
3-digit LED display unit which shows
the lambda value.
The other jack (CON4) provides a
S-Curve Output vs Lambda
1000
900
OUTPUT (millivolts)
800
RICH
700
600
500
400
300
200
LEAN
100
0
0.8
0.9
1
Lambda ()
1.1
1.2
Fig.1: the S-curve output from the Wideband
Controller simulates a narrowband sensor
output (the response follows the Bosch LSM11
narrowband sensor curve). Note the steep slope
in the curve at stoichiometric (ie, lambda = 1).
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.2: the wideband output from the Wideband Con
troller is linear with respect to lambda values from
0.7-1.84. The resulting signal is displayed as a lambda
value on the Wideband Display Unit to be described in
Pt.2 next month.
June 2012 33
more slowly if there is a sensor error
or if the air/fuel ratio is outside its
measurement range.
+12V
Rcal
Rcal
Ip
Vs/Ip
WIDEBAND
SENSOR
Heater
Vs
Ip
SIMULATED
NARROW-BAND
SENSOR SIGNAL
Rcal
Ip
Vs/Ip
Vs
H–
H–
H+
H+
WIDEBAND
CONTROLLER
+12V
0–5V OUTPUT
GND
GND2
GND1
Why do you need it?
8.8.8
WIDEBAND DISPLAY
Fig.3: here’s how the Wideband Controller is used with a wideband oxygen
sensor and with a Wideband Display Unit (to be described in Pt.2), to provide
accurate air/fuel mixture readings. As shown, the Wideband Controller has
both a display output and a simulated narrowband (S-curve) output.
signal which simulates the output
from a narrowband sensor. This enables the vehicle’s existing narrowband
sensor to be replaced with the Bosch
LSU4.9 and still provide for normal
ECU operation.
As far as the car’s ECU is concerned,
the simulated signal is what it would
get from a narrowband sensor and so
engine operation is normal.
By the way, it’s possible to use
the wideband sensor by temporarily
installing it into the end of the exhaust pipe, as will be detailed in Pt.2
next month. You might want to do
this for easy monitoring of changes
to different vehicles. However, the
ideal installation is to substitute the
original narrowband sensor with the
Bosch LSU4.9.
A description of the new Bosch
sensor is provided in an accompanying panel.
Another feature of our new Wideband Oxygen Sensor Controller is an
on-board sensor to measure pressure
in the exhaust system. We’ll talk more
about this later.
A red status LED on the front panel
indicates when the controller is heating the sensor to its operating temperature. This occurs each time the
controller is switched on and it takes
less than 10 seconds for the operating
temperature to be reached.
Once the sensor is at operating temperature, this LED then flashes rapidly.
From that point on, the wideband
controller is monitoring the signal
from the oxygen sensor and feeding
a simulated narrowband signal to the
ECU. By contrast, the LED flashes
Fig.4: inside a narrowband zirconia oxygen sensor. It consists of a zirconia
ceramic sensor element with thin platinum electrodes on both sides.
34 Silicon Chip
So why is the Wideband Oxygen
Sensor Controller necessary? It’s be
cause a wideband sensor is very different from a narrowband sensor. In its
most basic form, a narrowband sensor
has only one wire and this is the sensor
output. The other connection is via the
metal frame of the unit. However, some
narrowband sensors have an internal
heater and these units may have three
or four wires.
By contrast, a wideband sensor has
six wires (yeah, we know the socket
on our controller has eight pins – be
patient). This is because the wideband sensor comprises a narrowband
oxygen sensor, a heater and an oxygen
ion pump which diffuses oxygen ions
into or out of the measurement chamber (of the narrowband sensor). The
heater and oxygen ion pump need to
be controlled externally from the sensor and this is where the Wideband
Oxygen Sensor Controller comes into
the picture. But we are getting way
ahead of ourselves . . .
Fig.3 shows the basic set-up. At
left is the wideband sensor with its
six leads which are all connected to
the wideband controller. As already
mentioned, this provides a simulated
narrowband sensor signal which feeds
the ECU. In addition, there is an output
to drive the 3-digit Wideband Display
Unit.
Before we describe how a wideband
sensor and its associated controller
work, it’s necessary explain the characteristics of a narrowband sensor.
Fig.4 shows a cross-section of a typical
narrowband sensor. It’s about the same
size as a spark plug and is threaded
into the exhaust system so that the
sensor is exposed to the exhaust gasses. The assembly is protected using
a shield that includes slots so that the
exhaust gases can pass through into
the sensor.
The sensor itself is made from a
zirconia ceramic material that has
a thin layer of porous platinum on
both sides. These platinum coatings
form electrodes to monitor the voltage
produced by the zirconia sensor as the
exhaust gas passes through it. For the
chemistry-minded, the sensor is called
a “Nernst cell”.
The device operates by measuring
siliconchip.com.au
DIFFUSION
GAP
EXHAUST
20 A
REFERENCE
CURRENT
PUMP CELL
O 2¯
MEASUREMENT
CHAMBER
ZrO 2
O 2¯
CONTROLLER
LOGIC
PSEUDO
REFERENCE
SENSOR CELL
HEATER
WIDEBAND DISPLAY OUTPUT
NARROWBAND OUTPUT
(SIMULATED)
450mV
REFERENCE
Vs
Vs SENSE
COMPARATOR
HEATER ELEMENT
H+
62
DIFFUSION
PATH
Vs/Ip
ZrO 2
Ip SENSE
AMPLIFIER
Rcal
Ip
ZrO 2
Ip
Rcal
H–
WIDEBAND SENSOR
WIDEBAND CONTROLLER
Fig.5: the basic scheme for a wideband oxygen sensor and its associated control circuit (at right).
the difference in oxygen content between exhaust gas and outside air. The
oxygen content of air (about 20.95%)
serves as the reference (reference air).
In operation, a voltage is produced
between the electrodes because the
zirconia sensor has a high conductivity
for oxygen ions at high temperatures.
Some narrowband sensors include
a resistive heating element to ensure
that they operate within their correct
temperature range. The heater also
quickly brings the sensor up to its
operating temperature and thereby
allows the ECU to provide closed-loop
operation earlier than would otherwise be possible.
So with that brief description of a
narrowband sensor under your belt,
take a look now at Fig.5. This shows
the internal cross-section of the wideband sensor on the left and the connections to the controller on the right.
The wideband sensor includes a
clever method to obtain a wider, more
linear response from a narrowband
sensor. This involves a measurement
chamber incorporating a pump cell
into which a small sample of exhaust
gas enters via a diffusion gap.
The pump cell moves oxygen
ions into or out of the measurement
chamber gap in order to maintain a
stoichiometric measurement for the
sensor cell. For our purposes, the
sensor cell is a narrowband sensor. If
the measured mixture is lean, then the
sensor cell detects excess oxygen. The
pump cell then drives oxygen ions out
of the measurement chamber until the
sensor cell produces a stoichiometric
lambda value.
Conversely, if the mixture is rich,
oxygen ions are pumped from the
surrounding exhaust gas into the meassiliconchip.com.au
Fig.6: this graph plots Ip (pump current) versus lambda for
the wideband sensor.
urement chamber gap until the sensor
cell again reaches its stoichiometric
lambda value.
When the mixtures are lean, there is
oxygen available in the measurement
chamber for the oxygen ions to be
transferred. Conversely, when the mixture is rich, oxygen ions for both the
pump cell and the pseudo reference
chamber are obtained (reduced) from
the available oxygen in the sampled
exhaust gas.
This available oxygen can be reduced from exhaust gases such as
carbon dioxide (CO2) and steam (H2O).
As a result of the above, the current applied to the pump cell can be
either positive or negative, depending
on whether oxygen is pumped into
or out of the measurement chamber.
The oxygen pump thus maintains a
stoichiometric lambda value within
the measurement chamber.
So while the narrowband sensor
(sensor cell) is used to detect the
stoichiometric mixture, it is the current applied to the pump cell that
provides the necessary information to
accurately determine the air/fuel ratio.
If this sounds like “black magic”
then that’s not far from the truth. Most
wideband sensors (including the older
Bosch LSU4.2) utilise a narrowband
sensor similar to the Fig.4 arrangement
June 2012 35
Specifications
Power requirement: 11V to 15V. Start-up current when heating is 1.6A (~20W)
and typically 0.6A (7.5W) when up to temperature.
Reading accuracy: typically 1%.
Measurement range: 0.7 (rich) to 1.84 (lean) lambda.
Reading error indication: LED flashes at 1Hz rate for <0.7 or >1.84 lambda.
Engine started battery voltage threshold: adjustable to 15V; 13V setting
typical (TP2 = 4.17V).
Sensor heating: preheat begins at an effective 2V for 2s then at an effective
7.2V and ramps up at 73.3mV/187.5ms (equivalent to 0.39V/s).
Heater maximum effective voltage (Veff): 12Veff after initial preheat and at
13Veff for <30s.
Heat-up period: typically <10s.
Heater over current error: 4A.
Fuse protection: 5A.
Heater open-circuit detection error: if current is less than 390mA at initial
preheat.
Heater drive frequency: 122Hz.
Sensor temperature: controlled at 780°C by maintaining the 300Ω impedance
of the sensor cell at that temperature. Can be measured as 684mV DC at
the wideband output with JP1 inserted.
Temperature correction: Ip corrected for sensor temperature between 698°C
and 880°C.
Pressure correction: Ip corrected for pressures up to 587hPa above standard
atmospheric pressure of 1013hPa.
Pressure offset adjustment: between sea level (1013hPa) and 2000m
(766hPa) above sea level. VR6 adjusted for 1V/1000m when the sensor is
plugged for gauge pressure readings.
Sensor cell measurement: AC drive at 1.953kHz and 243µA.
Sensor cell DC loading: <4.5µA.
Reference Current: 20µA.
Wideband output: linear 0-5V output for 0.7-1.84 lambda.
S-curve output: simulates a 0.8-1.17 range following the Bosch LSM11 sensor
curve.
S-curve response: 100ms time constant.
Wideband reading response: 100ms to a 5% change in oxygen.
Indicator LED: pre-startup and 2Veff warm up = dim; during sensor preheat =
fully lit; controlled with data = 16Hz flash; error = 1Hz flash. An overheated
sensor is indicated with the dim LED.
WHERE TO FIND DATA
(1) Data for the LSU4.2 and LSM11 sensors mentioned is available at http://
www.bosch.com.au/content/language1/downloads/Section_D.pdf
(2) Data on the Bosch LSU4.9 oxygen sensor is available at http://
www.breitband-lambda.de/media/Dateien%28Lambda%29/
LSU49TechProductInfo.pdf
(3) A description of the operation of wideband sensors and the difference
between the LSU4.2 and LSU4.9 is found at http://www.ee.kth.se/php/
modules/publications/reports/2006/XR-EE-RT_2006_008.pdf.junk
(4) More information on oxygen sensors in general can be found at http://
chemistry.osu.edu/~dutta/index_files/Recent%20Publications_files/
Ramamoorthy_R.pdf
36 Silicon Chip
where it has a reference air-chamber.
However, the Bosch wideband LSU4.9
sensor does away with the reference
air, utilising a “pseudo reference”
chamber instead. It is truly a clever
device.
For the pseudo reference, excess
oxygen is maintained in this chamber
by applying a small reference current
to the sensor. This current transfers
oxygen ions from the measurement
chamber to the pseudo reference
chamber. For this chamber to act as a
reference, the driving reference current must be sufficient to maintain
excess oxygen in the pseudo reference
chamber.
As with the pump cell, this oxygen comes from the exhaust gas. The
partial gas pressure between the two
chambers is equalised by having a
diffusion path opening in the pseudo
reference chamber.
The pseudo reference chamber is
a big advance because a reference
air-chamber needs to be constantly
replenished with oxygen from the
outside air and the only way oxygen
can enter the sensor is via the sensor
leads, ie, between the copper wire and
its surrounding insulation, a pretty
tortuous route!
Any contamination of the sensor
leads from oils, tars and fuels can
affect the oxygen flow to the sensor.
The leads are also susceptible to damage if the sensor lead connections are
soldered (instead of crimped), as this
will melt the wire insulation sufficiently to seal the wire against oxygen
flow. However, for a pseudo reference,
oxygen replenishment is not affected
by sensor lead contamination since
it derives its oxygen via a different
pathway.
It should be noted that both the
reference air-chamber and the pseudo
reference chamber, whichever is deployed, will be depleted of oxygen
over time unless it is continuously
replenished. That is because any oxygen in the reference chamber will ultimately diffuse into the measurement
chamber to balance out the oxygen
partial pressure that is higher in the
reference chamber (for the chemistry
minded, this is due to Fick’s First Law).
Now have another look at the block
diagram of Fig.5. Vs is the output voltage from the oxygen sensor cell while
Ip is the current into or out of the pump
cell. At the stoichiometric point, Vs is
450mV and this is compared against a
siliconchip.com.au
BUFFER
FILTER
siliconchip.com.au
10k
PWM1
(IC1)
AN6
(IC1)
x25.45
100nF
TP3
(IC4b)
Rcal
(IC3b)
62
TP12
Ip
20 A
AMPLIFIER
Vs
TP11
AN10
(IC1)
x4.7
+
PUMP
CELL
SENSOR
CELL
(IC3a)
OFFSET BUFFER
TP4
TP1
Vs/Ip
3.3V
+5V
VR4
(IC4a)
Fig.7: this diagram shows the general arrangement for the pump control
and the sensor cell measurement. Buffer stage IC4b supplies current to
the pump cell via trimpot VR5 and the paralleled Rcal and 62Ω resistors.
The other side of the pump cell connects to a 3.3V supply (formed using
buffer stage IC2b and set by trimpot VR3 – see Fig.12). IC3a monitors and
amplifies the sensor cell voltage (Vs) by 4.7.
Ip Variation with Pressure
20
Ip/Ip at 1013 hPa (%)
lambda > 1
15
10
lambda < 1
5
0
–5
Fig.8: this graph shows
how Ip (pump current)
varies with pressure.
The effect on Ip with
pressure is greater
for lean mixtures
(lambda>1). The
wideband controller
corrects for pressures
up to 587hPa above
standard atmospheric
pressure of 1013hPa
(ie, up to 1600hPa).
1900
1800
1700
1600
1500
1400
1300
1200
1100
1000
900
–15
800
–10
700
450mV reference. If Vs is higher than
the 450mV reference, the mixture is
detected as “rich” and the Vs sense
comparator output goes high.
This “informs” the controller logic
that Ip needs to change, to pump oxygen ions into the diffusion gap in order
to regain a stoichiometric measurement. Similarly, if Vs is lower than the
450mV reference, the exhaust mixture
is detected as “lean” and the comparator output goes low. As a result, the
controller adjusts Ip to pump oxygen
out of the diffusion gap.
Note that if there is no Ip control,
the sensor cell behaves like a standard
narrowband sensor with an output
voltage above 450mV for rich mixtures
and below 450mV for lean mixtures.
However, with current control, the
pump current is adjusted to maintain
a 450mV reading from the sensor cell.
Variations in the sensor cell voltage indicate the change in mixture in
either the rich or lean direction, while
Ip (the pump current) shows whether
the mixture is actually rich or lean. A
negative Ip indicates a rich mixture
and a positive current indicates a lean
mixture. The Ip level indicates the
lambda value.
Fig.6 shows a graph of Ip versus
lambda for the wideband sensor. The
lean region curve (lambda from 1-1.84)
was developed from a graph of Ip versus oxygen concentration provided in
the Bosch LSU4.9 data and the equation: Lambda = [(Oxygen% + 3] +1]
÷ [1 - 4.77 x Oxygen %]. For the rich
region, a 4-step graph provided in the
LSU4.9 Bosch data sheet is used.
Another calculation is made to convert the lambda value to the voltage
required at the wideband output as
shown in Fig.2. Similarly, the lambda
value is converted to an S-curve response for the simulated narrowband
(S-curve) output as shown in Fig.1.
Ip is sensed by measuring the voltage across a 62Ω 1% resistor (in parallel with Rcal). However, during the
calibration of each sensor, the actual
resistor used by Bosch is 61.9Ω (a 0.1%
tolerance value from the E96 range).
Rcal is trimmed so that the voltage
across this resistor, measured against
lambda, is the same for each sensor.
In fact, Rcal can be a value ranging
between 30Ω and 300Ω, depending on
the characteristics of the individual
sensor. The value for Ip shown on the
vertical axis of Fig.6 is therefore not
the total pump current.
AMPLIFIER
Rcal
VR5
Pressure in hectoPascals (hPa)
In the graph, Ip only relates to the
voltage across the 62Ω resistor. So
while Fig.6 shows Ip varying between
-1.85mA and 1.07mA, the actual total
current range could vary from -2.23mA
to 1.29mA if Rcal is 300Ω or -5.67mA
to 3.28mA if Rcal is 30Ω. This total
current needs to be supplied by the
wideband controller circuit.
Pump sensor control
Fig.7 shows the general arrangement
for the pump sensor control. As can be
seen, a filtered pulse width modulated
(PWM) signal from a microcontroller
(IC1) is applied to buffer stage IC4b.
This in turn supplies current to one
side of the pump cell via trimpot
VR5 and the paralleled Rcal (located
inside the wideband sensor) and 62Ω
resistors.
The other side of the pump cell con-
nects to a 3.3V supply.
When the output of IC4b is at 3.3V,
there is no current through the pump
cell. For positive current through the
pump cell, IC4b’s output goes above
3.3V. Conversely, when IC4b’s output
is below 3.3V, the pump cell current
is negative.
In practice, IC4b’s output can swing
between 5V and 0V to allow for the
current range required for the lambda
extremes of measurement (0.7 to 1.84).
The pump cell current (Ip) is monitored using op amp IC3b which operates with a gain of 25.45. Its output is
in turn monitored using the AN6 input
of microcontroller IC1.
Op amp IC3a monitors and amplifies
the sensor cell voltage (Vs) by 4.7. The
20µA reference current is also applied
to the sensor cell at this point. Note
that while this is called a reference
June 2012 37
Advantages Of The LSU4.9 Oxygen Sensor
In September and October 2009, we published a wideband controller based on the
LSU4.2 wideband sensor from Bosch. While this sensor is similar in many respects to
the LSU4.9, the latter has some distinct advantages.
Perhaps the most important advantage is that the sensor now has a pseudo reference for oxygen that replaces the atmospheric air reference of the LSU4.2. For the
LSU4.2, this reference air had to pass through the leads of the sensor and this made
it prone to problems due to contamination with oils, tar and fuels preventing the flow of
the required oxygen. The LSU4.9 is not subject to any contamination that can cause
measurement inaccuracies.
Other advantages of the LSU4.9 over the LSU4.2 are a faster response to mixture
changes, a faster heat-up period and a revised higher resistance for the sensor cell. So
while the sensor cell of the LSU4.2 has a resistance of 80Ω at its 750°C operating temperature, the LSU4.9’s sensor cell is at 300Ω at its operating temperature of 780°C. This
higher resistance results in a more accurate measurement of the sensor temperature.
The way in which the LSU4.9 is used with a Wideband Controller also differs from the
LSU4.2. While the LSU4.2 heater could be driven from a PWM (pulse width modulated)
voltage at 2Hz or more, the recommended heater-driver PWM frequency for the LSU4.9
is greater than 100Hz. Additionally, the ramping up of heating applied to the sensor
has been revised to include a preheat at low voltage. These measures ensure that the
sensor is not damaged due to thermal shock or from moisture during sensor heating.
Air/fuel ratio & lambda
Lambda is simply the ratio of the actual air/fuel ratio to the stoichiometric air/fuel ratio.
For petrol, the stoichiometric air/fuel ratio (the mass of air required to completely burn a
unit mass of fuel) is 14.7:1. However, this can drop to 13.8:1 when 10% ethanol is added.
A lambda of 0.7 for petrol is equivalent to an air/fuel ratio of 0.7 x 14.7 = 10.29:1.
Similarly, a lambda of 1.84 is equivalent to an air/fuel ratio of 27.05:1. The stoichiometric air/fuel ratio is typically 15.5:1 for LPG and 14.5:1 for diesel. These values can
differ depending on the actual fuel composition and for diesel it varies between winter
and summer.
Lambda is probably the best measure of air/fuel mixtures since it is a universal value
and not dependent on the specific fuel.
current, it is not a critical value and
the word “reference” indicates that
the current is for the pseudo oxygen
“reference”.
Note also that any variation in
the reference current does not affect the calibration of the wideband
sensor when it comes to accurately
measuring the oxygen content in the
measurement chamber. Instead, that
calibration depends on the Rcal adjustment. The reference current must
be sufficient to constantly maintain
excess oxygen in the pseudo reference.
The recommended current to do this
is 20µA.
Trimpot VR4 is used to provide an
offset voltage which is buffered by IC4a
and is set so that IC3a’s output is 2.5V
when the sensor cell voltage is 450mV.
The microcontroller monitors IC3a’s
output at its AN10 input and varies
the pump current to maintain a 2.5V
reading. This effectively maintains the
sensor cell for monitoring stoichiometric mixtures.
The measured Ip value when the
38 Silicon Chip
sensor cell is measuring stoichiometric
is used to determine the lambda value.
One complication with Ip is that
it is dependent on exhaust pressure
which is always above atmospheric
pressure. Fig.8 shows the change in
Ip versus pressure. As a result, our
Wideband Oxygen Sensor Controller
provides pressure correction up to
587hPa above standard atmospheric
pressure (1013hPa).
At this pressure, Ip is reduced by
12% for lean mixtures and 9% for
rich mixtures.
This correction requires an air-hose
connection from the exhaust manifold to the Wideband Controller. It is
optional though. If you don’t utilise
pressure correction, then the readings
can be manually corrected using the
graphs of Fig.6 and Fig.8.
Note that the exhaust pressure does
not have any effect on stoichiometric
readings because Ip at stoichiometric
is zero.
Another complication is that Ip is
also dependent on temperature. As a
result, any variation in the sensor cell
temperature will affect the Ip readings,
resulting in inaccurate lambda values.
Fig.9 shows how the sensor cell
resistance varies with temperature.
The change in Ip with temperature is
some 4% per 100°C.
There are two ways to ensure the
lambda readings remain accurate. One
way is to correct for the effect of temperature using the graph and the 4%
change per 100°C. We actually do this
in the Wideband Controller itself but
it is only useful for small temperature
changes when variations in exhaust
gas flow across the sensor can cause
a momentary temperature variation.
The main method to ensure accurate
readings is to maintain a constant temperature for the sensor. That’s done by
using the sensor’s heater.
Heater element control
In this case, the Wideband Controller maintains the sensor’s temperature
at 780°C. In operation, its temperature
is measured by monitoring the impedance of the sensor cell. This has high
impedance at room temperature, falling to 300Ω at 780°C.
The impedance of the sensor cell is
measured by applying an AC signal to
it. Fig.10 shows the circuit arrangement. A 5Vp-p (peak-to-peak) AC
signal is applied to the sensor cell via
a 220nF capacitor and 10kΩ resistor.
The capacitor blocks DC and the resistor forms a voltage divider with the
impedance of the sensor cell.
When the sensor cell has an impedance of 300Ω, the voltage swing across
it is 145.6mV peak-peak. IC3a has a
gain of 4.7 so its output is 684.5mV
peak-peak. The microcontroller measures this 684.5mV signal at its AN10
input and maintains the 300Ω sensor
impedance by controlling the heater
current.
Fig.11 shows the heater control circuit. Mosfet Q1 is connected in series
with the heater element across the 12V
supply and is driven by a PWM signal
from IC1 (RB7). The heater current is
monitored via a 0.1Ω resistor in series
with Q1’s source and the resulting voltage across this resistor is filtered using
a 22kΩ resistor and 100µF capacitor
and fed to input AN4 of the microcontroller. If the heater is disconnected or
goes open circuit, the lack of current
will be detected and this will switch
off the Wideband Controller.
Similarly, if the heater current besiliconchip.com.au
Sensor Cell Resistance versus Temperature
10000
Ip = 4%/100°C
1000
Sensor Cell Resistance ()
comes excessive, the controller will
switch off Q1 and the heater.
Note that there is a strict “ramp-up”
of power that must be applied in order
for the sensor to be heated gradually.
This is to prevent thermal-shock damage to the ceramic sensor.
It works like this: initially, the sensor is not heated until the engine starts
and this allows any condensation to
be blown out of the sensor. Then there
is a sensor preheat period that begins
with an effective 2V being applied to
the heating element for two seconds.
The heater voltage then increases to
an effective 7.2V which then ramps
up by 73.3mV every 187.5ms.
This is equivalent to 0.39V/s and
just under the maximum ramp-up rate
of 0.4V/s specified by Bosch.
In order to set the effective heater
voltage, we also have to monitor the
battery voltage to calculate the required duty cycle of the PWM waveform. In addition, the battery voltage
is monitored to detect when the engine
has started.
Basically, the circuit detects when
the battery voltage rises above its normal resting voltage with the engine is
off. This rise occurs when the engine
is started and the alternator begins
charging the battery. In practice, the
battery voltage can vary from around
12.5V with the engine off to more than
14V when the battery is charged.
As shown in Fig.11, the battery voltage is measured using a voltage divider
comprising 20kΩ and 10kΩ resistors,
together with a 100nF capacitor to
filter out voltage spikes.
In operation, the impedance of the
sensor cell is constantly monitored
and as soon as it reaches 300Ω the
preheat is complete and power to the
heater is controlled to maintain this
value. Once the sensor has reached
operating temperature (780°C), the
pump control circuit begins to operate.
300 at 780°C
100
10
600
700
siliconchip.com.au
1100
1000
1200
Fig.9: this graph shows how the sensor cell impedance varies with
temperature. The change in Ip with temperature is about 4% per 100°C.
20 A
REFERENCE
CURRENT
5Vp-p (1.953kHz)
RB6
(IC1)
220nF
10k
AN10
(IC1)
TP11
(IC3a)
300
3.3V
684.5mVp-p
x4.7
+
SENSOR
CELL
AMPLIFIER
145.6mVp-p
Vs
Vs/Ip
SENSOR CELL IMPEDANCE MEASUREMENT
Fig.10: the temperature of the sensor cell is monitored by measuring its
impedance using the circuit configuration shown here.
+12V
+12V
H+
HEATER
ELEMENT
BATTERY
VOLTS
AN3
(IC1)
20k
H–
Circuit description
Refer now to Fig.12 for the complete circuit details. It’s based on a
PIC16F1507-I/P microcontroller (IC1)
and we have used nine of its 10-bit
analog-to-digital (A/D) converters and
three of its PWM outputs. It runs with
an internal 16MHz clock oscillator.
The remainder of the circuit consists
of a pressure sensor, Mosfet Q1 (to control the oxygen sensor heater), some
op amps and a few other components.
The op amps are rail-to-rail types
900
800
Temperature of Sensor Cell (°C)
RB7
(IC1)
10
22k
AN4
(IC1)
D
G
S
10 F
EARTH1
Q1
MOSFET
10k
100nF
0.1
EARTH2
HEATER CONTROL
Fig.11: the heater element is connected in series with a Mosfet (Q1) that
switches the power on and off at 120Hz. Temperature control is achieved
by driving the Mosfet with a PWM signal to vary its duty cycle.
June 2012 39
CON1
+12V
D1 1N4004
F1 5A
A
REG1 LM317T
10
K
100 F
16V
VR1
500
A
GND1
4
1
MCLR
Vdd
AN0
PWM4
10k
PWM1
MPX2010
PRESSURE SENSOR
IC2: LMC6484AIN
TP5V
19
100nF
15
1M
17
5
100nF
TP2
PRESSURE
PORT
VR2
10k
8
+5V
Q3
BC337
B
TP10
VR6
10k
PRESSURE
OFFSET
CON2
3
MPX2010
PRESSURE
SENSOR
12
TP9
9
4
7
2
1
INSTALL
ONLY FOR
TESTING
JP1
AN1
RA1
IC1
PIC16F1507
–I/P
AN6
TP8
RB6
2 6
RA5
AN10
RC4
D
Q1
IRF540N
10
G
S
0.1
5W
B
22k
10
16
RB7
K
A
D2
C
D4
100 F
K
14
220nF
11
62k
10k
20 A
13
20
6
TP11
100k
3
1
IC3a
K
470k
22pF
* CHANGES REQUIRED FOR O 2 ¯
IN AIR MEASUREMENTS (SEE
TEXT IN PT.2)
WIDEBAND OXYGEN SENSOR CONTROLLER
2
470k
LED1
A
SC
510 *
Vs
A
Vss
A
ZD2
15V
1W
K
D2-D4: 1N4148
2012
100nF
A
470
AN4
10 F
TPV–
D3
K
A
E
Q2
BC327
AN9
AN7
100nF
C
E 100 F
18
10k
100 F
AN8
THRESHOLD
VOLTAGE
1 2 3 4
Vs/Ip
11
10k
PWM3
VACUUM
PORT
10 F
150
7
IC2b
100nF
1k
3 2
AN3
4
5
6
+5V
H–
100nF
VR3
10k
10 F
20k
GND2
100nF
120
ADJ
K
ZD1
16V
1W
H+
+5V
OUT
IN
K
1N4004
A
K
ZD1, ZD2
A
K
Fig.12: the full circuit uses microcontroller IC1, several CMOS op amps (IC2-IC4), a Mosfet (Q1) to control the heater
in the oxygen sensor and a pressure sensor. The microcontroller and op amps monitor & control the wideband oxygen
sensor and drive the Wideband Display Unit. IC1 also provides a simulated narrowband output (via IC2c).
and comprise an LMC6484AIN quad
op amp (IC2) and two LMC6284AIN
dual op amps (IC3 & IC4). These have
a typical input offset of 110µV, a high
input impedance of more than 10
Teraohms (>10TΩ), a 4pA input bias
current, an output that can swing to
within 10mV of the supply rails with a
100kΩ load, and a wide common mode
input voltage range that includes the
supply rails.
40 Silicon Chip
Power for the circuit comes from an
external 12V supply, ie, the car battery.
The +12V rail is fed in via fuse F1 and
applied directly to the heater circuit
(via H+ at CON1). It’s also fed in via
reverse polarity protection diode D1
and applied to an LM317T adjustable
regulator (REG1) and to 12V regulator
REG2 (LM2940CT-12).
Fuse F1 will blow if the sensor is
connected when the supply polarity is
reversed. That’s because, in this situation, there’s a low-resistance current
path through the heater element and
the body diode in Q1.
Trimpot VR1 allows REG1’s output
to be set to exactly 5.00V. This rail
supplies microcontroller IC1 and op
amps IC2 and IC3. The +12V rail from
REG2 supplies IC4.
The battery voltage is measured at
the AN3 input of IC1 via a 20kΩ and
siliconchip.com.au
REG2
LM2940CT-12
IN
+12V
OUT
GND
3
1
IC2a
2
12
13
RING
TIP
SLEEVE
10
WIDEBAND
DISPLAY
OUTPUT
CON3
RING
TIP
150
8
IC2c
9
H–
150
14
IC2d
H+
10 F
(NOT
USED)
SLEEVE
CON4
SIMULATED
NARROWBAND
OUTPUT
TO
OXYGEN
SENSOR
CON5
3
Vs/Ip
2
1
+12V
4
8
Rcal
5
6
Vs
7
Ip
8
5
VR5 1k
7
IC4b
6
Rcal
4
62
TP3
Ip
22k
+5V
TP5
100nF
7
IC3b
4
TP7
560k*
5
8
22k
6
IC3, IC4:
LMC6482AIN
3.3nF
+5V
VR4
10k
3
100k
1
Vs/Ip
B
E
IC4a
G
C
D
D S
LM317T
LM2940CT-12
IRF540N
10kΩ voltage divider connected between the +12V input rail and 0V. This
divider reduces the applied voltage by
two thirds and results in a maximum
of +5V at the AN3 input for a battery
voltage of 15V (note: 5V is the upper
limit for analog-to-digital conversion
by IC1 for a maximum 10-bit digital
value of 1023).
Trimpot VR3 across the 5V rail
provides the 3.3V reference voltage
siliconchip.com.au
2
TP4
BC327, BC337
LED
Additional supply rails
TP6
560k
K
A
TP1
GND
IN
GND
OUT
This is necessary because zero pump
current is required during the sensor
heat-up period. It’s also necessary
when there is a fault in the sensor’s
heater element or the connection to it.
IC4b is driven from the PWM1
output of IC1 via a 10kΩ resistor and
100nF capacitor. These RC components filter the PWM output to produce
a steady DC voltage. The PWM signal
is output at 15.625kHz and its duty
cycle can be varied from 0-100% to
produce an effective DC voltage ranging from 0-5V.
IC1’s PWM4 and PWM3 ports (pins
15 & 17) provide the wideband and
narrowband signal outputs respectively, again using PWM control. As
shown, the PWM4 output is filtered via
a 10kΩ resistor and 100nF capacitor
and buffered with IC2d. The wideband
display output is then fed to CON3 via
a 150Ω resistor.
By contrast, the PWM3 output is filtered using a 1MΩ resistor and 100nF
capacitor to give a slower, smoothed
response that’s similar to the response
from a standard narrowband sensor.
This signal is buffered using IC2c
and fed to CON4 via a 150Ω isolating
resistor.
OUT
ADJ
OUT
IN
referred to earlier and this is buffered
by op amp IC2b. This op amp drives
one side of the pump cell, at the Vs/Ip
connection, via a 150Ω resistor which
isolates the op amp output. In addition, the Vs/Ip voltage is measured at
the AN0 input of the microcontroller
to ensure that the pump current can
be set to zero by applying the same
voltage (from the PWM1 output) to
pump drive buffer stage IC4b.
While IC2 & IC3 are provided with
a 5V supply, IC4 is a special case
because IC4b’s output is required to
swing from 0-5V to drive the pump
cell with current. To ensure this, IC4’s
positive supply rail needs to be more
than +5V and its negative rail needs
to be less than 0V.
As a result, REG2 is included to
provide a nominal 12V supply. This
supply is nominally 12V because the
regulator cannot deliver 12V unless
the input is just over 12V. If the input
voltage to REG2 is less than 12V, its
output falls accordingly.
This isn’t important since we only
want more than 5V for IC4 and REG2
is basically used to limit the positive
supply to +12V.
Transistors Q2 & Q3, diodes D2-D4
and their associated capacitors are
used to derive the negative supply rail
for IC4. This circuit is driven by the
RA1 output of IC1 which generates a
3.906kHz square-wave signal. Q2 &
Q3 buffer this signal and drive a diode
pump consisting of D2 & D3 and two
100µF capacitors.
This produces a negative supply rail
of -2.5V. Diode D4 clamps this rail to
June 2012 41
Parts List
1 PCB, code 05106121, 149 x 76mm
(availble from SILICON CHIP)
1 ABS box, 155 x 90 x 28mm (Altronics H0377)
1 MPX2010DP 10kPa temperature
compensated pressure sensor
(Sensor1; optional) (Jaycar ZD1094)
2 M205 PCB-mount fuse clips
1 5A M205 fuse (F1)
1 DIL20 IC socket
1 DIL14 IC socket
2 DIL8 IC sockets
2 PCB-mount 3.5mm stereo
switched jack sockets
1 4-way SIL socket strip (can be
cut from a DIP8 IC socket)
1 2-way PCB-mount screw terminals (5.04mm spacing)
1 3-way PCB-mount screw terminals (5.04mm spacing)
4 M3 x 5mm machine screws
4 M3 x 10mm machine screws
2 M3 x 15mm machine screws
5 M3 nuts
1 3-6.5mm IP65 cable gland
20 PC stakes
1 2-way pin header, 2.54mm pitch
1 jumper plug for pin header
1 100mm cable tie
1 70mm length of yellow medium
duty (2A) hookup wire
1 70mm length of red medium duty
(2A) hookup wire
1 70mm length of black medium
duty (2A) hookup wire
1 120mm length of green medium
duty (2A) hookup wire
1 150mm length of light blue heavy
duty (7.5A) hookup wire
1 4m length of green heavy duty
(7.5A) hookup wire
+0.6V when the negative supply generator is not working, ie, when IC1 is
not in circuit or if there is a fault in
the negative supply generator. Zener
diode ZD2 limits the total supply that
can be applied to IC4 to 15V.
Op amp IC3b is connected as a
differential amplifier to monitor the
voltage across the paralleled 62Ω and
Rcal resistors. It operates with gain of
25.45 as set by the 560kΩ and 22kΩ
feedback resistors. The 3.3nF feedback
capacitor rolls off high frequencies and
prevents amplifier instability.
IC3b’s output is referenced to the
Vs/Ip voltage (at +3.3V) by the 560kΩ
42 Silicon Chip
1 2.5m length of red heavy duty
(7.5A) hookup wire
1 140mm length of 3mm heatshrink
tubing (or 20mm yellow, 40mm
red, 40mm black, 40mm green)
Semiconductors
1 PIC16F1507-I/P microcontroller
programmed with 0510612A.hex
(IC1)
1 LMC6484AIN quad op amp (IC2)
2 LMC6482AIN dual op amps
(IC3,IC4)
1 LM317T adjustable regulator
(REG1)
1 LM2940CT-12 12V low-dropout
regulator (REG2)
1 IRF540N 100V 33A N-channel
Mosfet (Q1)
1 BC327 PNP transistor (Q2)
1 BC337 NPN transistor (Q3)
1 3mm red LED (LED1)
1 16V 1W zener diode (ZD1)
1 15V 1W zener diode (ZD2)
1 1N4004 1A diode (D1)
3 1N4148 switching diodes (D2-D4)
Capacitors
4 100µF 16V PC electrolytic
4 10µF 16V PC electrolytic
1 220nF MKT polyester
8 100nF MKT polyester
1 3.3nF MKT polyester
1 22pF ceramic
Resistors (0.25W, 1%)
1 1MΩ
1 1kΩ
2 560kΩ
1 510Ω
2 470kΩ
1 470Ω
2 100kΩ
3 150Ω
1 62kΩ
1 120Ω
3 22kΩ
1 62Ω
1 20kΩ
2 10Ω
4 10kΩ
1 0.1Ω 5W
Trimpots
1 500Ω multi-turn trimpot (3296W
type) (Code 501) (VR1)
4 10kΩ multi-turn trimpot (3296W
type) (Code 103) (VR2VR4,VR6)
1 1kΩ multi-turn trimpot (3296W
type) (Code 102) (VR5)
Sensor Parts
1 Bosch LSU 4.9 Broadband Oxygen sensor (Available from TechEdge
http://wbo2.com/lsu/sensors.htm part #17123, Bosch. Part # 0 258
017 123)
1 Bosch connector for LSU 4.9 sensor (Available from TechEdge http://
wbo2.com/cable/connkit.htm part #017025)
1 6-way sheathed and shielded lead with 2x7.5A wires for heater (Available
from TechEdge http://wbo2.com/cable/default.htm part #DIY26CBL;
includes 1 x 8-pin circular multi-pole line socket part #P8PIN)
1 8-pin circular multipole panel microphone plug connector (Available from
TechEdge http://wbo2.com/cable/connkit.htm part #S8PIN)
resistor between its pin 5 input and
the output of op amp IC2b. As a result,
when there is 0V across the 62Ω resistor, IC3b’s output sits at 3.3V.
Sensor cell voltage
Op amp IC3a monitors the sensor
cell voltage (Vs). As already noted,
IC3a is set so that when Vs is at 450mV,
its output is 2.5V.
To do this, trimpot VR4 provides an
offset voltage which is buffered using
op amp IC4a. A 2.5V setting means
that IC3a can swing symmetrically
above and below this level to drive
IC1’s AN10 input (pin 13). This voltage
swing allows an expanded measurement of any variation above or below
450mV from the sensor cell.
The reference current applied to the
sensor cell is derived via two series
resistors (62kΩ and 510Ω) between the
+5V supply rail and the Vs terminal of
the sensor cell (in the oxygen sensor).
When the controller is running and
measuring correctly, the Vs terminal
is at the Vs/Ip voltage (3.3V) plus the
450mV of the sensor cell.
The 62kΩ and 510Ω series resistors deliver the recommended 20µA
current to the cell. That current is
calculated as (5V - 3.3V - 450mV) ÷
siliconchip.com.au
(62kΩ + 510Ω) or 19.99µA. The actual
current does not affect the accuracy of
lambda measurement unless the current is reduced down to near zero or
is increased above 40µA.
Link setting
When installed, jumper JP1 ties
IC1’s RA5 (pin 2) input low. This selects a test mode for checking that the
sensor impedance is correct (ie, 300Ω).
In this mode, instead of the wideband output from IC2d providing
0-5V for lambda measurement, it
outputs a value that corresponds to
the impedance of the sensor cell.
Since this impedance depends on the
temperature of the sensor, it’s useful
for ensuring that part of the control
circuit is working and that the sensor
is not being overheated by exhaust gas
when installed in a vehicle.
Trimpot VR2 sets the threshold
voltage for “engine-started” detection.
This is so that the engine can blow
out any condensation in the sensor
before any electrical heating of the
sensor begins.
As stated previously, engine-started
detection is achieved by monitoring
the battery voltage. Typically, a 12V
lead-acid battery is below 12.9V when
the engine is off but rises above 12.9V
when the engine starts and the alternator begins charging.
In operation, the battery voltage is
compared with the threshold voltage
on TP2 (AN8 of IC1), as set by VR2.
This threshold voltage can be set anywhere from 0-5V, corresponding to a
battery voltage range of 0-15V.
Basically, the TP2 voltage is set
to 1/3rd the required engine-started
battery voltage. For example, if this
voltage is selected to be 13V, TP2 is
set at 4.33V.
When the wideband controller is
used as a portable air/fuel ratio measuring instrument, TP2 can be adjusted
to 4V or less. This will ensure that the
sensor is heated when power is first
applied. However, it also means that
the sensor MUST be protected from
moisture ingress and from physical
shock when not in use.
Heater current
Mosfet Q1 drives the sensor’s heater
with a DC voltage derived from a
122Hz PWM signal delivered from
IC1’s RB7 output (pin 10). The heater
current (and the Mosfet’s source current) is monitored via the AN4 input
siliconchip.com.au
at pin 16. That’s done by monitoring
the voltage across the 0.1Ω 5W resistor.
LED1 is the status LED. It’s driven
from the RC4 output of IC1 via a 470Ω
current-limiting resistor. As stated previously, it turns on when the sensor is
heating and then flashes rapidly once
the operating temperature is reached.
It flashes more slowly if there is a
sensor error or if the air/fuel ratio is
outside its measurement range.
Pin 4 of IC1 is the MCLR reset input.
It’s pulled high via a 1kΩ resistor and
ensures that IC1 is reset on power up.
Two grounds
Note that the circuit uses two
grounds. One (GND2) is for the heater,
while the other (GND1) is for the rest
of the circuit. These two grounds are
connected to the car chassis via separate wires.
Without this separate earthing, the
switching current applied to the heater
would cause inaccuracies in the measurements of voltage and current and
for the wideband output.
Pressure sensing
The pressure sensing circuit comprises the pressure sensor (Sensor1)
itself and offset trimpot VR6. The
specified sensor has differential pressure inputs and differential outputs.
These outputs are connected to AN7
& AN9 (pins 7 & 9) of IC1.
With a 5V supply, each output sits
at 2.5V when there is equal pressure
on each input port. Unequal pressures result in a differential output of
1.25mV per kPa, although the resolution of the pressure sensor readings
with a 10-bit A/D converter is about
3.9kPa (or 39hPa).
This resolution is sufficient to allow
Ip to be corrected to within 1%. The
highest pressure that we compensate
for is 587hPa (58.7kPa) above atmospheric, which gives a differential
sensor output of 73.38mV. The resulting correction, as determined by the
microcontroller, reduces Ip by 12% for
lean values and by 9% for rich values.
These corrections are in accordance
with the graph shown in Fig.8.
The pressure sensor is set up by
plugging (blocking) one of its differential air inlets to allow the sensor to
work as an absolute pressure (often
called “Gauge pressure”) sensor rather
than as a differential sensor. This is
best done when the sensor is located
at sea level, where the standard air-
This is the Bosch LSU 4.9 wideband
sensor that’s used in conjunction with
the Wideband Controller.
pressure of 1013hPa is available.
That way, the sensor will respond to
variations in pressure above and below
standard atmospheric pressure, giving
a positive output for pressures above
atmospheric and a negative output for
pressures below atmospheric.
If one input is plugged at higher
altitudes, the sensor output will be
referenced against the lower pressure
in the plugged inlet and the actual
output will be a positive value when
measuring standard atmospheric pressure instead of 0. In other words, the
pressure sensor output will be offset
according to the amount that the
plugged input is below atmospheric
pressure.
As a result, offset trimpot VR6 has
been included to counter this effect.
Basically, it allows the lower pressure
reading to be offset, not at the sensor
itself but in the way the sensor’s output
is mathematically manipulated by the
software.
In practice, VR6 is set to give a 1V
output per 1000m above sea level. For
a sea level setting, its output (TP10) is
set at 0V. At higher voltage settings,
IC1 provides compensation for the
approximate 11kPa drop in pressure
per 1000m in elevation above sea level.
Note, however, that this only applies
for elevations up to 2000m above sea
level, at which point the change in
pressure becomes non-linear. As a
result, we do not correct for pressure
offset above 2000m.
If the pressure sensor is not required, then the AN7 and AN9 inputs
must be tied to 0V and 5V respectively.
That will stop the AN7 and AN9 inputs
from floating and will also indicate to
IC1 that the sensor is not connected.
We show how these AN7 and AN9
inputs are tied to the supply rails in the
construction details to be published
next month. We’ll also publish the
SC
details for the display readout.
June 2012 43
SERVICEMAN'S LOG
Off on yet another wild goose chase
It’s always important to gather as much
information as possible from the customer
before starting a repair, otherwise it’s all too
easy to get involved in a wild goose chase.
Here’s a classic example of what can happen.
A
MUSICIAN FRIEND of a friend
recently contacted me, asking if
I would check out two PA/instrument
amplifiers that weren’t working properly. I replied that given the economic
climate here in Christchurch, I’d look
at anything!
Unfortunately, I wasn’t at the workshop when he dropped the amplifiers
off so I didn’t get to ask my usual
pointed questions. As any serviceman can tell you, asking the right
questions when the gear is brought in
can often save a lot of time and grief
further down the track. Of course, I
did get some of the background over
the phone but there were quite a few
questions remaining.
As for the units themselves, one
was a Rockit 150W 8-channel mixer/
amplifier combo which his band used
for the front-of-house vocal mix. The
other was a Jansen 440W bass guitar
amplifier. In most gigging bands, one
person typically ends up doing all the
PA-related set-up and in this band, the
44 Silicon Chip
job falls to the guy who dropped the
amplifiers off. He’s also the band’s bass
guitarist and apparently is the only one
who knows how to put it all together.
His descriptions of the amplifier
faults were a little on the vague side
though. He’d told me over the phone
that there were problems with both
amplifiers but didn’t go into great
detail. When he dropped them off,
he told my work colleague that the
Rockit’s monitor system had stopped
working and the bass amplifier sometimes squealed loudly when fired up.
In the end, I decided to call him to
find out more specifically what was
going on with the amplifiers. I also
wanted to ask if he had tried anything
to try to isolate the problems, such as
trying different cables and speakers
with the Rockit.
Unfortunately, after going through
this process, I wasn’t much the wiser.
He wasn’t sure what the monitor
problem with the Rockit was other
than that the drummer, parked as per
Dave Thompson*
Items Covered This Month
•
•
•
•
Rockit PA/instrument amplifier
Jansen PA/instrument amplifier
Faulty voltage/current calibrator
The ignorant customer and his
new 500GB hard drive
*Dave Thompson, runs PC Anytime
in Christchurch, NZ.
usual at the back of the stage, couldn’t
hear anything through his foldback
wedge. They hadn’t tried any other
cables or speakers and he had simply
assumed it was something to do with
the amplifier.
As for the bass amplifier, all he knew
was that sometimes he’d arrive at a
gig, plug everything in and when he
turned it on, he would get an alarmingly loud squeal through his “quad”
(a large bass speaker cabinet sporting
four 12 or 15-inch bass drivers). Given
this amplifier pumps out a hefty 440W
of low-end grunt, this type of fault
could pose serious consequences for
the amplifier’s output stages, not to
mention the speakers.
The first issue I faced was finding
suitable speakers with which to test
these amplifiers, as my workshop
“20-watters” are a touch on the small
side. With units like these, a power-on
thump can blow low-wattage voice
coils and/or leave the cones dangling
in the frames. Even if the volume is
kept to a minimum, a faulty amplifier can still send a nasty signal to the
speakers and I wasn’t about to risk it.
I ended up calling the band’s drummer and he offered to drop off a
foldback wedge, which sounded perfect (no pun intended!).
If I was going to blow speakers,
I may as well blow theirs!
Fortunately for me, the two
amplifiers were both made in
now-defunct Auckland factories in the mid-1980s and
were pretty much standard
siliconchip.com.au
fare. The Rockit used a transistor output stage (similar to
many of the kit-set power amplifiers of the day) while the
Jansen used a bank of Mosfets. Both used analog preamps
stuffed with op amps like the TL071 and RC4558 and
all other passive and discrete components were clearly
marked.
It certainly makes it easier when parts can be easily
identified, especially when circuit diagrams are hard to
find.
I fired the Rockit up first. To test amplifiers, I use my
trusty signal injector which I made from a SILICON CHIP
project many years ago. This was housed in a cylindrical
metal vitamin container and I mounted a push-to-make
switch on the plastic cover. A sharpened probe, salvaged
from an old multimeter lead, was mounted through a
hole drilled in the opposite end, while the earth lead was
brought out through a grommeted hole in the side of the
tube and terminated with an insulated crocodile clip.
The result is a very useful piece of test gear that can be
operated using just one hand.
Anyway, I connected a 6.3mm mono jack plug (the music world’s universal instrument input connector) with a
flying lead to one of the Rockit’s eight inputs, clipped the
crocodile clip of the signal injector to a ground point on
the chassis and set the channel and master volumes just
above the stops. I then touched the injector’s probe onto
the input lead connected to the jack plug and pressed
the button.
When I did this, a nice clean tone came from the speaker
so the amplifier chain was working OK and the volume
wasn’t high enough to frighten the daylights out of me.
All I had to do now was to figure out why the monitor
side of things wasn’t working.
Now whenever I get old units like this coming in for
repair, I always suspect that a solder joint has degraded
and formed a dry joint or perhaps a connecting wire might
have come adrift. These types of amplifiers are usually
very well built for the road but unlike their domestic
sit-in-the-lounge cousins, they tend to suffer some terrible abuse.
Indeed, I know from my own days of touring with five
other musos, travelling endlessly up and down the country
in a van stuffed with audio hardware, that the gear often
gets a very hard time. Unloading and reloading audio gear
before and after a gig is not exactly an enjoyable exercise
and the amplifiers and speakers tend to get the odd bit
of “road rash” now and then. This can play havoc with
physical connections and soldered joints.
Anyway, having established that the amplifier worked, I
unplugged it from the mains, removed the machine screws
holding the front and rear panels and slid the whole
kit-n-caboodle out of the road case (I love this method
of construction – everything is so easy to access). I then
set the two halves up on the bench and had a good look
over them, paying particular attention to interconnecting
cables and solder joints.
Now although I love a good electronics detective
mystery, the serviceman inside me is always looking for
a quick-and-easy fix rather than a drawn-out and ultimately uneconomical repair. There was no such luck in
this case – the interior of this amplifier looked pristine,
without so much as a spider’s web evident. In fact, the
components all looked as-new, despite pushing 30 years
siliconchip.com.au
NEW 4 Digit UP-DOWN Counter
Module with Preset Feature
The MXA069 (0-9999) UP/DOWN Counter features power drivers
to multiplex JUMBO LED displays, up to 10". Adding
more MXA069 increases the count capacity by
4 digits at a time. Hundreds of applications in
sport,traffic, automation and industrial control
Fully
Assembled
and Tested
Value!!!
$38.17 inc. GST
Plus
$7.50 Pack & Post
NEW 5 Channel Infra-Red Remote
Control Kit Set with Handpiece
Build your FK442 to control appliances, lighting, air-conditioning,
machinery and security systems. The 5 channel receiver
board is user-set to match the hand piece numeric
settings, and the relays can be set for momentary or
ON-OFF-ON control. Add up to 5 receiver boards
to control 30 x 500Watt relays
from a single point.
All Up!! $48.34 inc. GST
Single
Channel Kits
Available
Plus $7.50
Pack & Post
For details and to buy
on-line see us at:
www.kitstop.com.au
P.O. Box 5422 Clayton Vic.3168
Tel:0432 502 755
Radio, Television & Hobbies:
ONLY
the COMPLETE
00
$ 62
archive on DVD
&P
+$7 P
• Every issue individually archived, by month and year
• Complete with index for each year
• A must-have for everyone interested in electronics
This remarkable collection of PDFs covers every
issue of R & H, as it was known from the
beginning (April 1939 – price sixpence!)
right through to the final edition of R, TV
& H in March 1965, before it disappeared
forever with the change of name to
Electronics Australia.
For the first time ever, complete and in one
handy DVD, every article and every issue is covered.
If you're an old timer (or even young timer!) into vintage radio, it
doesn't get much more vintage than this. If you're a student of
history, this archive gives an extraordinary insight into the amazing
breakthroughs made in radio and electronics technology following
the war years. And speaking of the war years, R & H had some of the
best propaganda imaginable!
Even if you're just an electronics dabbler, there's something here to
interest you.
NB: Requires a computer with DVD reader to view
– will not work on a standard audio/video DVD player
Use the handy order form
on page 81 of this issue.
June 2012 45
Serr v ice
Se
ceman’s
man’s Log – continued
tion meant that there was nothing
wrong with the Rockit amplifier at all.
Instead, the problem was most likely
a dud speaker lead or a broken socket
in the main speaker and I decided to
check that out later.
After talking with the drummer, I offered to build him an active (powered
and amplified) foldback speaker. This
would take the monitor output from
the Rockit as intended and would enable him to control his own volume
and audio mix. He replied that this
was exactly what he’d been wanting
for the last 10 years but didn’t know
how to achieve it.
So at least something good came of
the whole Rockit affair. At the same
time, it also had a decent check-up and
they now know it will keep pumping
out the sounds for a while yet.
On to the Jansen
old and all the visible solder joints
appeared shiny and electrically sound.
Oh well; you win some and you
lose some.
As mentioned above, the rear section of these amplifiers usually carries
all the output sockets and this one was
no different. In this case, there are two
main speaker outputs, as well as an
echo/effects send/return loop, a monitor output for a foldback system and a
“slave” output for daisy-chaining this
amplifier to another power amplifier.
All these outputs are line-level outputs. In addition, the echo/effects loop
and monitor outputs have separate
controls on each channel to determine
how much signal from the preamp
stages is fed to the relevant system.
I plugged a pair of headphones into
the various output sockets and all appeared to be working as they should.
However, when I listened to the lowlevel monitor feed, alarm bells began
to ring (figuratively speaking that is).
The foldback speaker I was using
was one of their usual stage units.
However, there was no way this
line-level monitor output was going
to drive this speaker at any volume
without something else in the system
to boost the signal. I called the bass
player again and asked him if they had
another monitor amplifier somewhere.
46 Silicon Chip
He said they didn’t but I should ask the
drummer because he usually plugged
in his own monitor speaker (the one
I had at the workshop) and the bass
player wasn’t 100% certain how he
plugged it into the PA system.
Now at last we were starting to get
somewhere. The bane of a serviceman’s existence is misinformation
and it seems that I had been getting
the wrong end of the stick. A call to
the drummer confirmed that he didn’t
plug his monitor into the monitor
output of the PA amplifier but into a
bridged speaker socket on one of the
front-of-house speaker bins instead!
In practice, this made both more and
less sense. When wired up this way,
his foldback speaker was simply an
extension or slave speaker for one of
the main FOH (front-of-house) speakers. This meant that he was simply
hearing whatever mix was sent to FOH
speakers. However, this also explained
why he couldn’t alter the volume of
his monitor and why he got a lot of
feedback from that wedge, requiring
him to position it very carefully.
It turned out that just like the band
I was in, the left hand doesn’t always
know what the right hand is doing and
in hindsight I should have spoken to
everyone concerned as to the exact
system they used. This new informa-
With the Rockit affair out of the way,
I hoisted the Jansen amplifier onto the
bench. This sucker has a very large
power transformer, which makes it a
beast of a thing to carry around.
I powered it up numerous times
but couldn’t replicate the squealing
noise the bass player had reported. I
then pulled it apart and connected the
two halves back together on the bench
without the road case.
This amplifier was also quite tidy
inside, though a little dustier because
it had a cooling fan that sucked dust
in along with the cooling air. Considering this amplifier would have done
the majority of its work in smoke and
sweat-filled pubs and clubs over the
years, I was surprised not to find a
layer of nicotine-impregnated oil and
dirt coating every interior surface.
In fact, this type of contamination
sometimes makes working on sound
hardware a disgusting task.
As before, I checked all the usual
suspects and made sure the interconnecting cables and their connections
were secure and electrically sound.
It all seemed fine until I took a closer
look at the preamp board and immediately noticed a tiny sliver of metal
sitting between pins 1 & 2 on one of
the TL071 op amps.
A closer look through my trusty
magnifying glass confirmed it. If I
bumped the case, I could see the sliver
move, so it could easily be shorting out
pins 1 & 2 of the chip due to vibration.
I used a pair of tweezers to remove
the metal sliver and under the right
siliconchip.com.au
The faulty voltage/current calibrator
A. L. from Turramurra, NSW went
bargain hunting in Singapore but got
more than he bargained for. Here’s
his story . . .
Last year, my wife, daughter and
I had a holiday in Singapore. While
we were there, my wife and daughter decided to take off one day for
some bargain shopping. Having been
caught on these expeditions before, I
said that I would do the same thing
only with electronic bargains, so I
headed straight for Sim Lim Tower
then Sim Lim Square which is diagonally opposite.
The “Tower” is a rather strange
place and has several floors of small
shops, each of which specialises in
a certain line. For example, there
are shops selling just capacitors –
everything from SMD miniatures to
giant, oil-filled, multi-kilovolt jobs.
I bought a few kilograms of some
large electrolytic capacitors and
high-voltage capacitors very cheaply
indeed!
Other shops specialise in audiovisual parts, switches or just connectors and I also bought a few kilos
of these, as well as some hard-to-get
items.
I also checked out one of my
favourite shops on the third floor
which specialises in electronic tools.
I had bought a couple of instruments
there once before and have been very
happy with them.
This time around, they had two
voltage/current calibrators in the
window which looked like value for
money and so I asked the proprietor
which one he considered the best. He
told me that “cheap one only works
sometimes but this one is OK!” and
so we checked it out on a couple of
multimeters and it performed well.
And so after some customary
bargaining, I purchased it and took
it back to the hotel.
The brand is a Victor 04 Voltage/
mA source but I have seen the same
thing on the internet under different names and sure enough, it is
made in China. It looks much like
an electronic multimeter but instead
of measuring voltage or current, it
delivers a very accurate voltage or
current so that you can check and
siliconchip.com.au
calibrate your multimeters.
For example, you can set the
output voltage anywhere from 1mV
to around 8V with an accuracy of
0.5mV. It can also provide a constant
current ranging from 0.001mA to
22mA to allow current calibrations.
Overall it is a very handy tool because just like us, most multimeters
suffer from heat exposure, vibrations,
moisture or being dropped. They can
wander quite a bit with age too!
On returning home, I checked all
my multimeters and two of them
went straight into the quarantine
box because they were significantly
out of whack by over 1V DC! I also
checked it against my 8-digit Agilent
3458A bench multimeter and sure
enough, the calibrator was very accurate!
Some weeks later, I decided to use
the instrument to check and calibrate
DC measurements on an oscilloscope. I hooked it up but I couldn’t
get any stable readings so I checked
it against the bench multimeter and
also couldn’t get anything stable. So
it looked like the unit had developed
a fault during the period it had been
left unused.
Not having any sort of international guarantee and not intending
to return to Singapore in the near
future, I decided to see if I could fix
it myself. First, I checked the manual
for some sort of fault-finding table
but all I found was: “A note stands
to remind the user that he misunderstand the correct operation of the
calibrator and its characteristics”.
They stand in pretty good judgement of me on that issue!
And as for any disassembly instructions, it states that “no-one is
allowed to remove the split case
except professionals”,
Well, so much for the manual. But
I think I qualify as a professional
case splitter!
Changing the battery made no
difference and I almost feared that
the instruments under test were
faulty. I then noticed that jiggling the
calibrator’s leads and holding them
upright seemed to fix the problem,
so I decided to remove the leads
and replace them with known good
ones. However, when I pulled out the
common (negative) lead, the internal
spigot came free of the circuit board!
On splitting the case, it was pretty
obvious that the soldering was poor.
It had a dry “crystalline” appearance
and no strength at all. So as accurate
and well-designed as these instruments are, they leave something to be
desired in the quality-control department when it comes to the soldering.
After “sweating” the spigot back
in place with a hot iron and also
re-soldering the other three spigots,
the calibrator performed faultlessly.
In short, it was an easy fix but it was
unexpected in such a new instrument. Indeed, it would be very rare to
see anything like this happen with a
well-known brand, so bargain shopping has it risks.
Having got the unit working again,
I decided to put it to use. One multimeter that was significantly way
out on its DC voltage readings was a
Jaycar QM-1324. I’d had it for some
time and it had had a pretty rough
life in the tool box.
When I opened it up, I found that
six adjustments were visible, these
being labelled VR1-VR6. Without
knowing which preset did what, my
approach here was to connect the
calibrator, set its output voltage to
3.000V and then very gently adjust
each of the presets to see if the reading changed.
On the DMM’s 20V range, the initial reading was 4.20V but adjusting
VR3 made no difference so I returned
it to its original position. VR2 gave
the same result but VR1 allowed me
to adjust the reading to show exactly
3.00 volts
Then, leaving VR1 alone, I tried
the same thing with other measurements with the following results:
VR2 = °C, VR4 = inductance, VR5
= capacitance. These ranges were
calibrated against an accurate LCZR
instrument and so the Jaycar multimeter was given a new life.
Finally, most brand new multimeters that I’ve checked are accurate
to ±2mV when fitted with fresh
batteries. So if you buy one from a
reputable supplier, you can check/
calibrate your multimeter against it
without having to spend hundreds
of dollars on a calibrator. Just make
sure you don’t knock it or drop it!
June 2012 47
Serr v ice
Se
ceman’s
man’s Log – continued
light and magnification could see that
it was a curved piece of swarf. Just
where this might have come from is
a bit of a puzzle as there are no case
screws or mounting points anywhere
near this chip (metal swarf can sometimes be produced when case screws
are overtightened).
The chip was in the active cross
over section of the circuit and all the
evidence made sense. I looked over
the rest of the boards for more foreign
objects and finding none, buttoned it
all back up.
The guy has had the amplifier back
for a while now and I haven’t heard
anything during that time. So apparently that was it.
The ignorant customer
All technicians have to deal with
self-righteous, uninformed (read ig-
norant) customers on occasions. G. R.
of Mosgiel, NZ recently encountered
one such customer . . .
I often wonder why some people
insist on doing their own computer
repairs or upgrades when they really
don’t know what they are doing.
Last week, I sold a 500GB IDE
hard-drive to a guy via eBay and as
soon as he got it, he began complaining via both email and feedback that
the drive did not work. Now, I knew
that it did work. What’s more, it had
been supplied zero-fill formatted in an
anti-static bag with a silica-gel sachet,
complete with a printed report.
Unfortunately, the customer kept
demanding his money back and
seemed to be totally convinced that I
had ripped him off.
After a bit of investigation and
advice via email, such as telling him
Servicing Stories Wanted
Do you have any good servicing stories that you would like to share in The Serviceman column in SILICON CHIP? If so, why not send those stories in to us? In doesn’t
matter what the story is about as long as it’s in some way related to the electronics
or electrical industries, to computers or even to car electronics.
We pay for all contributions published but please note that your material must
be original. Send your contribution by email to: editor<at>siliconchip.com.au
Please be sure to include your full name and address details.
48 Silicon Chip
how to find disk-manager and how to
quick-format the drive, he still insisted
that the machine would not work and
that Windows would not even start.
So where to start? Perhaps his motherboard’s BIOS had a problem with
large-capacity drives, so I asked him
to return the drive and to bring along
his computer as well. This would enable me to see if I could work out what
was going on.
The customer lived nearby and
eventually, after some persuasion,
agreed to do this. However, he was
still insisting on his money back, as
I would not be able to make it work
either – or so he thought.
He arrived the next day with the
computer box under his arm. I immediately saw that it was a small-formfactor (SFF) box, which rang alarm
bells. When I opened it up, I found
that he had installed the new drive
correctly but because it is an SFF box,
it only has one drive-bay. This meant
that he had removed the original drive
– the system drive – in order to install
the new one but had neglected to then
reinstall the operating system.
It was obvious that he didn’t have
a clue that this was even necessary.
Instead, he simply complained to me
that the machine would no longer boot
up and was convinced that I had sold
him a dud. Sheesh . . .
Fortunately, he had brought the
old drive with him, so I reinstalled it
and sent him away with a USB-IDE
adapter for the new drive and then
he was happy.
So are you ready for the kicker? He
earlier told me on the phone that he
had already taken it to a technician
and he couldn’t make the drive work
either!
Frankly, I don’t believe him. No
technician worth his salt would miss
something as simple as that, no matter whether the drive was internal or
external. I think that he just blatantly
lied to me about that in an attempt to
get the upper hand.
As I say, some people should realise
their limitations and not attempt to
do their own upgrades. The annoying
thing is, they are always adamant that
they are in the right and that you are
in the wrong. Not only that but you
are also a rip-off artist.
It gets my hackles up when uninformed customers behave like that and
try to tell you your job when they don’t
know what they are talking about. SC
siliconchip.com.au
Child Monitor/General Surveillance System
Keep an eye on a room full of children and pan across to zoom onto any one of
them, or monitor swimming pool, retail showroom, or factory. You can remotely
pan or tilt the camera or even zoom in for a closer look.
• 2.4GHz DIGITAL Wireless transmission • 4 separate channels
• Includes power adaptor for both units
• 100m transmission range
• Size: Camera: 112(W) x
• 2.4" LCD monitor screen
• CMOS image sensor (640 x 480 pixels) 109(D) x 133(H)mm
$
00
Monitor: 68(W) x
• 2 times digital zoom
26(D) x 149(L)mm
QC-3638 Was $299.00
SAVE $100
Spare 2.4GHz PTZ Digital Camera QC-3637 $99.00
JUNE
CRAZY
199
1.3MP Wireless IP Camera
5Ch DMX LED Light Controller
View live camera footage on your iPhone® or
computer from anywhere there is Internet access.
Free management software for PC, iPhone® and
AndroidTM phones, view up to 16 network cameras
simultaneously via the PC software. Easy
to install and features motion triggered
snapshots and pre/post-recording.
Compact 5 channel
controller creates
colourful scenes and
amazing lighting
effects. A good all
round controller giving strobe and basic
dimming effects. Features six selectable modes with a
combination of RGB colour mixing,
fading, chasing and sound control.
NEW
CLEARANCE
8995
$
• 9V plugpack included
• Size: 252(L) x 122(W) x 46(H)mm
SL-3423
NEW STORE- TUGGERAH NSW
Check out our
range of crazy
clearance lines
in-store!
118 Pacific
Highway
NSW 2259
Ph: (02) 4353 5016
Lots of Parking
Available!
True RMS CAT IV Digital
Multimeter - IP67 Rated
Measures up to 1,000 volts AC & DC and is rated to
Cat IV 600. The meter includes temperature and
capacitance ranges, as well as peak-hold
and min/max options. Water and dustproof (IP67) and features a double
moulded case. Includes K-type
thermocouple.
149
$
00
• 4000 count
• True RMS
• Backlight, data hold
• Size: 182H) x 82(W) x 55(D)mm
QM-1543
Motion Activated Outdoor
Camera with Flash
A weather resistant outdoor camera suitable for surveillance
around the home, office or warehouse, or for wildlife
applications. The PIR sensor with 5-zones for wide angle
detection triggers the 7MP camera for colour photos and
videos by day or monochrome by night. Night vision is assisted
using the bright IR flash, which illuminates objects up to 15
metres away. Photos and videos up to 90 seconds long are
recorded to its 32MB internal memory or
NEW
an SD Card (available separately) for
more storage. Playback the vision
$
00
with audio on the integrated 2.4"
colour LCD screen.
189
• Video resolution: VGA
640 x 480 30fps
• Power: 4 x D and 3 x C
batteries required
• Size: 192(L) x 104(W)
x 90(H)mm
QC-8036
ED JU
IT NE
IO
N
Pr
ice
va
lid
un
til
23
/0
6/
20
12
40A Laboratory Power Supply
A high powered
switchmode power
supply with variable
current output from
1 to 16VDC and
variable voltage from 0 to
40A. Features dual action (coarse/fine)
microprocessor controlled rotary encoder tuning for
smooth, precise and fast settings, 3 user defined
voltage and current presets, and intelligent fan
cooling control. See website for features and
specifications.
399
• High RFI immunity and
$
00
excellent EMI
• Overload, short circuit, over
temperature and tracking over voltage protected
• Size: 200(W) x 90(H) x 215(L)mm
MP-3094
80 Ch Rechargeable 0.5W
UHF Transceiver
Features a built-in LED torch whilst out in the bush.
It does all the normal CB functions and includes
desktop charging cradle, AC adaptor, two
transceivers and batteries.
NEW
• 80 channel
• Power output: 0.5W
$6995
• Up to 3km range
• Up to 30 hours battery life
DC-1009
2W 80 Channel UHF Transceiver
with CTCSS function NEW DC-1049 $99.95
To order call 1800 022 888
• Sends motion detected snapshots
to email and FTP
• Resolution: SXVGA (1280 x 960) at 30fps
• Power supply included
• Size: 78(H) x 68(W) x 27(D)mm
$
QC-3830
12900
7-in-1 Solar Rechargeable
Station Kit
Kit
for Kids
Teaches children the ways of
powering and charging a
vehicles. Assembled into a
recharging station and can be
NEW
transformed into a truck. Comes with all
the snap together plastic parts required $
2495
(no need for glue), a solar panel, micro
rechargeable battery and all the other accessories.
• Recommended for ages 8+
• Size (charging truck): 105(L) x 55(W) x 41(H)mm
KJ-8964
Speed Control Kit for Induction Motors
Ref: SC Magazine Apr/Mar 2012
Control induction motors* up to 1.5kW (2HP) to run machinery at
different speeds or controlling a pool pump to save money. Also
works with 3-phase motors. Full form kit includes case, PCB,
hardware and electronics. See website for
full features and specifications.
KC-5509
NEW
*Note: Does not work
$22900
for motors with
centrifugal switch
Kit will vary from one pictured here.
Mini DVR and Bullet
Camera Package
Record and re-live the thrills of your action sports.
Mount the camera and screen on your body, helmet
or handlebars, then record video and audio to the
256MB built-in memory or to an SD memory card
(1GB - 32GB, not included). Playback on the 2.5"
colour screen or output to a larger screen using the
AV output. Recharge via USB or using the supplied
AC mains charger.
• Colour CMOS camera
(curly cord extends to 1m)
• Video Format: AVI (MPEG-4)
• Camera size: 60(L) x 14(D)mm
Monitor/Recorder: 75(W)
$19900
x 55(H) x 20(D)mm
SAVE $70
QC-8015 Was $269.00
www.jaycar.com.au
HARDCORE ELECTRONICS
Phase Coupler Module
Industrial IP66 Stainless Steel
Enclosure
Connects three mains phases with each
other so that transfer rates of up to 200
MB via the mains supply can be reached
for internet and networking (depending on
the nature of the mains supply). Suitable
for wireless intercoms.
$
00
• Voltage rating: 100 - 440VAC
$
• Size: 72(L) x 50(W) x 28(H)mm
SAVE 10
AA-0268 Was $49.00
A foam rubber seal inside the lid protects against
dust and moisture giving the
enclosure an IP66 rating.
An internal mounting
flange 15mm above
the base has a row of
M5 bolt holes for
easily securing your
project in place.
• Heavy duty enclosure
• Wall thickness: 1.5mm
• Size (Overall): 150(W) x
150(H) x 85(D)mm
HB-6413
89
$
95
FREE
ABS Enclosure
(HB-6410)
valued at
$12.95
39
NOTE:This product must be installed
by a licensed electrical contractor.
Ask for our 2-page
CRAZY CLEARANCE
FLYER instore or
download from
our website.
• 10 way
• Size: 95(L) x 85(W) x 36(H)mm
SZ-2008
Fuses not included
NEW
• Rated up to 32V AC or DC. Terminal studs 8mm
1995
Bolt-Down Fuse 125A
SF-1982 $9.95
Bolt-Down Fuse 250A
SF-1984 $9.95
Bolt-Down Fuse 500A
SF-1986 $9.95
High Current Fuse Holder
SF-1980 $19.95
Weather Proof Fuse Block
with LED Indicators
Perfect for marine application,
keeping fuse and wiring connections
well protected from corrosion. Each
fuse socket has an LED indicator to
give you quick indication of blown fuses,
and there are also a number
of slots to fit spare fuses.
2495
Contains around 120 standard
size automotive fuses housed in
a 6 compartment storage box.
• 20 x 5A, 10A, 15A, 20A, 25A
& 30A fuses included
SF-2142
23
$
95
IP67 True RMS Autoranging
Cat IV DMM
Features a large, easily read display
and IP67 rating, making it waterproof.
• True RMS
• Cat IV, 600V, 4000 count
• Data hold & relative function
• Auto off & backlit display
• Diode test & audible continuity
• 10A current
range
$
95
QM-1549
79
2
NEW
1295
$
SMD Tantalum Capacitors
• Mixed - pack of 30
• 20 values
RZ-6618
NEW
1295
$
SMD Voltage Regulators
From
995
$
Self-Powered LED Panel Meters
• 10 way
• Size: 125(W) x 89(H) x 47(D)mm
Fuses not included.
Shown without cover.
SZ-2001
NOTE: Products above are available early June.
Automotive Fuse Pack
• Mixed - pack of 50
• 20 values
RE-5959
• Mixed - pack of 30
• 8 types
ZV-1616
NEW
1795
$
NEW
$
SAVE $10
SMD Electrolytic Capacitors
Commonly used for battery and alternator
connections and other heavy gauge cables requiring
ultra high current protection. SF-1982 and SF-1984
are slow blow fuses; SF-1986 is a short-circuit
protection device.
$
$
See website for list of component values.
• Ideal for prototyping
Ultra High Current Fuses
Features a common supply rail and
includes a removable protective cover
and LED indicators for each fuse. Perfect
for automotive or marine applications.
4495
• Size: approx. 87(L) x 60(W) x
32(H)mm
AA-0347 Was $54.95
SMD Components Bulk Packs
www.jaycar.com.au/JUNEclearanceAU
10 Way Blade Fuse Block
with LED Indicators
12VAC Motor & Lamp Controller
Controls the speed of 12VAC motors and can also be
used as a dimmer for incandescent lamps.
With the addition of a rectifier, it
can also be used to control DC
motors and if you add a 100k or
200k pot, you can control 24 or
48V devices. Suitable for iron core
transformers only.
Simple and easy to install self-powered meters with
voltage or current display. The voltmeter has a simple
2-wire connection, and the current meter has 4-wire
connection with an included current shunt.
• Auto zero calibration
• Easy to read red LED display
• Cut-out size 42 x 23mm
From
2495
$
LED Voltmeter 8 - 30V DC
QP-5586 $24.95
LED Ammeter 0 - 50A DC
QP-5588 $39.95
Note: When connecting the ammeter QP-5588 it is
essential that the wiring instructions provided with
the product are followed, or the meter may be destroyed.
Fast Acting Cartridge Fuses For use in Multimeters
Used in many well-known
multimeters. Designed for
use in circuits with high
AC fault current capacity.
600V 15A (suits Fluke) SF-2274
600V 1A (suits Fluke) SF-2276
$17.95
$8.95
Spare ferrule fuses for our IP67 CATIV rated DMMs:
1000V 10A
SF-2277 $14.95
1000V 500mA
SF-2278 $9.95
1000V 800mA
SF-2279 $9.95
To order call 1800 022 888
Cat IV Fixed Jaw Clampmeter
The ideal test instrument for electrical contractors.
Compact and light with probe storage in the back for
easy one-handed operation. Jaw opening is 16mm.
• 2000 count
• CATIV 600V, CATIII 1000V
$
00
• Non-contact voltage sensor
• Data hold, auto off
$90
SAVE
• Diode test
• Audible continuity test
• Size: 190(H) x 62(W) x 42(D)mm
QM-1567 Was $179.00
89
Limited stock. Not available online.
Soldering Station with
Digital Display
Precision, Japanese manufactured instrument with excellent
temperature stability and anti-static characteristics. It has a
digital temperature adjustment from 200 to 480°C at 65W
and a lightweight
soldering pencil.
See website
or catalogue
for full
specifications.
• Power: 70W
• ESD Safe
• Size: 146(L) x
115(W) x 98(H)mm
TS-1440 Was $299.00
24900
$
SAVE $50
All savings based on Original RRP. Limited stock on sale items.
Prices valid until 23/06/2012.
METERS, TESTERS & TOOLS
2.7GHz Digital Frequency Counter
This unit is a 10Hz to 2.7GHz dual range frequency counter
for measuring functions of frequency, period totals and self
checking. The counter readout has a large 10mm high
intensity 7 segment LED display with gate time and data
hold function. Decimals are
also included as well
as a single step input
attenuation to a factor
of 20 and a low pass
filter.
• 8 digit LED
• Mains powered
• Size: 230(W) x 210(H) x 76(D) mm
QT-2202 Was $169.00
12900
$
SAVE 40
$
Electrical Tester with Polarity
Checking and Light
Designed for maximum safety. Good grip
probes and are IP64 rated. It checks for low
impedance, continuity, do a single pole
phase test and show rotary field
indication. A LED
$
95
light is included for
dimly lit locations.
SAVE $10
• Cat III 1000V/Cat
IV 600V rated for safety
• Powered by 2 x AAA batteries (included)
• Size: 240(H) x 78(W) x 40(D)mm
QP-2286 Was $49.95
39
Pressure Differential Sensor
The piezo resistive pressure sensor provides a
very accurate and linear voltage output
directly proportional to the applied
pressure. The sensor housed a single
monolithic silicon die with a strain gauge
and thin film resistor network on each chip.
• 0°C to 85°C temperature compensation
• 0 to 10kPa (0 to 1.45 PSI)
• 25mV full scale span
$
ZD-1904
See website for datasheet.
3995
LED Laboratory Magnifier Lamp
Included is an extension pole that transforms it from a
desk top unit into a floor standing unit, also included is
a detachable desk-mounting
clamp. Can be powered with
the included plugpack or 4 x
C size batteries.
• 20 high-brightness LEDs
$5900
• 2 dioptre magnification
• 1200mm floor mode height
SAVE $20
• 600mm desk mode height
• Base size: 310(L) x 230(W)mm
QM-3542 Was $79.00
Micro Sound Level Meter
With a range of 40 - 130dB, this meter is ideal for
environmental, safety and sound system
testing. It has a fast response time for
transient measurements
$
95
and is A-weighted for
the frequency range of
$10
SAVE
human hearing.
29
• Frequency range: 31.5Hz - 8kHz
• Accuracy: ± 3.5dB <at> 1kHz
• Size: 150(L) x 55(W) x 32(D)mm
QM-1591 Was $39.95
Heavy Duty Terminal Crimper
Crimp lug/eye terminals onto heavy gauge power
cables. Lever arm action for solid
NEW
hex crimp. Features a built-in
rotating die which can be
$
95
rotated to suit terminals for
2
6/10/16/25/35/50mm cable
(10AWG-1/0AWG).
49
• 450mm long
TH-1849
Modular Crimp Tool
This great tool will cut, strip and crimp flat telephone
cable, or Cat5e type
cable as well.
Constructed from
high quality carbon
steel and features
interchangeable dies and
ergonomic design.
3995
$
• 4P/6P/8P/10P
TH-1936
6 Piece Insulated Electronic
Screwdriver Set
Contains all the smaller sizes you
need for working on electronic
gear. They have ergonomic
handles with excellent non-slip
grips. Storage case included.
• 1000V rated
• Case size: 192(L) x
130(W) x 26(H)mm
TD-2026
This kit contains a
Portasol Pro Piezo Gas
Soldering Iron, and all of
the following parts.
• Quality storage case,
cleaning sponge and
tray, 2.4mm double flat
FREE
tip, hot air blow, hot
200gm roll of Solder
knife tip, hot air
(NS-3005 or NS-3010)
deflector, flame tip
valued at $10.95
TS-1318
12900
$
Cable Staple Gun
Take the pain out of cable installation.
Simply staple the cable to eaves,
rafters or joists. The staples
have an integral plastic cable
clamp that holds the cable
firmly in place.
• Includes heavy duty die
cast gun, 3 interchangeable
blades and 200 staples
in a carry case
TH-2615
Was $49.95
2995
$
SAVE $20
Autoranging SMT DMM
Specifically designed for SMT work
with interchangeable probes and
tweezer probes.
1995
$
Logic Tester
Quality logic probe that will test all logic families
(TTL, LS, CMOS, etc). Pulse/normal switch
indicates pulse or continuous signals. Three
LEDs provide the logic level indication. Detects
pulse widths.
• 6000 count
• CAT III 600V
• Autoranging
• Continuity test
• Auto power-off
• SMT probes
• Size: 110(H) x
36(W) x 21(D)mm
QM-1496 Was $69.95
3995
$
SAVE $30
Cat III Dynamo-Powered DMM
• Working voltage:
4 - 16VDC
QT-2210 Was $29.95
19
$
95
SAVE $10
Pro High Temperature
Non-Contact Thermometer
Measure high temperatures with safety.
Suitable for lab, furnace, forge and
small-scale foundry work. The laser
pointer allows for accurate
placement of the measurement
point and the 30:1 distance-totarget ratio allows for accurate
measurement from greater
distances.
Better, More Technical
Just crank the handle for 10 seconds to provide
power for approx 10 minutes operation. Ideal for
electrical emergencies on the car or boat.
• 4000 count
• No batteries required
• Data hold
• 10A current
• Size: 152(L) x
78(W) x 45(D)mm
QM-1547 Was $79.95
3995
$
SAVE $40
Rechargeable Solar DMM
• Temperature range:
-50 - 1000°C (-58 - 1832°F)
• Built-in laser pointer
$
00
• Size: 230(L) x 100(H) x
56(W)mm
SAVE $30
QM-7226 Was $189.00
159
Digital for
an analogue
price!
Portasol Pro Gas Soldering
Tool Kit
An environmentally friendly DMM with
rechargeable batteries that can be charged
from the built-in solar panel, 12-36VDC or
from mains power.
Never have to buy
$
00
batteries again.
69
• Cat III 600V
SAVE $50
• 2000 count
• Size: 179(H) x
88(W) x 39(D)mm
QM-1546 Was $119.00
www.jaycar.com.au
3
SOUND & VISION
Economy USB Digital TV Stick
Digital TV on your PC for under fifty bucks and a
bundle of extra features including
Picture-in-Picture, still and video
image capture and much more.
Easy to install.
• Digital TV and radio
program recording
• Real-time video
recording
• One-touch channel scan
• Multi-lingual installation
XC-4888 Was $34.95
29
$
95
SAVE $5
IPTV Internet Digital TV Tuner
Watch your favourite TV shows and schedule
recordings from anywhere in the world. Time
shifting and scheduled recording are also
supported so you can pause
and rewind live TV. See
website for more details
XC-4861 Was $169.00
99
$
00
Program up to 8 devices in a home
entertainment system using the learning
function or pre-programmed code library.
The LCD backlight is colour
coded for easy recognition
on each device and key
layout can be customise.
1995
$
A nifty MP3 player module to build
into a car or home audio project.
Requires 5VDC (via USB port or
straight to PCB), and a USB flash
drive or SD Card with MP3 files. Features
aluminium front panel and bright red LED display.
• Includes slim IR remote
• Size: 75(W) x 49(H) x 46(D)mm
3995
$
SAVE $20
Ideal for any audio
enthusiast that enjoys
building and modifying
speaker systems. The preassembled PCB is tiny which allows you
to incorporate it into a wide variety of speaker systems.
• 15W per channel continuous
• Regulated 12VDC 2000mA required
• Size: 68(L) x 32(W)mm
AA-0228
2995
$
IR Over Cat 5
Extender/Repeater Kit
Control AV source equipment up to a distance of 250
metres away with existing IR remote controls over Cat
5 cable. The IR remote signals are piped down the Cat
5 cable for full control at the remote location. Extender,
repeater, mains plugpack and emitters included.
11900
$
SAVE $30
• Up to 30m range
• Size: 105(W)
x 150(D)
x 38(H)mm
AR-1840
NEW
1495
$
SD Digital Set-Top Box with
Recording Output
Enjoy more channels, extra
features and clearer
reception on your analogue
TV. Features USB port for AV
recording as well as playback.
• Driver diameter: 42mm
• Power handling: 120mW
• Nominal impedance: 64 ohms
AA-2065 Was $99.00
7900
$
SAVE $20
Compatible with any device that
features a 3.5mm headphone socket
such as iPods®, MP3 players, PDAs,
portable games and
computers. It comes
with a USB connection to
recharge the built-in battery.
995
$
• Size: 25(W) x 25(H) x 25(D)mm
XC-5178 Was $19.95
SAVE $10
Portable DAB+/FM
Radio with Earphones
Never miss your favourite radio stations
while you run, cycle or commute. Provides
excellent reception and crystal clear
digital sound. Equipped with a standard
FM radio and requires
2 x AAA batteries.
$
00
59
2495
$
Fine-tune your listening experience with this HDMI
Volume Leveller. It sorts out those annoying
fluctuations in volume while channel surfing
or between the TV shows themselves and
the advertisements. Protects your valuable
home theatre equipment from
the damaging noise spikes.
To order call 1800 022 888
Affordable professional headphones
that offers outstanding performance.
Provides accurate, linear sound
reproduction to cater for the most
demanding monitoring applications.
Comes with comfortable ear
cushions to provide hours
of fatigue-free listening.
• Earphones included
$
• Size: 68(L) x 38(W) SAVE 40
x 21(H)mm
AR-1754 Was $99.00
Audio Signal Volume Leveller
• Regulates TV, satellite, radio
and DVD volume
• Mains power supply included
• HDMI in/out ports
• Size: 100(W) x 64(D) x 23(H)mm
AC-1615 Was $149.00
19
Mini Rechargeable USB
Keychain Speaker
BUY a Spare
Receiver (AR-1841)
for only $30 with
every purchase of
AR-1840
SAVE $49
• DVB-T/MPEG-2 compatible
• Standard definition
• Size: 189(W) x 40(H) x 117(D)mm
XC-4912
Spare remote XC-4911 $7.95
• Requires 1 x AAA battery
• 3.5mm input and output jack
• LED light activation
NEW
• Size: 55(L) x 23(W)
$
95
x 14.5(H)mm
AA-0407
Pro Monitor Headphones
MP3 Player Module with
Remote Control
9900
Class-T Digital Audio
Amplifier Module
4
NEW
Easily share audio and video
signals from your cable TV or
Blu-ray player with this
wireless device. The powerful
5.8GHz transmitter and receiver
provide excellent picture and audio
quality so you can enjoy your movies
or TV shows anywhere in the house $
without interruption.
Touchscreen 8-in-1 LCD
Remote Control
• Input: 1 x IR receiver
• Output: 1 x Cat 5, 5 x IR extender
• Power supply: 5VDC, 500mA
• Size: 62(L) x 50(W) x 23(H)mm
AR-1826 Was $149.00
• Supports MicroSD card
• USB recharge cable
included
• Size: 91(W) x 54(H) x 20(D)mm
AR-1738
Watch Cable TV All
Over The House
NOTE: Time shifting requires Vista
• Requires 4 x AAA batteries
• Size: 195(L) x 65(W) x 21(H)mm
AR-1728 Was $59.95
Amplify the sound to exactly how you’d like
it. Simply connect to headphones of an MP3
player and experience higher quality bass
on the go. Designed for high impedance
and low sensitivity headphones.
A compact, portable mini FM
radio with built-in MP3 player.
Includes rechargeable Li-ion
battery. Charge via USB.
AA-0229
SAVE $70
Portable Headphone Amplifier
USB Rechargeable
Portable Mini FM Radio
with MP3 Player
12900
$
SAVE $20
Audio/Video Balun with
DC Power and Wall Plate
Transmit audio and video signals up to 300m
over standard CAT5 UTP network
cable. Available for both component
video and composite video signals
with and without audio. All models
supplied as a pair.
Composite Video, Mono Sound,
DC Power (up to 12V) LT-3037
Was $69.95 Now $29.95 Save $40
Component / RGB Video LT-3038
Was $69.95 Now $29.95 Save $40
Component / RGB Video and
Digital Audio LT-3039
Was $69.95 Now $29.95 Save $40
2995
$
SAVE $40
All savings based on Original RRP. Limited stock on sale items.
Prices valid until 23/06/2012.
COMPUTER GADGETS
Gives a whole new dimension to capturing, storing and
sharing of photos and videos wirelessly. Transfer and
share precious moments from your
digital camera to your PC, laptop, tablets
or Smartphones without the need for
cables. Great for travellers! See website
for full features and specifications.
• 8GB storage for approx. 3000
photos (varies based on photo size)
• Plug & Play
XC-5620
9900
$
Accessories not included
More comfortable and far more accurate than a
mouse with higher resolution and pressure
sensitivity. The pen has user defined buttons and
"hotspots" around the
border of the tablet.
Paint, draw, write or
touch up. Ideal for
graphics designers,
photographers or
other creatives.
• Battery and software included
• Windows compatible or MAC®
• Size: 205(W) x 190(H)mm
XC-0356 Was $59.95
Wi-Fi Remote IP Camera
9995
• Lightweight with
soft padded
earpieces
XC-4969 Was $49.95
Cradle & Adaptop available
separately QC-3369 $29.95
Convert Slides, Film &
Photos to Digital
Scan directly to your PC using
the provided software.
• Powered by USB from
the host computer
XC-4122 Was $49.95
• 1,800dpi resolution
• Windows compatible
• Size: 85(W) x 165(H) x
90(D)mm
XC-4881 Was $74.00
4500
$
SAVE $29
Features an 8MP sensor and white LED lighting and it
will produce clear high resolution scans quickly.
Enables you to do basic photo editing
such as crop, straighten, retouch and
colour adjust. See website for full
specs and system requirements.
$
6900
SAVE $60
USB Combo Image Scanner
with LCD
SAVE $30
129
$
00
SAVE 70
$
1995
$
SAVE $30
USB Device Share Hub
Share a printer, external drive or any other USB
device between two computers. Each computer
plugs into the hub via USB cable
and you switch between
them using the switch on
the unit or via the scroll
lock key on your keyboard.
No power, drivers or software
required. PC or MAC®.
• USB-B cable required
for each computer
• Size: 100(L) x 80(W) x 27(D)mm
XC-4944 Was $24.95
Excellent for on-the-go
online video conferencing
or chatting. It has a built-in
microphone to keep set-up
to a minimum. Mounts on top of a
thin LCD laptop screen.
• Plug and play
• Size: 28(W) x 59(H x14(D)mm
QC-3231 Was $19.95
Better, More Technical
5995
$
• Composite Video input via RCA
connector or S-Video mini-DIN
• Windows compatible
• Size: 35(W) x 95(D) x 15(H)mm
XC-4867 Was $69.95
SAVE $10
In-Car Laptop Power
Supplies
50W Automatic MP-3479 $34.95
90W Automatic MP-3324 $59.95
150W Manual MP-3472 $74.95
From
3495
$
Right Angle
Computer Adaptors
DB9 Male to DB9 Female Adaptor
PA-0908 $5.95
DB15HD Male
to DB15HD
NEW
Female Adaptor
$ 95
PA-0909 $5.95
5
1495
$
SAVE $10
Tiny 300k Notebook
USB Webcam
Connect this to your PC and
take high resolution scans of
all your photos, slides and
negatives to preserve
in JPEG or TIF
format.
• 2.4" LCD
• Size: 210(L) x 230(W)
x 150(H)mm
XC-4893 Was $199.00
1995
$
Extend your printer or any
other USB device as far as
10 metres away from
your PC. A 4-port hub
adds extra flexibility.
USB Slide/Film
Scanner
Turn your aging collection of
VHS video tapes into new video
productions or record video
straight to your DVD or CD
burner. Works on PC or MAC®
and the included software
allows editing/publishing for web
applications etc.
Keep you laptop or netbook
charged on the road. Models
to suit most of the mini
computers on the
market. Check our
website for compatibility.
Powered USB Extension Lead
with 4-Port Hub
Easy DIY way of digitally archiving,
sharing and saving cherished photos.
• Four photo sizes:
3.5 x 3.5, 3.5 x
4.5, 3.5 x 5.0, 4.0
x 6.0 inches
• PC & MAC® compatible
• USB 2.0
XC-4910 Was $129.00
SAVE $20
These backphones have a built-in
bass shaker that adds depth and
realism to your gaming experience.
Include a concealed microphone
perfect for network games.
$
USB Photo Scanner
3995
$
Gaming Backphones
with Built-in Bass
Shakers
The smallest IP camera we've ever seen! With
its wireless network interface, the camera
allows you to stream and record audio video
images over your network or directly to
your Smartphone (iPhones® or AndroidTM
devices) and laptop on
the go.
• 640 x 480 resolution
• Size: 30(Dia.)mm
QC-3368
USB 2.0 DVD Maker II
5.5" Graphics Tablet
Wireless SD Card - 8GB
1495
$
SAVE $5
USB to Apple® Connector/USB
Micro B and Mini B Cable
A versatile USB cable that can
connect to an Apple® iDevice, or
anything that features a micro or
mini USB socket. The t-shaped end
of the cable features a USB mini and
micro plug on either side as well as
an Apple® connector that can piggy
back off the micro USB plug.
NEW
• Cable length: 1.1m (approx)
WC-7691
1995
$
Remote PC Control Over
Ethernet Adaptor 1080p
Want to play games, browse
the net or watch films on
your TV when your
computer is in another
room? This adaptor allows all
of the above over a simple Ethernet
connection. It features 2 x USB ports to
connect a keyboard/mouse for remotely
controlling your PC and 2 x 3.5mm sockets for audio
and microphone input. Output is to DVI which may
require an adaptor for connection to your flat panel TV.
See website for more details.
• Windows compatible
• Size: 120(L) x 57(W) x
21(H)mm
XC-4976 Was $129.00
9900
$
SAVE $30
www.jaycar.com.au
5
CARAVAN LIGHTING & ACCESSORIES
Rechargeable Halogen Spotlight
Provides 20 minutes continuous operation with
3,000,000 candlepower will be
plenty of light for any outdoor
activity. Rechargeable and
ruggedly built.
• Built-in SLA battery
• Locking on/off switch
• High impact rubber lens protector
• LED map light
• AC and DC chargers included
• Size: 210(L) x 150(Dia.)mm
ST-3301 Was $29.95
Great for use as reading lights in
caravans but also suitable for a
variety of other applications.
Easily powered from a 12VDC
(or AC) power source. Uses 12
x 5050 SMD LEDs.
NEW
Cool White ZD-0562 $14.95
Warm White ZD-0563 $14.95
1995
$
1495
$
SAVE $10
12VDC HD Digital Set Top Box
• Output: HDMI,
Composite, RF
• USB port for
recording and playback
• Cigarette lighter cable included
• Size:154(W) x 117(D) x 40(H)mm
XC-4921
6995
$
IP67 Waterproof LED
Flexible Strip Light
5W 80 Channel UHF
Transceiver
Amazing range and clarity suitable for long distance
communication. Switch to power saving 1W output
for short distance communication. Includes Li-ion
rechargeable battery pack, AC adaptor, charging
cradle and belt clip.
• 80 channels with CTCSS
• Channel scan, dual watch,
key lock, VOX, auto power save
and repeater functions
$
• Antenna: 165mm long
• Size (without antenna):
130(L) x 60(W) x 35(D)mm
DC-1065
14900
4995
$
6495
$
SAVE $1500
• 120 Lumens
• Size: 27(Dia.)mm
NEW
Cool White
ZD-0568 $13.95
Warm White ZD-0569 $13.95
$
13
95
• LED life: 40,000 hours
• 250 lumens
• Size: 50(Dia.) x 40(D)mm
ZD-0358 Was $59.95
6
1495
$
SAVE 20
$
LED illumination lamps have
significant advantages over
incandescent lamps. They are
long lasting, have lower heat
generation and low power
consumption.
Utilises three 1W Nichia 083B LEDs
to produce an amazing amount of
light. Perfect as a drop-in
replacement for MR16 halogen
downlights, retail display lights
or remote solar/wind/battery
power systems.
2995
$
SAVE $30
• Colour: white
• 1.5 to 2W
• GU5.3 base
• 20 LEDs per unit
ZD-0320 Was $29.95
To order call 1800 022 888
NEW
Warm White ZD-0561 $19.95
Cool White ZD-0560 $19.95
1995
$
CREE® LED Downlight Kits
Featuring CREE® XR-E LEDs with 110 to 400 lumens,
these offer comparable light to a 50W halogen
downlight but at just 10% the power consumption!
Life expectancy is over 50,000 hours.
Power supply included.
• 110 - 130 lumens
• Size: 60 x 45mm
(45mm cutout)
ZD-0370 Was $49.95
LED MR16 Replacement Lamp
MR16 LED Downlight
44
1 x CREE® LED Downlight Kit
Each uses one CREE® XR-E
LED driven at 3W.
• Colour: White
• GU10 base
• 160 lumens
• Mains powered
• Size: 50 x 55mm
ZD-0362 Was $34.95
For a reliable light source in your caravan that won't
blow like incadescent globes, this 12VDC powered
light uses an array of 24 high
NEW
brightness white LEDs that
will light up your interior.
$
95
• 300 Lumens
• Input power: 12VAC/DC
• Size: 50(Dia.)mm x 46(H)mm
GU10 3W CREE®
LED Downlight
Great for use as a low wattage
replacement globe in desk lamps,
rangehoods, and other household
applications. Features a 120 degree
light angle for a broad spread of light.
24 LED Caravan Roof Light
MR16 LED Downlights 120º
LED REPLACEMENT LAMPS
G4 LED Replacement Lights
3495
$
MR16 replacement downlights for
your caravan or mobile home.
Utilise 24 x 5050 SMD LEDs
that will output up to 300
lumens of warm white or
cool white light.
Completely solar powered to reduce
mould, mildew, moisture and excess
heat build-up in boats, caravans and
RVs, or anywhere else you need air
extraction. Cut-out size: 150mm.
• Wall or roof mounting
• Stainless shroud
• Gasket included
• Size: 215(Dia.) x 30(H)mm
MP-4559 Was $79.95
NEW
• Size: 147(Dia.) x 36(H)mm
SL-3446
• Size: 213(L) x 66(W) x 41.5(H)mm
SL-3447
Solar Powered Ventilator
A 1m long fully waterproof, flexible LED strip light
that is perfect for any outdoor application needing
reliable lighting. Uses 60 of the highest brightness
5060-SMD type LEDs that are fully sheathed in a
protective plastic casing to
protect from water, dust and
damage. See website
for full specifications.
19 LED Caravan &
Automotive Roof Light
Provide more illumination in your
car or caravan with this
12VDC LED powered rooflight
that makes use of 19 x white
high brightness LEDs. Easy to
install and operate.
• 130 lumens
• Size: 34(Dia.) x 29(D)mm
Great for use on the road, this high definition set top
box will pickup all the digital channels on offer in the
area. You can also plug in a USB drive and record TV
in MPEG2 format to watch at a later date.
• Powered by 12VDC
• Size: 1000(L) x 10(W)mm
ZD-0579
MR11 LED Downlights 120º
Now $29.95 Save $20
4 x CREE® LED Downlight Kit
• 400 - 450 lumens
• Size: 90 x 110mm
(77mm cutout)
ZD-0372 Was $129.00
Limited
stock. Not
available
online.
Now $49.00 Save $80.00
From
2995
$
SAVE $20
E14 CREE® LED
Downlight
Drop-in replacements for E14 fittings.
995
$
SAVE 20
$
• Colour: White
• Power: 3.3W
• Brightness: 110 - 130 lm
• Input voltage: 100 - 240VAC
• Size: 50 x 73mm
ZD-0366 Was $39.95
2495
$
SAVE $15
All savings based on Original RRP. Limited stock on sale items.
Prices valid until 23/06/2012.
SECURITY & SURVEILLANCE
Universal Fingerprint
Access Controller
A complete bio access control solution that enables you
to enrol up to 120 users. The fingerprint scanner reads in
less than two seconds. It has a robust
cast housing and all operating
parameters are stored in a flash
memory so it won't be lost
due to power failure.
• All metal construction
• Weatherproof and tamperproof
• IR remote control
• Up to 4 supervisors
• 12VDC powered
• Size: 68(W) x 115(H) x 32(D)mm
LA-5122 Was $299.00
14900
$
SAVE $150
Low Cost RFID Access
Control Keypad
• Compression H.264/MPEG4/JPEG
• Sensor: 1/4 inch CMOS
$
00
• Resolution: 640(H) x 480(V)
• Size: 99(W) x 97(L) x 45(H)mm
SAVE $60
QC-8624 Was $259.00
199
Secure your house, apartment or business without
running cables. The system "learns" what sensors
are connected and the part arm function allows you
to protect certain zones while
others are disarmed. Easy to
install, ideal for rented or
temporary premises.
• 12VDC powered
LA-5124 Was $79.95
RFID tags to suit:
Key Fob Type
ZZ-8950 $12.95
Credit Card Type ZZ-8952 $6.95
Lanyard Type
ZZ-8953 $4.95
2995
$
SAVE $50
Limited stock. Not available online.
Biometric Finger Scan Safe
This advanced biometric safe provides secure
storage using a finger print scan
for fast and simple access in just
2 seconds! Features a built-in
flash memory retaining the
fingerprint data even during a
battery failure. Ideal for storing
money, passports, jewellery or
other personal documents.
Complete with 2 back up keys
and a 1m alloy security cable
for attaching to your bed frame
or placing it in your closet.
Mounting hardware included
NEW
14900
$
2.4GHz Baby Monitor System
with Portable LCD &
Night Vision
Monitor your baby sleeping or your
kids at play in the backyard.
Features a portable 2.4" colour LCD
and CMOS colour camera with
inbuilt mic. The 2.4GHz digital
transmission ensures a stable,
clear and interference free picture
up to 100m away. The camera unit
features infrared night vision and
voice activation mode to keep
you alert throughout the night.
• Rechargeable Li-ion battery
and charging cradle
for monitor included
• 4 channel operation
QC-3251 Was $169.00
Designed to take advantage of power over Ethernet
to reduce installation costs and setup time, connect
straight to your existing network for complete control.
Access the camera through a web interface by hitting
the IP address of the device and logging in. The web
interface allows you to control
the camera around 3-axis,
zoom, adjust visual settings,
record, take snapshots and
setup scheduled recording.
8 Zone Wireless Alarm Kit
This low cost RFID unit is designed to
control door strikes in home or
business access control installations.
It allows 4 entry methods: password,
proximity card, password + proximity
card and egress push button entry.
• Requires 4 x AA Alkaline batteries
• Size: 273(L) x 190(W) x 51(H)mm
HB-5457
Network Connect Vandal
Proof Mini Dome Camera
12900
$
SAVE $40
• Kit includes siren, keypad,
PIR sensor, reed
switch and power
supply
LA-5150 Was $199.00
Additional sensors and accessories
available separately, see in-store
or online for more info.
16900
$
SAVE $30
Wireless Colour Video Doorphone
SAVE $50
Dual Beam Infrared Barrier
Protect your doors or
windows with this
dual beam infrared
detector. Housed in a
strong aluminum and
suitable for outdoor
environments (IP55).
The detector will
sound an internal buzzer and energise
a relay when the beam is broken or
tampering is detected.
9900
$
SAVE $70
Professional CCD Cameras
Range of professional CCD cameras below
with great prices.
• 752 x 582 resolution
• 550 TV Lines
• Power: 24VAC/12VDC
Day / Night Colour CCD
• Flickerless
• 1/3" Sony Hi-Res Super HAD CCD
QC-8621 Was $199.00
14900
$
SAVE $50
High Resolution ExView
Colour CCD - Pro Style
22900
$
SAVE $70
With its 2.5" LCD screen and a built-in
distortion compensation feature, you can see the
person clearly on the other side of the door by a
simple press of a button. The camera is no bigger
than an original fisheye viewer and looks the
same as a peep hole viewer from
the outside. Simple to install
without compromising door
security. Comes complete
with an installation tool
and AA batteries.
Better, More Technical
9900
$
• Size: 55(W) x 92(H) x 25(D)mm
QC-3430 Was $149.00
High resolution day/night camera
with Sony® sensor, colour by
day, black and white by night.
Extremely high performance in
low light levels. Perfect for use
with infrared illuminators.
2.5" LCD Electronic Door
Peep Hole Viewer
• Size: 146(W) x 90(H) x 30(D)mm
QC-3267 Was $199.00
Make sure your private
conversations stay private with this
mini RF bug detector. Detects
transmissions between 50MHz &
6,000MHz (6GHz). The unit can be
operated in silent mode with the
built-in vibrator & features an RF
sensitivity control, a
'battery low' warning
light and handy belt clip.
• Mounting hardware included
• Length 570mm
LA-5186 Was $169.00
A compact wireless video
doorphone that's full on features.
Incorporating digital encryption
and code-hopping 2.4GHz
wireless transmission, signals
are clear and interference-free
up to 100m range. The receiver
unit features 3.5" TFT LCD, stores up to
200 images and a built-in rechargeable
battery. The camera unit is equipped with
a wide angle lens IR illumination
and is easy to install.
• Clear night vision
• Mini USB for PC interface
• Rechargeable lithium battery
• Size: 290(W) x 210(H) x 50(D)mm
QC-3253 Was $299.00
RF Bug Detector
12900
$
SAVE $70
Ideal for use with infrared
illuminators and features high
speed electronic shutter, back
light compensation and 3 stage
automatic gain control.
• 1/3" Sony Hi-Res ExView
HAD CCD
• Size: 145(L) x 68(W) x 57(H)mm
QC-8622 Was $249.00
19900
$
SAVE $50
Wide Dynamic Range CCD
Professional grade camera
based around Sony's
SS2 vertical
double-density wide
dynamic range CCD
system. Provides a high
quality picture.
• 1/3" Sony CCD
• Size: 145(L) x 68(W) x 57(H)mm
QC-8623 Was $399.00
www.jaycar.com.au
19900
$
SAVE $200
7
NO. 1 FOR KITS
Mixture Display Kit For
Fuel Injected Cars
Thousand’s
SOLD!
Refer: Silicon Chip November 1995
This very simple kit will allow you to monitor the fuel
mixtures being run by your car. This type of sensor is
also known as an E.G.O. (exhaust, gas, oxygen)
monitor. The circuit connects to the
EGO sensor mounted in the
exhaust manifold and the
cars battery. PCB, LEDs and
components supplied.
• PCB: 74 x 36mm
KC-5195
1695
$
Salt Water Fuel Cell Engine Car Kit
An educational kit demonstrating the concept of a salt
powered automotive engine. It gives the next generation a
look at alternative means of propelling cars of the future.
Assemble, add salt water, and your
4WD car will be propelled forward.
• Assembly time: 3 hours
• Recommended
for ages 8+
Kit for
KJ-8960
kids
Measure the g-forces on your vehicle and it's
occupants during your next lap around the race
circuit, or use this kit to encourage smoother driving
to save petrol and reduce wear & tear. Forces (+/2g) are displayed on the 4-digit LED display. Also
use it to measure g-forces on a boat crashing over
waves or on a theme park thrill ride. Kit includes
PCB with pre-mounted SMD component,
pre-programmed microcontroller and
all onboard electronic
components.
• Requires 2 x AA batteries
• PCB: 100(L) x 44(W)mm
KC-5504
NOTE: We supply the PCB
with the SMD component
already mounted on the board
to save time and frustration.
Limited stock. Not available online.
24
95
Car Battery Monitor Kit
Refer: Electronics Australia May 1987
This simple electronic voltmeter lets you monitor
the condition of your car’s battery so
you can act before getting
stranded. 10 rectangular
LEDs tell you your battery’s
condition. Kit includes PC
board and all components.
49
95
Programmable High Energy
Ignition Kit for Cars
95
NEW STORE - FERNTREE GULLY
815 Burwood
Highway
Open
Early
VIC
3156
June
Ph. (03) 9758-0141
Parking available
This kit controls DMX fixtures such as spotlights
using a PC and USB interface. It can also be
operated in stand-alone mode that outputs all
512 channels at the same time (9V battery
required for stand-alone mode). Includes
software, USB cable and enclosure.
• Test software and DMX Light
Player software included
• 512 DMX channels with
256 levels each
• 3 pin XLR-DMX
output connector
KV-3610 Was $149.00
9900
$
SAVE $50
Control a relay with the DMX512 protocol. The relay will
be activated when the DMX value of the set channel
equals 140 or more and turns off when the value is 120
or less. Team it with KV-3610 to
make a computer-controlled
automation system. Short
form kit.
• 512 unique addresses,
DIP switch settable
• Relay hold function in
case of DMX signal loss
KV-3612 Was $49.95
2995
$
SAVE $20
DMX Control Dimmer Kit
Allows you to control a lamp or group of lamps through a
DMX signal. You can use the USB Controlled DMX
Interface kit or any other control console compliant with
the DMX-512 protocol as a controller. It will drive
resistive loads like
incandescent lamps and
mains voltage halogen
lighting. Shortform kit.
• Suitable for single coil systems
• Dwell adjustment
• Single or dual mapping ranges
• Max & min RPM adjustment
• PCB: 102 x
81mm
$
95
KC-5442
17
$
• PCB: 62 x 39mm
KA-1683
Party Lighting Kits
DMX Controller USB Interface
DMX Relay Control Kit
$
Refer: Silicon Chip Magazine March 2007
This advanced and versatile ignition system can be
used on both two & four stroke engines. The system
can be used to modify the factory timing or as the
basis for a stand-alone ignition system with variable
ignition timing, electronic coil control and anti-knock
sensing. Kit includes PCB with overlay, programmed
micro, all electronic components, and die cast box.
NEW
$
G-Force Meter Kit
69
High Range Adjustable
Temperature Switch for Cars
• 512 unique addresses,
selectable with DIP switch
• Status LED for power and
error detection
• Stand alone mode for testing
KV-3614 Was $79.95
Refer: Performance Electronics for Cars Silicon Chip Publications
This temperature switch can be set anywhere
up to 1200ºC. The relay can be used to trigger an
extra thermo fan on an intercooler or a simple alarm to warn
you of overheating. The LCD which can easily be dash
mounted, displays the temperature constantly. Kit supplied
with solder masked PCB with overlay, LCD panel, temperature
probe and all electronic components.
4995
$
SAVE $30
7295
$
• PCB: 105 x 60mm
KC-5376
YOUR LOCAL JAYCAR STORE - Free Call Orders: 1800 022 888
• AUSTRALIAN CAPITAL TERRITORY
Belconnen
Fyshwick
Ph (02) 6253 5700
Ph (02) 6239 1801
• NEW SOUTH WALES
Albury
Alexandria
Bankstown
Blacktown
Bondi Junction
Brookvale
Campbelltown
Castle Hill
Coffs Harbour
Croydon
Erina
Gore Hill
Hornsby
Liverpool
Maitland
Ph (02) 6021 6788
Ph (02) 9699 4699
Ph (02) 9709 2822
Ph (02) 9678 9669
Ph (02) 9369 3899
Ph (02) 9905 4130
Ph (02) 4620 7155
Ph (02) 9634 4470
Ph (02) 6651 5238
Ph (02) 9799 0402
Ph (02) 4365 3433
Ph (02) 9439 4799
Ph (02) 9476 6221
Ph (02) 9821 3100
Ph (02) 4934 4911
Newcastle
Penrith
Port Macquarie
Rydalmere
Sydney City
Taren Point
Tuggerah NEW
Tweed Heads
Wagga Wagga
Wollongong
Ph (02) 4965 3799
Ph (02) 4721 8337
Ph (02) 6581 4476
Ph (02) 8832 3120
Ph (02) 9267 1614
Ph (02) 9531 7033
Ph (02) 4353 5016
Ph (07) 5524 6566
Ph (02) 6931 9333
Ph (02) 4226 7089
• NORTHERN TERRITORY
Darwin
Ph (08) 8948 4043
Ph (07) 3863 0099
Ph (07) 5432 3152
Ph (07) 4041 6747
Ph (07) 3245 2014
Ph (07) 3282 5800
Ph (07) 5537 4295
Ph (07) 4953 0611
Ph (07) 5479 3511
Ph (07) 5526 6722
Ph (07) 4926 4155
Ph (07) 4772 5022
Ph (07) 3841 4888
Ph (07) 3393 0777
• SOUTH AUSTRALIA
Adelaide
Clovelly Park
Gepps Cross
Reynella
• TASMANIA
• QUEENSLAND
Aspley
Caboolture
Cairns
Capalaba
Ipswich
Labrador
Mackay
Maroochydore
Mermaid Beach
Nth Rockhampton
Townsville
Underwood
Woolloongabba
Hobart
Launceston
Ph (08) 8231 7355
Ph (08) 8276 6901
Ph (08) 8262 3200
Ph (08) 8387 3847
Ph (03) 6272 9955
Ph (03) 6334 2777
• VICTORIA
Cheltenham
Ph (03) 9585 5011
Coburg
Ph (03) 9384 1811
FernTree Gully NEW Ph (03) 9758 0141
Arrival
datesofofnew
new
products
in flyer
this were
flyer confirmed
were confirmed at the
Arrival dates
products
in this
HEAD OFFICE
time
print.
Occasionally
these
at the of
time
of print.
Occasionally
thesedates
dateschange
change unexpectedly.
320 Victoria Road, Rydalmere NSW 2116
Please
ring your
to check
stock
details.
unexpectedly.
Pleaselocal
ringstore
your local
store to
check
stock Prices valid from
Ph: (02) 8832 3100 Fax: (02) 8832 3169
Prices valid
from 24th
May
to 23rd
2012.are based on original RRP
details.
24th February
to 23rd
March
2012.
AllJune
savings
ONLINE ORDERS
Frankston
Geelong
Hallam
Kew East
Melbourne
Ringwood
Shepparton
Springvale
Sunshine
Thomastown
Werribee
Ph (03) 9781 4100
Ph (03) 5221 5800
Ph (03) 9796 4577
Ph (03) 9859 6188
Ph (03) 9663 2030
Ph (03) 9870 9053
Ph (03) 5822 4037
Ph (03) 9547 1022
Ph (03) 9310 8066
Ph (03) 9465 3333
Ph (03) 9741 8951
• WESTERN AUSTRALIA
Joondalup
Maddington
Mandurah
Midland
Northbridge
Rockingham
Website: www.jaycar.com.au
Email: techstore<at>jaycar.com.au
Ph (08) 9301 0916
Ph (08) 9493 4300
Ph (08) 9586 3827
Ph (08) 9250 8200
Ph (08) 9328 8252
Ph (08) 9592 8000
PRODUCT SHOWCASE
Universal Charger for Cordless Power Tools (4.8-24V)
Have a cordless power tool and can’t find the charger? If it has a Ni-MH or
Ni-Cd battery then this charger will solve your problem.
It features intelligent polarity operation, which automatically detects the
polarity and voltage of your battery and charges it accordingly. Operating from
12V DC (cigar lighter plug included) or 100-240V AC via power adaptor (also
included), you simply connect the strong magnetic or alligator clip connectors
to your battery and this smart charger will do the rest. It incorporates two status
LEDs, one indicating that the battery is charging and the other indicates once
it is full. Charging time is 1-3 hours depending on battery capacity.
Recommended retail
price is $79.95 (Cat no Contact:
MB-3631), it’s avail- Jaycar Electronics (all stores)
able from Jaycar PO Box 107, Rydalmere NSW 2116
stores, resellers or Order Tel: 1800 022 888 Fax: (02) 8832 3188
via the Jaycar web Website: www.jaycar.com.au
store.
New world record for efficiency in organic solar cells
Heliatek GmbH, a German company which specialises in the design
and production of solar cells, has just
achieved an efficiency of 10.7% for its
latest organic photovoltaic (OPV) cells.
Heliatek is the only solar company
in the world that uses the deposition
of small organic molecules in a low
temperature, roll-to-roll vacuum
process. Their solar tandem cells are
made of nanometer thin layers of high
purity and uniformity. They can literally engineer the cell architecture to
systematically improve efficiency and
lifetime.
The measurement results for low
light established that the efficiency
not only remains constant but even increases gradually. At an irradiation of
100W/m² the efficiency is 15% higher
compared to the standard efficiency
measured at 1,000 W/m².
Ocean Controls’ Rain Gauge uses infrared light
The RG-11 Rain Gauge senses water hitting its outside surface using beams of infrared
light.It uses the same sensing principle used in millions of automotive rain sensing windshield wiper controls.
Because it is optical – not mechanical, chemical, or conductive – it is far
more rugged, sensitive and reliable than any other technology.
The sensor is extremely sensitive and virtually immune to false
trips. Yet it is completely unaffected by jostling and motion.
There are no exposed conductors to corrode, no tipping buckets to
foul and no openings for bugs to crawl into. There is no place for leaves
or other debris to collect.
The RG-11 Rain Sensor includes a DIP switch that allows it to
be set up for the
mode of operation Contact:
that best matches Ocean Controls
PO Box 2191, Seaford BC, Vic, 3198
the application.
Retail price is Tel: (03) 9782 5882 Fax: (03) 9782 5517
Website: www.oceancontrols.com.au
$79.95 +GST.
siliconchip.com.au
New RTA electrostatic
speaker panels
Reality Technologies Australia’s
(RTA) new UFPS-440 Electrostatic Loudspeaker panel measures
168mm across by 440mm high, at
only 8mm thick, making it ideal for
use in companion speakers to or for
integration into the latest generation
of flat panel television screens.
RTA’s several decades of speaker
engineering expertise behind the
technology has enabled them to
create a flat panel speaker that also
has high quality audio reproduction,
overcoming a traditional barrier
with other flat panel technology.
Traditional problems with electrostatic speaker panels have also been
overcome.
RTA is now able to supply high
quality, low cost panels, reproducible in high volumes for OEM
purposes, without the need for
expensive high-current amplifier
circuitry to drive it. Furthermore,
the technology can be employed
to create custom shapes and sizes
for integration into new or existing
product lines.
The UFPS-440 speaker panels are
also available in kit form, including two panels and all associated
electronics.
More detailed specifications and
test data are available at the company’s website.
SC
Contact:
Reality Technologies Australia
33 Malcolm Rd, Braeside, Vic 3195
Tel: (03) 8581-7638 Fax: (03) 9587-4986
Website: www.reality-design.com.au
June 2012 57
Anyone can build this high performance four-channel audio mixer. . .
Want to mix two or more audio signals
together? Maybe it’s an MP3
player and a microphone so
you can “play” Karaoke. Or
perhaps you’ve formed the
next earth-shattering
band and need to mix
a couple of guitars
and a mic or two
together. Or you’ve built
a PA amplifier and want to be
able to drive it from a variety of
signal sources. Here’s the answer:
this 4-channel mixer might be
simple and cheap to build –
but its performance lacks for
nothing!
By
Nicholas Vinen
Mix-It!
T
his mixer is something of a puts which can be configured for a controls, individual channel level
reprise of two very popular wide variety of signal sources, from controls along with a master volume
control and an on-board power supply.
4-Channel Guitar Mixers fea- very low level (eg, microphone or
tured in SILICON CHIP – the first in our guitar) right through to quite high (eg You can build it as a stand-alone unit
or incorporate it into a PA or guitar
January 1992 issue and a more recent iPODs/MP3 players, CD/cassette decks
[Gad, what are they?]) and the like.
amplifier.
version in June 2007.
It has bass, midrange and treble
In fact, it doesn’t even need to be a
While this one has several similar
PA/guitar amplifier:
features, (it is an auwith almost 800mV
dio mixer, after all!)
output, this mixer
it also has a number
could be used with
of improvements –
• Four unbalanced inputs with 1MΩ || 100pF input impedance (see text)
virtually any amplifor example, perfor• Gain of 0-36dB per channel (depending on feedback components)
fier with a “line in” or
mance, cost, easy to
• Bass, mid and treble controls (±10dB)
similar input.
build – and as a bonus,
• Master volume control
Other features inthe PCB is actually
• Input radio signal filtering
clude a variety of
smaller than either
• Flat frequency response
power supplies – it
so you can fit it into a
• Low distortion and noise
could use a low voltsmaller case.
• Four supply options: 15VAC, 12-30V DC, ±15V or unregulated split supply
age AC supply – say
It features four in-
Features
58 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
An early prototype of the Mix-It!
4-channel mixer – some components
have been moved or changed since this
photo was taken. PCBs purchased from
SILICON CHIP will also be double-sided, eliminating the
need for the wire links shown on this board.
around 15V – or it could use a split DC
supply such as that commonly found
in amplifiers (eg, ±15V).
We’ll have more to say on the supply shortly.
How it works
pacitors with 1MΩ biasing resistors.
This high value is necessary if the
mixer is used with electric guitars,
as their frequency response changes
when driving lower impedances due
to loading effects on the inductive
pick-up(s). The relatively low value
RF filtering capacitors (100pF) were
chosen for the same reason.
While most of the coupling capacitors in the circuit have been increased
compared to the original designs, here
we have used a lower value since the
input coupling capacitors need to be
non-polarised. This is because the
signal source could potentially have
a high DC bias or the input might be
accidentally shorted to a power rail.
We also wanted to use an “MKT”
(polyester) capacitor as they are more
reliable and linear than non-polarised
electrolytics, which also vary greatly
in size.
Before each op amp is a 100Ω resistor, which acts as an additional RF
stopper.
IC1a-IC2b are TL072 low-noise JFET
input op amps. Due to the high value
bias resistors, the LM833s used in the
original design are not suitable. They
would have an excessive output DC
offset due to their relatively high input
bias currents. JFET input op amps have
a much lower input bias current with
only a small increase in noise.
The gain for these op amps is set by
the two resistors at their outputs. In
the circuit we have used “middle of
the road” values of 1.8kΩ and 220Ω,
resulting in a gain of about 9.2x (18dB).
Gain is calculated using the formula
Each of the four identical inputs,
CON1-CON4, can be fitted with either a terminal block or preferably,
a PCB-mounting shorting-type RCA
socket. We say preferably because unconnected inputs are then shorted to
1.8kΩ + 220Ω
ground and therefore don’t introduce
220Ω
any noise or hum into the circuit.
Each input has an RF filter, consistThis is about half that of the original
ing of a ferrite bead and 100Ω resistor
design, which could not handle linein series with the signal and a 100pF
level input signals without clipping.
capacitor to ground. These act as lowThis one can – up to 900mV RMS or
pass filters with a cutoff frequency of
more with reduced gain.
16MHz while the ferrite beads greatly
These values can be changed to suit
improve the rejection of signals above
various input devices, as we shall see
a couple of hundred kilohertz.
shortly.
We mentioned “ground” a moment
The feedback capacitors (nomiago. In this circuit, it’s important
nated as 220pF) roll off the op amp
to note that there are two different
closed-loop gain at high frequencies
“grounds”. The first is the “power”
to improve stability, reduce noise
ground and uses the conventional
and provide a further degree of RF
ground symbol ( ). The second is
rejection.
the “signal” ground and
The op amp outputs are
uses a different symbol
AC-coupled via 10µF electro(
). We’ll explain
lytic capacitors to 10kΩ log
these a bit more when • Input range for line level output: 18-900mV
volume pots (VR1-VR4). These
we look at power sup- • Frequency response:
20Hz-20kHz, +0,-1.2dB (see Fig.3)
capacitors are polarised, to
plies shortly.
• Signal-to-noise ratio:
-75dB <at> 32dB gain; -92dB <at> 0dB gain
minimise size and cost. We can
The audio signals are • THD+N (for 20Hz-20kHz 0.015% <at> 32dB gain;
get away with it because the op
then AC-coupled to op
bandwidth):
0.003% <at> 18dB gain;
amp input bias currents (small
amps IC1b, IC1a, IC2b
0.002% <at> 0dB gain)
though they may be with JFET
and IC2a via 470nF cainputs) cause the op amp out-
Specifications
siliconchip.com.au
June 2012 59
+15V
CON1
1
L1
BEAD
100
470nF
100
8
5
2
6
INPUT
1 CON1a
IC1b
1M
100pF
IC1: TL072
100
470nF
100
100F
25V
6.8k
470F
16V
SUPPLY RAIL SPLITTER
220
47pF
39k
IC1a
1M
10F
1
C2
1.8k
220pF
VR2
10k
LOG
9
47F
CHANNEL
2 GAIN
100
1
470nF
–15V
6
CON4
1
2
INPUT
4
CON4a
220pF
VR3
10k
LOG
= SIGNAL GROUND
470nF
100
1M
= POWER SUPPLY GROUND
Adjustments to input R & C for various devices
100nF
–15V
3
4
IC2a
R1-R4
C1-C4
Stage Gain Overall Gain
Suits
120
100pF
16x (24dB)
62x (36dB)
Low-sensitivity mics
150
150pF
13x (22dB)
50x (34dB)
Medium-sensitivity mics
220
220pF
9x (18dB)
38x (31dB)
390
330pF
5.5x (15dB) 22x (27dB)
910
470pF
3x (10dB)
12x (21dB)
1.8k
560pF
2x (6dB)
8x (18dB)
Line level sources
Omit
1nF
1x (0dB)
4x (12dB)
CD/DVD/Blu-ray players
10F
1
CHANNEL
4 GAIN
C4
1.8k
220pF
R4
220
SC
10k
R3
VR4
10k
LOG
2012
R5,R6 INSTALLED FOR USE WITH CONDENSER MICROPHONES
ON INPUT 4 ONLY
220
2
100pF
CHANNEL
3 GAIN
C3
1.8k
IC2: TL072
100
7
+15V
R1-4, C1-4 CAN BE ALTERED TO CHANGE GAIN OF EACH
CHANNEL AND THEREFORE SUIT DIFFERENT INPUTS –
SEE TABLE
10F
R5
100F
L4
BEAD
IC2b
1M
100pF
470
PHANTOM R6
POWER 1.8k
8
5
2
INPUT
3 CON3a
MIXER/AMPLIFIER
STAGE
+15V
100
10F
8
11
10k
R2
L3
BEAD
IC3c
10
220
CON3
33*
–15V
R1
4
3
2
100pF
VR1
10k
LOG
CHANNEL
1 GAIN
10k
2
1
–15V
2
INPUT
2 CON2a
220pF
–15V
IC3a
100nF
L2
BEAD
1
C1
1.8k
4
3
10F
7
+15V
CON2
100nF
6.8k
10k
Mics/guitars
Guitars
iPods, Mp3 players etc
MIX-IT! FOUR CHANNEL MIXER
Fig.1: the circuit diagram consists of four near-identical input stages, the outputs of which are mixed and amplified before
being fed into a tone control stage and output buffer. Any of the four inputs may be altered from that shown to account for
different audio devices – anything from a microphone to a Blu-ray player can be accommodated (see table above).
puts to have a slightly positive DC bias.
The pot wipers then connect to
four 10kΩ mixing resistors which
are joined together at the other end.
This is the “virtual earth” point and
is held at signal ground potential by
op amp IC3c.
Its non-inverting input (pin 10) is
at signal ground potential and it is
configured as an inverting amplifier
with a gain of -3.9, as set by the ratio of
the 39kΩ feedback resistor to the 10kΩ
mixer resistors. The overall maximum
60 Silicon Chip
gain of the unit is therefore 3.9 x 9.2
= 36 or 31dB.
The resulting output signal is the
sum of the four input signals (from
the wipers of the pots).
A 47pF feedback capacitor limits
the bandwidth again and the output is
AC-coupled to the active tone control
stage with a 10µF capacitor, orientated
so that it will have the correct DC bias.
The tone control stage is a traditional Baxandall-style arrangement
(named after Peter Baxandall, the man
who first described this circuit) with
three bands – bass, mid and treble.
We have copied this unchanged from
the original design as there is nothing
wrong with it. Three 100kΩ linear
potentiometers, VR5-VR7, adjust the
feedback around op amp IC3d which
is in an inverting configuration.
The combination of capacitors
across VR5 and VR6 with the capacitors at the wipers of VR6 and
VR7 mean that each pot controls the
feedback over a different audio “band”
siliconchip.com.au
K
REPLACE THIS CAPACITOR WITH
A WIRE LINK WHEN USING A
SPLIT DC OR AN AC SUPPLY
A
3
K
100F
25V
A
10k
A
0V DC INPUT
–22V DC INPUT
POWER
LED1
CON6, D1 AND D2 ARE NOT
FITTED WHEN HIGHER SPLIT
DC SUPPLY VOLTAGES ARE
FED IN THIS WAY
K
VR5
BASS
10k
D2
1N4004
100F
50V
REG2 79L15
100k LIN
15V
AC
IN
K
IN
OUT
CON6
A
GND
A
–15V
D1
1N4004
1.8k
D4
1N4004
22nF
10k
2
100F
50V
®
1
*RESISTOR FITTED ONLY WHEN
USING A SINGLE DC SUPPLY
K
GND
100F
25V
D3
1N4004
®
CON7
+22V DC INPUT
IN
®
OUT
®
REG1 78L15
+15V
2.2nF
10k
VR6
MIDRANGE
10nF
6.8k
10F
10k
100k LIN
100k LIN
VR8
10k
LOG
6.8k
OUTPUT
LEVEL
470nF
IC3: TL074
5
6
100k
7
IC3b
100
CON5
10F
1
2
100k
VR7
TREBLE
1.5nF
OUTPUT
CON5a
OUTPUT BUFFER
47pF
13
12
14
IC3d
LM79L15Z
LM78L15Z
D1–D4: 1N4004
TONE
CONTROL
(EQUALISER)
STAGE
A
–Vin
COM
IN
K
LED
OUT
–Vout
K
A
COM
WIRE LINK
REPLACING REG1
WIRE LINK
REPLACING REG1
+15V
K
CON7
1
D3
1N4004
100F
50V
1.8k
A
2
LED1
POWER
0V IN
–15V IN
–15V
SINGLE DC POWER SUPPLY CONFIGURATION
1
100F
25V
D3
1N4004
2
A
3
K
D4
1N4004
CON6
NC
K
CON7
+15V IN
30V
DC
IN
A
K
–15V
D1
1N4004
A
3
WIRE LINK
REPLACING
D4
+15V
K
1.8k
POWER
100F
25V
A
LED1
A
K
NC
+/–15V DC POWER SUPPLY CONFIGURATION
(REG1, REG2, D2, D4, THE LOWER 100F/50V
CAPACITOR & NEITHER 100F/25V CAPACITOR FITTED)
(REG1, REG2, D1, D2 AND BOTH 100F/50V
CAPACITORS OMITTED, ALSO CON6)
Inset at the bottom of the main circuit are two variations for powering the mixer – two are shown on the main circuit
diagram above (15V AC and ±22V DC). Each of these is further illustrated on the component overlays on page 63. R5, R6
and the 100µF capacitor on the main circuit are only needed if your microphone requires phantom power (see text).
. Thus they each boost or cut a different
range of frequencies. Refer to Fig.9 to
see the effect of these pots; this shows
the frequency response of the mixer
with the controls set at their maximum
extents as well as centred (blue trace).
Having been inverted twice, once
by the mixer and once by the tone
controls, the signal at output pin 14
of IC3d is in-phase with the inputs.
This is coupled to the master volume
control pot, VR8. The output is taken
from the wiper and then coupled with
siliconchip.com.au
a 470nF MKT capacitor to the noninverting input of op amp IC3b, with
a 100kΩ DC bias resistor. This op amp
simply buffers the signal to provide a
low-impedance output.
The 100Ω resistor at the output of
this op amp isolates it from any cable
capacitance which could otherwise
cause oscillation. As with the inputs,
output connector CON5 is either a
terminal block or RCA socket. A final
10µF AC-coupling capacitor is used
so that the output DC level is at 0V re-
gardless of the signal ground potential,
with a 100kΩ DC bias resistor setting
this DC level.
Power supply
Like the original design, this unit
can be powered from a ±15V regulated
DC supply, via CON7. If the mixer is
installed in a case with a preamplifier,
there is a good chance that such rails
will already be present.
But if not, or in cases where the
mixer is used as a stand-alone unit,
June 2012 61
THD+N vs Frequency, 80kHz BW
03/22/12 11:21:15
0.1
+1
Mixer Frequency Response (1kHz)
03/22/12 10:57:01
0.1
Total Harmonic Distortion Plus Noise (THD+N) %
Total Harmonic Distortion Plus Noise (THD+N) %
-1
Amplitude Deviation (dBr)
-2
-3
-4
-5
-6
-7
-8
0.05
0.02
0.02
0.01
0.01
0.005
0.005
0.002
0.002
0.001
20
-9
20
50
100
200
500
1k
2k
Frequency (Hz)
5k
10k
20k
50k
100k
0.001
20
50
100
200
500
1k
2k
5k
10k
20k
Frequency (Hz)
50
100
200
500
1k
2k
5k
10k
20k
Frequency (Hz)
Fig.2: frequency response of the mixer with the tone
controls set to their mid positions and gain at maximum.
Roll-off is only 1.2dB at 20Hz and -0.75dB at 20kHz while
the -3dB points are at 10Hz and 45kHz.
the mixer can be run off low voltage
AC or DC. An unregulated split supply
can also drive the unit in some cases,
as will be explained later.
For low voltage AC, 15-16V RMS
is supplied to CON6. Diodes D1 and
D2 act as two half-wave rectifiers,
charging the 100µF 50V capacitors
alternately as the AC signal swings
positive and negative to provide unregulated rails of approximately ±22V
DC. ((16 x 2 ) – 0.6V).
This is then regulated to ±15V by
REG1 (78L15, +15V) and REG2 (79L15,
-15V). The output voltages are filtered
with 100µF capacitors. Diodes D3 and
D4 prevent them from being reversebiased during operation, which could
cause REG1 or REG2 to “latch up”
when power is first applied. This
can happen because one rail starts to
03/22/12 11:21:15
Gain = 24dB
Gain
Gain==32dB
18dB
Gain
Gain==24dB
0dB
Gain = 18dB
Gain = 0dB
0.05
-0
-10
10
THD+N vs Frequency,Gain
80kHz
BW
= 32dB
Fig.3: performance with a 15VAC supply. At high gain
settings, noise and 50Hz hum field pick-up dominate the
distortion graph; the dip at 50Hz is when the test signal
cancels some of the mains hum.
charge up before the other due to the
half-wave rectification.
If the unit is to be run from a regulated split supply then this is connected
to CON7, bypassing the regulators and
powering the circuit directly.
If an unregulated split supply is to
be used then it can be connected via
the pads for D1 and D2, bypassing the
rectifier and feeding the regulators
directly.
The situation for a single DC supply
is a little more complicated. In this
case, the supply voltage is usually
well below 30V.
So to maximise the available
headroom (the amount by which the
signal can be amplified before clipping), the regulators are bypassed
(linked out) so that the full voltage,
minus D1’s forward voltage, is available to the op amps. D2 is also linked
out and power is applied via CON7.
In this case, since there is no negative supply, the signal ground potential
must be positive. This bias is generated
by op amp IC3a. The two resistors connected to its non-inverting input (pin
Another view of the completed
mixer, once again with input
terminal blocks. PCB mounting
RCA connectors could also be used. As
noted earlier, this is an early prototype, with
several component changes made to the final
version (including a double-sided board).
The PCB component overlay on P63 shows
the final version – use that when constructing
rather than this photograph.
62 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
100nF
IC3 TL074
47pF
39k
1.8k
33*
100k
VR4 10k LOG
6.8k
6.8k
10k
10k
10k
10k
10k
VR5 100k
1.5nF
100F 10F
6.8k
6.8k
D1
4004
D2
4004
D3
4004
D4
4004
BEAD
470nF
470
1M
220
100
100
1.8k
BEAD
100pF
100
100
IC2
TL072
470nF
1M
220
100pF BEAD
1M
220
100
100
IC1
TL072
470nF
100
100pF BEAD
100
1M
220
COMPONENTS IN
RED MAY BE CHANGED
TO ADJUST GAIN –
SEE TABLE
47pF
22nF
+
POT CASE
EARTHING
WIRE
VR3 10k LOG
100nF
10F
47F
10k
100
+
VR2 10k LOG
K
100k
+
100nF
100F 50V
LED1
POWER
10nF
1.8k
10F
10k
100F
A
+
VR1 10k LOG
10k
REG2
(25V)
+
10k
79L15
R4
100F 50V
CON5
470F*
C4 220pF
+
C3
10F
10F
10F
R5
+
1.8k
220pF
100F
+
220pF
100F
+
R3
1. 8k
100pF
CON7
+
R2
+
+
+
C1
C2
470nF
R6
CON6
–15V 0V +15V78L15
REG1
+
1.8k
CON4
+
R1
220pF
CON3
CON2
CON1
10F
470nF
2.2nF
POT CASE
EARTHING
WIRE
COMPONENTS IN
BLUE REQUIRED ONLY
FOR MICS NEEDING
PHANTOM POWER
VR6 100k
VR7 100k
PCBS FROM SILICON
CHIP WILL BE DOUBLESIDED SO ORANGE LINKS
WILL NOT BE NEEDED.
Fig.4: the complete component overlay for the Mix-It! mixer. In this case, we have shown 220Ω resistors and 220pF
capacitors in the R1/C1...R4/C4 positions which would make it suitable for guitars and many microphones. However, you
can change these resistors to suit other input devices (see the table on the circuit diagram) or even add switching to one or
more channels to allow the input(s) to be switched at will (see Fig.8). R5, R6 and the associated 100µF capacitor on input
4 are provided for microphones requiring “phantom power”. If you don’t need this, you can leave these components out.
3) form a divider across the supply
rails, producing a voltage of roughly
half the DC supply. For example, if
the DC supply is 12V, this point is at
about 6V. It is filtered using a 100µF
capacitor, to remove supply noise.
IC3a buffers this voltage, providing
a low output impedance and this is
filtered further using a 33Ω resistor
and 470µF capacitor. The 33Ω resistor prevents op amp instability due
to the large capacitive load. The RC
low-pass filter formed by the 33Ω
resistor and 470µF capacitor is important to achieve good performance
as even a tiny amount of supply ripple
coupling into the signal earth will be
greatly amplified and coupled into
the output, dramatically reducing the
signal-to-noise ratio and increasing
the distortion.
We would normally use a 100Ω resistor at the op amp output, to isolate
it from a capacitive load but experimentation shows that 33Ω provides
better hum rejection, presumably due
to the fact that higher values increase
the output impedance of the buffer
stage too much.
To quantify the loss of headroom
when running from a single supply,
12V DC can be considered equivalent
to a ±6V split supply. Considering limited op amp voltage swing, this gives
a maximum signal handling of about
(6V - 1V) / 2 ) = 3.5V RMS. With a fixed
gain of 10 at each input, the maximum
input level is then 350mV RMS.
siliconchip.com.au
That’s plenty for most microphones
and musical instruments but line level
sources are generally at least 500mV
and will clip unless they are attenuated somehow (or the input stage gain
is reduced; more on that later).
The foregoing explains why separate signal grounds and power supply
grounds are required with a single
rail DC supply is used. But when an
AC or split supply is used, the signal
ground is connected directly to power
supply ground to ensure the polarised
coupling capacitors are correctly biased. This is achieved by omitting the
33Ω resistor and replacing the 470µF
capacitor with a wire link.
All these options may seem confusing but we have provided diagrams
later showing which components to
install in each case.
Construction
The mixer is built on a PCB coded
01106121, 198 x 60mm. Refer to the
overlay diagram (Fig.4). If you are not
using an AC supply, refer also to one of
Figs. 5, 6, 7 or 8 to see the changes required to suit your particular situation.
The PCB will normally be doublesided with plated-through holes, so
there will be no need for links. However, we know that some schools like
to have students build their projects
“from scratch”, including making
PCBs where possible.
Because it is unlikely students (and
some readers!) will make a double-
GND
VR8 10k LOG
sided board, six tinned copper wire
links will be needed for single-sided
boards (they’re shown on the PCB
overlay).
Follow with the resistors. It’s best to
check the value of each with a digital
multimeter before fitting it - you can
also use the resistor colour code table
as a guide but it’s easy to make mistakes (brown for orange for red, for
example) so check them twice!
The 1N4004 diodes go in next, with
the striped (cathode) ends towards
the top of the PCB. If you’re using IC
sockets, mount them now, with the
notches orientated towards the bottom
of the PCB, as shown. Otherwise, just
solder the ICs into place, taking care
that they are orientated with pin 1
towards the bottom of the board. IC
sockets do make it easy to place and
remove ICs but we prefer to solder
them in permanently, as long as there
is no mistake!
If installing the regulator(s), bend
the leads to fit the pad spacings on
the board and solder them in place.
Don’t get them mixed up and ensure
that the flat side faces as shown on the
overlay diagram. The LED can be installed next, flat side also facing down,
followed by the ceramic and MKT
capacitors, from smallest to largest.
Solder 3-way terminal block CON7
in place, with the wire entry holes
facing the top edge of the PCB. If you
are using terminal blocks for the inputs
and outputs, fit them now too. Follow
June 2012 63
100F
K
LED1
POWER
IC3 TL074
47pF
1.8k
A
39k
D3
4004
D4
4004
470
100
IC3 TL074
47pF
1.8k
10F
100F
+
–22V
(25V)
CON7
100F
LINK
LIN
K
+
100F
K
+
79L15
100F 50V
LED1
POWER
39k
D3
4004
D4
4004
A
+
+
470
REG2
LINK
–15V 0V +15V
+
0V
IC3 TL074
DC INPUTS
LINK
100F 50V
33*
100k
SINGLE DC SUPPLY
+22V
+
+
100
–15V 0V +15V78L15
REG1
47pF
10F
100k
DC INPUTS
100F
LED1
POWER
+
10F
AC SUPPLY
100F
1.8k
K
+
(25V)
CON7
D1
A
39k
D3
LINK
100F
470F*
4004
100F 50V
CON7
4004
100
470
K
LED1
POWER
IC3 TL074
1.8k
47pF
D1
4004
D2
A
4004
100F
79L15
100F 50V
39k
D3
4004
D4
100
4004
+
470
REG2
LINK
+
100F 50V
CON6
–15V 0V +15V
+
100F
+
100F
+
+
+
CON7
LINK
+
CON6
–15V 0V +15V78L15
REG1
(25V)
10F
100k
100k
SPLIT DC SUPPLY, +/–15V
SPLIT DC SUPPLY, +/–22V
Fig.5: four variations on a theme . . . the mixer is quite versatile as far as power supply goes – simply wire yours
according to the power supply you are going to use.
with the DC socket and then the electrolytic capacitors, all of which have
the longer positive leads inserted in
the hole closest to the top edge of the
PCB (stripes towards the bottom edge).
Ensure the correct type of capacitor,
as shown on the overlay diagrams, is
placed in each location.
If you are using RCA sockets for the
inputs and outputs, mount them now,
checking that they are pushed down
all the way onto the PCB and that the
sockets are parallel to the board and
+20
perpendicular to the edge.
To minimise noise, all of the pot
bodies are connected together and
thence to the PCB with a 250mm length
of tinned copper wire. To prepare them
for soldering, hold gently in a vice and
file away a patch of the passivation
layer on the top of each pot (otherwise
the solder won’t take). If your pots have
long shafts, now is also a good time
to cut them to the length you require
(don’t forget to take into account any
case or cabinet width).
03/21/12 13:09:04
Mixer Tone Control Extents
+17.5
+15
+12.5
Amplitude Deviation (dBr)
+10
+7.5
+5
+2.5
+0
-2.5
-5
-7.5
-10
Flat
Max. Bass/Treble
Min. Bass/Treble
Max. Midrange
Min. Midrange
-12.5
-15
-17.5
-20
20
50
100
200
500
1k
Frequency (Hz)
64 Silicon Chip
2k
5k
10k
20k
Fig.6: the
operation of the
tone controls.
The blue trace
is the same as
Fig.2 but with a
different scale.
The tone controls
allow a boost or
cut of around
10dB for each
band with the
centre frequencies
around 30Hz for
bass, 1kHz for
mid-range and
above 20kHz for
treble.
Solder the pots in place, ensuring
that you note the difference between
the three 100kΩ linear types and the
10kΩ log types. While you have the
soldering iron in your hand, run a
thin layer of solder over the surface
of the pot where you just removed the
passivation.
Now solder one end of the tinned
copper wire to the pad marked “GND”
to the right of VR8, bend it over the top
of VR8 and then solder it to the top of
VR1, so that the wire passes across the
top of each pot. Once it is held tightly
in place, solder it to the top of the
remaining pots and trim the excess.
If you are using them, fit the nylon
spacers to the four mounting holes and
then, if you are using sockets, insert
the ICs. They must be orientated with
their pin 1 dots at the same end as the
notches on the sockets, ie, towards
the bottom of the board. If not using
sockets, carefully solder in the ICs,
again noting orientation.
Housing it
The mixer should ideally be housed
in an earthed steel case, although it can
be used inside an amplifier or guitar
amplifier/speaker case.
If putting it in a case, the pots are
all 25.4mm (1 inch) apart so you will
need to drill a horizontal row of eight
siliconchip.com.au
8mm diameter holes in the front panel.
The board can then be “hung” behind
the front panel via the potentiometers.
You may need to snap off the small
locating spigots on each pot with small
pliers (or, preferably, drill small pilot
holes to accommodate them. The spigots stop heavy-handed users trying to
twist the pots on the panel).
While not really necessary, you can
also attach the PCB to the bottom of
the case using the tapped spacers – although this method of mounting might
be preferable if poking the pot shafts
through a thick (eg, guitar speaker
box) panel.
The most common input connectors
for guitars, microphones and so on will
usually be 6.35mm jack sockets and/or
XLR sockets. The PCB is designed to
accommodate RCA sockets“on board”
but this may not be the most convenient to use.
The altenative is to mount the sockets on a case panel – often they are
mounted on the front panel or adjacent
vertical panel next to their respective
controls. If so, you will need to run
shielded cable from the sockets to the
input connectors (CON1-CON4).
The output can then go to an RCA
socket on the rear panel or to an internal power amplifier. Either way, use
shielded cable for this connection too.
When using chassis-mount jack
sockets, use switched sockets and wire
them to short out the input signal when
nothing is plugged in, to minimise
noise and hum. See Fig.7 for details
on how to do this.
The power supply wiring can then
be run. Wire split supplies (+15V,0V,15V) up to CON7. Single DC supplies
or low voltage AC go to CON6. The
overlay diagrams show how the wires
are connected.
If you want a front-panel power
indicator, it is possible to mount LED1
off-board and connect it up with flying
leads and optionally, a pin header.
Testing
Turn all the volume knobs, including master volume to their minimum
(ie, fully anti-clockwise) and set the
tone controls to their centre positions.
Switch on the power supply and check
that LED1 lights.
Plug the output of the mixer into
a suitable amplifier and turn that on
– with level controls at a minimum
you should hear nothing! It’s then
just a matter of applying a signal to
siliconchip.com.au
Parts list – Mix-It! Four Channel Mixer
1 PCB, code 01106121, 198 x 60mm (available from SILICON CHIP for $20 + P&P)
5 2-way mini terminal blocks (CON1a-CON5a) OR
5 PCB-mount switched RCA sockets (CON1-CON5)
1 PCB-mount DC socket (CON6)
1 3-way mini terminal block (CON7)
8 small knobs, to suit VR1-VR8
4 small ferrite beads
1 plugpack or other power supply
1 250mm length tinned copper wire (or 400mm if wire links are used)
4 M3 nylon tapped spacers
4 M3 x 6mm machine screws
2 8-pin DIL sockets (optional)
1 14-pin DIL socket (optional)
Semiconductors
2 TL072 dual low noise JFET-input op amps (IC1, IC2)
1 TL074 quad low noise JFET-input op amp (IC3)
1 78L15 +15V 100mA linear regulator (REG1)
1 79L15 -15V 100mA linear regulator (REG2)
1 green 5mm LED (LED1)
4 1N4004 diodes (D1-D4)
Capacitors
1 470µF 16V electrolytic
2 100µF 50V electrolytic
4 100µF 25V electrolytic
1 47µF 50V electrolytic
7 10µF 50V electrolytic
5 470nF MKT
3 100nF MKT
1 22nF MKT
1 2.2nF MKT
1 1.5nF MKT
4 220pF ceramic
4 100pF ceramic
2 47pF ceramic
Resistors (all 1%, 0.25W)
4 1MΩ
2 100kΩ
1 39kΩ
9 10kΩ
6 1.8kΩ
4 220Ω
9 100Ω
1 33Ω
5 10kΩ logarithmic 16mm potentiometers (VR1-VR4, VR8)
3 100kΩ linear 16mm potentiometers (VR5-VR7)
one input, then slowly turning up
corresponding input and master volume controls, to check that the output
sound is undistorted.
Note that since there is a fair bit of
gain available, if you use a line level
source, you won’t have to turn the
volume knobs up very far.
Check each of the four inputs in
turn and also check that the tone
controls have the appropriate effect
on the signal.
If you hear a lot of hum or noise,
it’s probable that it’s being induced
into the sensitive input stages from
whatever amplifier you’ve teamed the
mixer with – in which case, you might
need to house the unit in an earthed
4 6.8kΩ
metal box inside the amplifier case.
Alternately, hum may be caused
by a hum loop, either from the power
supply or the input cabling. You might
need to experiment a little with earthing arrangements for best results.
Making changes for MP3s etc
Some constructors may wish to
experiment with some component
values. By doing so, you can adapt it
to your particular requirements.
For example, the feedback resistors
for IC1 and IC2 can be changed to give
different maximum gain settings for
each input. You could, for example,
reduce the gain of inputs 1 & 2 so that
they can accept signals up to 1-2V
June 2012 65
RMS, suitable for use with a CD or
DVD player while leaving inputs 3 &
4 with a high gain to suit microphones
or a guitar. Or you could increase the
gain of one channel above the nominal
31dB to suit a microphone with a very
small output signal.
The easiest way to change the gain
of each input is to change the values
of R1 and C1 for channel 1, R2 and
C2 for channel 2 and so on. Smaller
values for these resistors increase the
gain and larger values decrease them.
The associated capacitor is changed at
the same time, to keep the frequency
response constant. The table on the
circuit diagram shows various options for these components but other
combinations are possible.
You can also alter the gain for all
inputs by changing the 39kΩ resistor
between pins 8 and 9 of IC3c. A higher
value resistor will give you more
overall gain but will also increase the
noise and distortion. So for example, if
you change the 39kΩ resistor to 82kΩ
you will double the overall gain while
changing it to 22kΩ will halve it.
It may be possible to gain a slight improvement in performance by replacing the TL072 and TL074 op amps with
OPA2132/2134 or similar. However,
the benefits will be marginal as other
factors already limit the performance.
It is possible that some devices such
as iPods and MP3 players may not
work with the mixer as published as
there is no DC path for the input signals to flow to ground. This can easily
be solved with the addition of a resistor
(eg, 100Ω) connected across the input
for that channel. Probably the easiest
Improvements to a popular design
Since the original 4-channel mixer was presented in SILICON CHIP in January 1992, audio design has come a long way and
it was possible to make quite a few improvements in performance without adding much to the overall component count.
So we have made significant improvements to the original circuit and the PCB, as follows:
1) Added RF filtering, consisting of 100Ω resistors and ferrite beads in series with each input and a 100pF capacitor to
ground. These compents greatly reduce RF break-through. Testing with the prototype showed no suggestion of radio
signal break-through.
2) Increased the input impedance from 10kΩ to 1MΩ, so that musical instruments with inductive pickups suffer less high
frequency loss.
3) Increased the size of many of the inter-stage AC-coupling capacitors from 2.2µF to 10µF, to reduce low-frequency
distortion and give a more extended bass response. At the same time, we opted to use 470nF MKT capacitors at the
input instead of polarised 2.2µF electrolytic types, again to obtain lower distortion.
4) Added full AC-coupling for the input volume pots, to reduce crackle when they are turned (especially as the pots age).
5) Lowered feedback resistor values throughout, to reduce noise and hum pick-up. The feedback resistors around the initial
amplifier stages have been greatly reduced, from 22kΩ/1.2kΩ to 1.8kΩ/220Ω. This results in a 70% reduction in Johnson
noise, one of the predominant sources of noise in the circuit. The mixer resistors are also reduced from 47kΩ to 10kΩ.
6) Split the signal gain between the input amplifier and mixer stages. This allows line level signals of up to 900mV RMS to
be fed in before clipping occurs with a ±15V supply, compared to 500mV with the original design. The maximum gain is
also increased from 26dB to 31dB, to suit a wider range of microphones.
7) Slightly extended the upper frequency response, for a -3dB point at 45kHz.
8) Changed mixer to a virtual earth configuration. This eliminates interactions between channel volume settings,
allows for increased gain and reduces inter-channel crosstalk for those which are turned to minimum volume.
It also has the advantage of inverting the signal, which is then re-inverted by the tone control circuit, avoiding the need
for a final inversion to keep the inputs and output in-phase.
9) Added provision for either PCB-mount RCA sockets or terminal blocks for inputs and output. The original design used
PC stakes.
10) Added an on-board power supply. The original design required a regulated split rail power supply. This one can run
from 15V AC (plugpack or small mains transformer) or from single-rail or split rail DC. The op amp stage freed up by
changing to a virtual earth mixer is used as a rail-splitter (ie, virtual earth generator) for single-supply operation.
11) Added an on-power power indicator LED (which may also be mounted off-board, eg, on the front panel of the unit).
12) Reduced the op amp package count to three by replacing two of the LM833s with a TL074.
13) Reduced the size of the PCB to 198 x 60mm (compared to the original at 249 x 113mm).
66 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
PANEL
6.5mm
MONO
JACK SOCKET
SHORT
LENGTH OF
SHIELDED
CABLE
2
1
(PC BOARD)
CON1
(OR CON2/3/4)
Fig.7: how to wire a standard
switched phono jack as a shorting
jack and connect it to the PCB.
This is highly recommended as
otherwise, unconnected inputs may
contribute noise and hum to the
output of the mixer.
way to do this is between the terminals
of CON1a, CON2a, etc – even if there
other cables going in there!
However, an input modified in this
manner will no longer work with
some microphones, guitars and other
devices with a high output impedance
(normal 600 ohm “dynamic” microphones will not be too badly affected).
Phantom power for
condensor microphones
It would arguably be fairly unusual
for condensor microphones to be used
with a mixer such as this but it is
possible.
The difficulty is that condensor
microphones require a DC supply on
their output (known as “phantom”
power), normally around 16-48V at
1-2mA and uses the microphone cable
itself to feed the microphone.
Because the inputs to the op amps
are AC-coupled, feeding DC “up the
line” will have no effect on the mixer.
Phantom power can therefore easily be
achieved by connecting a bypassed DC
supply between the positive supply
and the “hot” side of the microphone
Making inputs truly versatile
We designed this mixer to be as
simple as possible to build with everything “on board”. This assumed
that constructors would nominate the
input device required for each channel and fit appropriate resistors and
capacitors for R1, C1, and so on (as
per the table on the circuit).
But what if you needed to regularly
swap inputs with devices that had different signal levels? It happens often
in, for example, a band – or where
various microphones are required to
suit vocals or instruments.
It would be quite simple to fit a
multi-pole switch to any or all of the
input op amps and so switch various
values of R&C.
For most applications, the input bias
resistors will be satisfactory. However,
you could bring these all down to
100kΩ if you really want to.
Small double pole (or “changeover”)
slider switches are available with up to
four positions (eg, Altronics S-2040),
so you could in theory fit four different
values of R&C on the switch (again,
as per the table on the circuit) and
then be able to select the input level
required according to the device being
connected and, of course, its signal
level. (See fig.8).
Alternatively, small rotary switches
Resistor Colour Codes
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
input.
We have made provision for this
on one channel only, channel 4, with
R5, R6 and a 100µF bypass capacitor.
If you do not require phantom power,
you can simply leave out these three
components.
In fact, you should not connect
phantom power to a microphone that
doesn’t need it. Putting a DC bias on
a dynamic microphone’s voice coil,
for example, will usually result in a
lower (or no) output and may even
permanently damage the microphone.
No.
4
2
1
9
4
5
4
5
1
Value
1MΩ
100kΩ
39kΩ
10kΩ
6.8kΩ
1.8kΩ
220Ω
100Ω
33Ω
siliconchip.com.au
4-Band Code (1%)
brown black green brown
brown black yellow brown
orange white orange brown
brown black orange brown
blue grey red brown
brown grey red brown
red red brown brown
brown black brown brown
orange orange black brown
5-Band Code (1%)
brown black black yellow brown
brown black black orange brown
orange white black red brown
brown black black red brown
blue grey black brown brown
brown gey black brown brown
red red black black brown
brown black black black brown
orange orange black gold brown
150 Ω
390Ω
TO PIN6
IC1b
1.8k Ω
150pF
330pF
560pF
1
2
(SIGNAL
GROUND)
3
1
2
3
TO PIN7
IC1b
Fig.8: adding input switching to
one or more channels is really
easy and makes the mixer much
more versatile (but does complicate
construction a little). Here we’ve
shown a 2-pole, 3-position switch
capable of selecting a microphone
(1), guitar (2) or line-level (3) source.
2-pole rotary switches with up to six
positions are also available if you
want more switchable inputs.
can be configured to have two poles
and six positions so most of the variations shown on the circuit diagram
could be accommodated.
The resistors and capacitors could
be wired directly to the switch and
three wires (eg, rainbow cable) run to
the appropriate positions on the PCB
(ie, the positions which would have
been occupied by R1, C1 etc).
Want more than four
channels?
Getting greedy, aren’t we!
Seriously, adding additional channels to a design of this type is easy
– you simply build additional input
circuits – up to and including the 10kΩ
resistor after the individual channel
“gain” pots (VR1-4).
The “mixed” output of the four new
channels is simply connected to the
negative side of the 47µF capacitor
before the existing IC3c, just as happens now.
Power (ie ±15VDC), can be taken
from a suitable point on the existing
mixer – the supply will handle it – and
signal and supply grounds also conSC
nected to a suitable point.
Capacitor Codes
Value µF Value IEC Code EIA Code
470nF 0.47µF 470n 474
100nF 0.1µF 100n 104
22nF 0.022µF 22n 223
2.2nF .0022µF 2n2 222
1.5nF .0015µF
1n5 152
100pF NA 100p 101
47pF NA 47p 47
June 2012 67
CIRCUIT NOTEBOOK
Interesting circuit ideas which we have checked but not built and tested. Contributions will be
paid for at standard rates. All submissions should include full name, address & phone number.
10
330
100k
A
3
ZD1
15V
100nF
1
K
150k
100k
100nF
A
OUTPUT
WHEN WATER DROPS BELOW
MIDDLE SENSOR, OUTPUT
GOES HIGH.
WHEN WATER RISES TO TOP
SENSOR, OUTPUT GOES LOW
5
2
K
A
4
IC1
555
6
ZD3
15V
10nF
8
7
K
+5–12V
ZD2
15V
0V
ZD1–3
WATER LEVEL
SENSORS
MIDDLE
TOP
BOTTOM
A
Tank water level
circuit with hysteresis
to the bottom of the tank, supplies
a common positive voltage into the
water with the current limited to
about 50µA via a 330Ω resistor.
The middle probe, connected to
pin 2, acts as the pump start trigger
when the level drops below it. The
top (shortest) probe, connected to
pin 6, provides the pump stop signal
when the level rises to it. Three-core
flex can be used to connect between
the tank probes and the controller.
With a full tank of water, all the
probes are covered and the output
from pin 3 of IC1 is low. As the water
drops below the middle probe, pin
3 goes high and turns on the pump.
The pump continues running until
This circuit simulates a water tank
float valve in that it has the hysteresis missing in other electronic level
sensor circuits. It delays the pump
from coming on every time the water
level drops by only a small amount
below the top probe as water is
drawn from the tank.
This circuit uses a 555 (IC1) to
drive a solid-state relay but a standard relay could be used instead to
control the pump. Three stainless
steel rod probes are cut to lengths as
required and are hung from the top
of the tank. The longest, reaching
K
the water rises to the top probe at
which point pin 3 goes low and turns
off the pump. The distance between
the middle and top probes sets the
hysteresis. The advantage of this circuit is its simplicity and reliability.
The basic circuit has been in use
for over 25 years for pump control
on farms, using 2-pair underground
telephone cables over distances of
100 metres between the tank sensor
and pump controller. The 15V zener
diodes were fitted after a lightning
strike on the farm took out the 555
but they cannot guarantee zero damage in the event of another strike.
Peter Robertson,
Walkerville, Vic. ($50)
470
470
K
K
REED
SWITCH1
ZD1
5.1V
9V
BATTERY
9V
BATTERY
A
A
LED2
LED1
K
VERSION 1
Really simple garage
door monitor
The 433MHz garage door monitor
presented in these page in the April
2012 issue is an elegant solution
where wiring between the garage
68 Silicon Chip
A
LED3
REED
SWITCH2
A
A
REED
SWITCH1
ZD1
5.1V
K
K
A
A
LED1
LED2
K
VERSION 2
doors and the monitoring position
is impractical. However, if it is easy
to run wiring, this very simple circuit (Version 1) will enable you to
tell whether the garage door (or any
door) is open or closed.
It employs just two LEDs, one
K
LEDS
ZD1
A
K
K
A
reed switch, a 5.1V zener diode, a
9V battery (or DC plugpack) and a
470Ω resistor. Only one length of
figure-8 cable needs to be run from
siliconchip.com.au
10k
1.5k
3.3k
14
4
Vcc R1
1
5
D1
O1
2
IC1a
Th1
556
3
CV1
6
Tr1
100 F
25V
ACTIVE
+12V FROM PLUG
PACK AT
TRANSMITTER
LOCATION
TO D2 ANODE
IN REMOTE
TRANSMITTER
(EXT INPUT),
SET TO
TRANSMIT
ONCE ONLY
1k
A
10nF
12V RELAY WITH
MAINS-RATED CONTACTS
433MHz RECEIVER
(IN TOGGLE MODE)
+
–
LED1
K
LIGHT
FITTING
REAR OF SWITCH
1
2
+12V
STANDARD
ROCKER
LIGHT C
SWITCH
2
180 5W
BR1 W04
C
LOOP
10nF
470k
470k
10nF
1
+
~
K
~
–
4.7k
10
13
12
8
100 F
25V
D2
Th2
Tr2
R2
9
O2
IC1b
556
CV2
1.5k
B
E
11
GND
7
C
10nF
the garage door. The reed switch is
installed so that it is closed when the
garage door is closed. This causes
LED1 to light.
When the reed switch is open,
LED1 is dark and LED2 is lit and
the assumption is that the door is
fully open.
siliconchip.com.au
A
12V SLA
BATTERY
D1
1N4004
K
LED
K
A
12V AC FROM PLUG
PACK AT LIGHT
FITTING LOCATION
ZD1
BC548
B
1N4004
K
REMOTE SWITCH TRANSMITTER
This circuit was devised to overcome a problem of switching lights
mounted on a concrete fence at the
entrance to a property. Conduit and
cabling was run from the switchboard on the side of the house but
running wiring to a switch inside
the house was difficult and impractical. Instead, this circuit allows
a standard rocker light switch as
made by HPM or Clipsal to be used
with the 433MHz Remote Switch
described in SILICON CHIP, January
2009.
When the switch is turned on, a
brief negative-going pulse is applied
to pin 6 of IC1a via a 10nF capacitor.
A
NEUTRAL
Q1
BC548
A
433MHz remote
lamp switching
2200 F
50V
ZD1
15V
1W
A
K
E
C
REMOTE SWITCH RECEIVER
This is configured as a monostable
which applies a brief trigger pulse
to the 433MHz transmitter module.
LED1 gives an indication of the
output pulse. The 433MHz receiver
module is set to toggle mode and it
turns the light on via its relay.
When choosing the timing components for IC1a, the time between
switching on and off should be kept
at least two seconds apart.
When the light switch is turned
off, the same sequence of events
is initiated by the second 10nF capacitor (at terminal 2 of the rocker
switch) and the light is turned off.
The second monostable, IC1b,
is provided to avoid malfunctions
if there is a blackout. When power
is first applied or restored, its pin
If you want to be sure that the
door is fully open, you need another
reed switch and an additional LED,
as shown in Version 2 of the circuit.
This will need three wires run from
the garage door rather than two.
The second reed switch is installed so that it closes when the
Geoff
is this m Coppa
9 goes high for
of a $15 onth’s winner
a few seconds,
0 gift vo
ucher fr
switching on Q1
Hare &
Forbes om
which pulls pin
4 low. This disables
IC1a so that it will not be
triggered during that period by the
10nF capacitors. After that period,
the circuit behaves normally.
At the receiving end, blackouts
are catered for by using a 12V SLA
battery which is trickle-charged by
a 12V AC plugpack.
Geoff Coppa,
Toormina, NSW.
Editor’s note: kits for the 433MHz
remote switch project are available
from Jaycar Electronics (Cat KC5473) and from Altronics (K-1955
& K-1956).
door is fully open. With this arrangement, LED1 is alight when the door
is shut, LED2 is alight when the
door is fully open and LED3 is alight
when the door is in an intermediate
position.
Robert Hall, ($40)
Massey, NZ.
June 2012 69
KINGBRIGHT CC56-11EWA COMMON CATHODE DISPLAY
22
31
32
DIG3
DIG2
DIG1
23
DIG4
8.8.8.8.
a
b
c
d
e
f
DIG1
Vss
19
STORE
9
RESET
14
13
12
1nF
7
IC3d
11
10
9
8
IC3c
IC3: 4093B
100k
O0
11
4518B O1 12
O2
Vss
8
4
CP0
9
6
12
RS
22pF
22pF
X1
32.768kHz
100k
11
MR
8
Vss
O3
5
7
O4
O5
6
4
O6
13
O8
IC1
4060B O7 14
Rtc
10
1 125mS
15
O9
10M
Ctc
PHOTO INTERRUPTOR
TRIGGER CIRCUIT FROM
'LED STROBE & TACHO'
SC AUGUST 2008
9
70 Silicon Chip
O11
2 250mS
O13
16
Vdd
O12
1k
3 500mS LK1
5
1nF
2
IC3b
10
15
IC3a
CP1 IC2b
MR
O3
14 8x
13 6x
LK2
O0
1
CP0
CP1
2
3
1
14
10k
10
LED
ANODE
PHOTO TX
COLLECTOR
CATHODE
& EMITTER
18
17
DIG2
DIG4
DIG3
15
16
g
21
SEGg
26
22
SEGe
DIR
/2
IC2a O2
4518B O1 4
5
6
O3
MR
16
VDD
7
3
/5
LK3
100nF
8
COUNT IN
SEGf
28
SEGd
25
27
SEGb
SEGc
23
SEGa
Vdd
24
IC4
ICM7217A
5V DC
100 F
16V
S1 POWER
–
7
16
26
35
21
27
30
36
1
5
10
14
2
6
11
15
3
8
12
17
19
24
28
33
20
25
29
34
+
Circuit Notebook – Continued
Optical tachometer uses
photo-interrupter
This circuit was designed to display the speed
in RPM of model Stirling engines fitted with a
slotted flywheel and a photo-interrupter trigger.
It can measure up to 9999 RPM and leading
zeroes are automatically blanked. The trigger
input is compatible with the LED Strobe & Tachometer described in the August 2008 issue
and any of the trigger circuits from that project
can be used.
The timebase is derived from a 32kHz watch
crystal using a 4060 14-bit counter and oscillator IC1, to produce a clock signal of 125, 250 or
500ms, as selected by link LK1. BCD counter IC2b
is used to generate the STORE and RESET control
signals for IC4, an Intersil ICM7217A 4-digit decade counter/display driver. It drives a Kingbright
CC56-11EWA 4-digit 7-segment LED display.
Note that the LED digit numbering differs between IC4 and the Kingbright display. The most
significant digit (MSD) is labelled DIG4 on IC4
but is digit 1 on the LED display. The decimal
points are not used.
Link LK2 selects either six or eight cycles of
the gate clock to allow for a range of slots in the
flywheel. The trigger input is buffered by IC3a
and divided down by IC2a. LK3 selects either
the direct input (no division), divide-by-2 or
divide-by-5 to drive the clock input of the 4-digit
counter.
Table 1 shows how to select the links for
various numbers of slots. The circuit diagram is
shown with the links set for a 100-slot flywheel
disc, ie, one that generates 100 pulses per revolution. In this case LK1 is set to 500ms, LK2 to six
counts and LK3 to divide the input by five. So if
the flywheel was turning at 60 RPM (one rev/sec)
it would rotate three times in the 3-second gate
period, resulting in 300 trigger pulses. Dividing
by five results in the correct 60 RPM display on
the counter. Note that no input signal will result
in a blank display due to the ICM7217A’s in-built
leading zero blanking.
The prototype used an ICM7217A which has
been discontinued by Intersil but Maxim are still
producing the device. The timebase circuit could
also be used with a 74C926 4-digit counter with
the following modifications: invert the RESETBAR signal from IC3c pin 10 (use IC3b) and conTable 1: Pulses Per Revolution (P/R) For RPM Display
LK1
LK2
Gate Clock Gate Count
ms
cycles
125
6
125
8
250
6
250
8
500
6
500
8
Gate
Period
secs
0.75
1
1.5
2
3
4
LK3
Direct
P/R
80
60
40
30
20
15
LK3
Divide 2
P/R
160
120
80
60
40
30
LK3
Divide 5
P/R
400
300
200
150
100
75
siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
C
E
B
Q1, Q2:
BC337/BC338
LEDS
10k
22k
100nF
K
A
+5V
POSITION
S1
NMEA (TTL)
4x 10k
5
3
7
9
8 R2in
13 R1in
7 T2o
15
R2o 9
R1o 12
T2in 10
T1in 11
1 F
3
IC2
MAX232
16
1 F
14 T1o
4
1
5
6
2
+5V
1 F
100nF
100nF
1 F
+5V
13
11
1
2
6
4 +3.3V
10k
4.7k
8
12
10
16
15
14
18
17
22
20
21
19
24
23
4.7k
4.7k
+12V
+12V
–
9–12V
DC INPUT
+
–
9–12V TO
MAXIMITE
+
–
+
3 WH/GRN
GND
+12V
ON/OFF
1 WH/ORG
2 ORG
NMEA
5 WH/BRN
+12V
0V
PPS
6 BRN
+5V
+5V
R/W
5
EN
6
26
25
4.7k
E
C
B
1k
E
Q2
C
1k
Q1
K
K
200mS
PPS
LED2
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 GND
1
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7
16 x 2
LCD MODULE
RS
TO/FROM
MAXIMITE
B
1k
K
4
2x
10k
100nF
LED3
NMEA
A
ALARM
LED1
A
0V
3
CONTRAST
K
A
B/L
+5V
+12V
100nF
2
Vdd
220
GARMIN 16HVS
GPS RECEIVER
MODULE
nect to RESET (74C926 pin 13); connect
the STORE-BAR signal from IC3d pin 11
to LATCH ENABLE (74C926 pin 5) and
connect the DISPLAY SELECT (74C926
pin 6) to ground.
Geoff Nicholls,
Hamburg, Germany. ($50)
A
Based on the very popular Maximite
(SILICON CHIP, March-May 2011), this
GPS clock display reads the NMEA
string from a Garmin 16HVS GPS module and gives a very accurate indication
of the time. It also displays date, day of
the week and day of the year.
The pushbutton (S1) toggles the display between time and position. There
is also an output that will light a LED
to show an alarm. It is set to toggle high
for two seconds every minute, four seconds every hour and six seconds every
24 hours. The rising edge of this alarm
occurs about 800μs after the pulse per
second (PPS).
The NMEA string contains all the
necessary information for the display.
Normally, the GPS module will output
the NMEA string after the PPS and if it
is displayed at that time it will be about
500ms late. The program receives the
NMEA string from the GPS, strips the
necessary information (parsing), adds 1s
to the time and waits for the next PPS. It
then updates the display. This ensures
the correct time is displayed.
The time it takes to update the first
line of the display is less than 45ms;
almost indiscernible to the eye. On the
24-hour changeover, the date will update
one second late.
The Garmin module is set to output
the $GPRMC string at 19200, 8, N, 1 and
the PPS is set to a width of 20ms. The
Garmin website gives information on
how to program the module.
Any GPS module can be used so long
as it can be programmed and will provide a PPS. This is essential for synchronisation to the correct time. A GPS 15L
module with a GA 29F antenna could
be used in place of the 16HVS.
The software (garmin1.bas) can be
downloaded from the S ILICON C HIP
website.
Trevor Dalziell,
Canberra, ACT. ($50)
VR1
10k
Accurate clock uses
Maximite and Garmin
GPS module
June 2012 71
Circuit Notebook – Continued
16
Vdd
IC1: 4093B
9
8
O12
IC1c
10
12
O11
14
13
10M
X1
32768Hz
O13
1k
11
10
O10
CP
IC1d
O9
O6
O5
10nF
O4
11 MR
2x
12pF
2x
12pF
O3
O0
Vss
8
16
2
Vdd
1
O9
O8
15
O7
14
12
O8
IC2
4020B O7 13
160k
27k
3
8
11
6
4
9
5
10
14
Vdd
S
Q
CLK
IC3b
D
R
7
Q
14
13
13
12
O6
CP0
O5
IC4
4017B
O4
CP1
O3
O2
Vss
7
15
9
O1
MR
Vss
O0
O5-9
8
11
9
6
5
1
10
7
4
2
3
12
16
Vdd
100k
100k
O9
O8
1
RESET
IC1a
O7
3
2
IC3: 4013B
6
S1
5
6
IC1b
4
7
10nF
Engine hours
counter
This timer circuit is used for a machine, such as a large air compressor,
that requires regular maintenance
after a fixed number of hours. Be
cause it uses discrete logic ICs instead of a microcontroller, it is fairly
complex but the CMOS chips are all
S
3
CLK
5
4
10nF
5
D
R
Q
IC3a
Q
1
1
2
14
10
15
D
CP
PL
MR
4
6
11 13
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4
14
Vdd
16
13
IC5
4018B
CP0
IC6
4017B
CP1
O5
O4
O3
O2
P0 P1 P2 P3 P4
2 3 7 9 12
cheap and readily available.
Essentially, the circuit is a crystalcontrolled counter that displays the
number of hours that the machine
has been running on a 2-digit 7-segment LED display. The circuit is
connected to the ignition switch and
the machine’s 12V battery.
When the ignition switch is off,
the counter stops, the 2-digit display
O6
Vss
8
15
O1
MR
Vss
8
O5-9
12
O0
11
9
6
5
1
10
7
4
2
3
is off and the circuit draws about
800µA from the battery. This is necessary to retain the counter value.
When the ignition switch is on, the
clock runs and the number of hours
run is displayed. A reset switch is
provided to set the counter to zero
and is pressed after the required
service has been completed.
IC1d, one inverter in a 4093 quad
Issues Getting Dog-Eared?
Keep your copies of SILICON CHIP safe with these
handy binders
REAL
VALUE
AT
$14.95
PLUS P
&
P
Available Aust, only. Price: $A14.95 plus $10.00 p&p per order (includes
GST). Just fill in and mail the handy order form in this issue; or fax (02) 9939
2648; or call (02) 9939 3295 and quote your credit card number.
72 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
D2
D1
K
A
a
a
f
K
2200 F
25V
100nF
A
g
e
ZD1
15V
1W
d
10 F
b
f
K
A
b
g
D3
e
c
c
d
1k
dp
a
K
+12V (FROM
BATTERY
POSITIVE)
dp
a
g
g
7x
1.5k
13 12 11 10 9 15 14
Oa Ob Oc Od Oe Of Og
5
Vdd
EL
8
IC10
4511B
Vss
+12V (FROM
IGNITION
SWITCH)
A
DISP2
DISP1
K
K
DA DB DC DD
7 1 2 6
27k
5
16
8
4
BI
13 12 11 10 9 15 14
Oa Ob Oc Od Oe Of Og
10nF
Vdd
EL
IC11
4511B
Vss
LT
3
K
7x
1.5k
DA DB DC DD
7 1 2 6
100 F
BI
A
ZD2
6.1V
1W
16
4
A
LT
D4
3
K
100
5
1
14
10
15
D
CP
PL
MR
4
6
6 11 14 2
O0 O1 O2 O3
11 13
O0 O1 O2 O3 O4
Vdd
16
5
10
IC7
4018B
P0 P1 P2 P3 P4
2 3 7 9 12
15
9
Vss
8
1
CLK
CE
UP/DN
BIN/DEC
PL
Vdd
15
16
5
10
IC8
4029B
P0 P1 P2 P3 Vss
4 12 13 3 8
9
TC
7
1
100nF
6 11 14 2
O0 O1 O2 O3
CLK
CE
UP/DN
BIN/DEC
PL
100 F
P0 P1 P2 P3 Vss
4 12 13 3 8
TC
7
0V
A
siliconchip.com.au
16
IC9
4029B
D1–D4: 1N4004
2-input Schmitt trigger inverter
package, is connected as a crystal
oscillator running at 32.768kHz. Its
signal is coupled via IC1c which is
gated off when the ignition switch is
off and on if the ignition is on. From
there it is applied to a frequency divider comprising IC2, IC3b, IC4, IC5,
IC6 & IC7 to divide the 32.768kHz
crystal frequency by 117,964,800.
This gives one pulse per hour.
This is fed to two cascaded 4029
decade counters, IC8 & IC9. Their
BCD outputs are fed to two 4511
BCD to 7-segment decoder drivers,
IC10 & IC11. These two last ICs
drive the two LED digits to display
the run time.
Gates IC1a & IC1b are wired as
an RS flipflop to provide a reset
pulse when momentary switch S1 is
pressed. This pulse resets the coun-
Vdd
ters and the display to zero. Zener
diode ZD2 is used to reduce the 12V
counter supply to approximately
5V when the ignition switch is off.
K
(BATTERY
NEGATIVE)
ZD1, ZD2
A
K
This reduces the supply current to
a low value.
Les Kerr,
Ashby, NSW. ($60)
$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$
$
$
contribution
$
$
$
$
$
$
$ As you can see, we pay $$$ for contributions to Circuit Notebook. But $
$
$
$ each month the best contribution (at the sole discretion of the editor) $
$
$
$ receives a $150 gift voucher from Hare&Forbes Machineryhouse.
$
$ That’s yours to spend at Hare&Forbes Machineryhouse as you see fit – $
$
$
$ buy some tools you’ve always wanted, or put it towards that big
$
$
$
$ purchase you’ve never been able to afford! Contribute NOW and WIN! $
$
email your contribution now to editor<at>siliconchip.com.au or post $
$
$
to PO Box 139, Collaroy NSW 2097 $
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$$
May the best man win!
June 2012 73
By NICHOLAS VINEN
PIC/AVR Programming
Adaptor Board; Pt.2
Last month, we described our new programming adaptor board
which works in conjunction with an In-Circuit Serial Programmer
(ICSP) to program most 8-bit & 16-bit PIC and 8-bit Atmel AVR
microcontrollers. Here, we give the details of how to build it and
how to use it.
A
S NOTED LAST MONTH, virtually all the semiconductor devices
in the PIC/AVR Programming Adaptor are surface-mount, apart from the
diodes and LEDs. This approach has
been taken otherwise the PCB would
have been impractically large.
Even so, the double-sided PCB is
fairly densely populated on the topside and has quite a few SMDs underneath as well. However, we have
specified SMDs with a “reasonable”
pin spacing so they should not be too
challenging to solder.
74 Silicon Chip
The double-sided PCB measures
116 x 127mm and has plated-through
holes and vias. The PCB is available
from the SILICON CHIP Partshop and
is coded 24105121. It isn’t practical
to make the board yourself, given the
number of vias, especially as some of
them are located under components.
The boards we provide not only have
plated through-holes but also a solder
mask and a silk-screened overlay on
both sides to make construction as
easy as possible.
Figs.4(a) & 4(b) show the component
overlays for both sides of the PCB.
Install the surface-mount parts on the
top first. You can refer to the panel
later in this article for a step-by-step
procedure on hand-soldering SMDs.
Note that most of the SMD components are static-sensitive and so you
should ideally build it on an anti-static
mat or using some other method to
prevent damage to the Mosfets and ICs.
Starting assembly
Start with the three small dual
diodes (D6-D8) and then fit the four
siliconchip.com.au
Q15
© 2012
100nF
100nF
100nF
1
24105121
IC9
4075B
1
IC12
4069B
1
IC7
4071B
1
IC11
4081B
IC10
4081B
IC6
4028B
1.1k
13k
1
100nF
+
1
470nF
Q4
Q24
Q25
220nF
100nF
1
100nF
220
4x
2N7002P
Q3
Q27
Q28
Q11
Q23
10F
+
100F
REG4
34063
VPP
VDD
PGD
GND
PGC
IC3
4051B
Q12
100nF
100nF
47k
100k
Q29 Q26
40-PIN ZIF
SOCKET
10F
220nF
2.2k
47k
2.2k
2.2k
47k
D4
4148
RN1 8x100k
LK1 16V
+ – 47F 25V
D1
5819
L1
470pF
220H
100nF
D6
BAT54S
D8
1 BAT54S
Q7
100nF
D3
4148
S1 MODE
Q16
LK2
100nF
1
100nF
10F
47k
RESET
1 100nF
IC13
74HC04D
100nF
IC17
4028B
POWER
OFF
O/C
1M
IC16
LM393
1
D2
4148
1k
47k
68k
100nF
100nF
MICRO LED2
POWER
ON
ON
MICRO LED3
33pF x2
100nF
Q17
1k
LED1
IC14
4013B
S5
0.1Ω
IC15
OP07
ON
REG2
3.3V
100nF
BAT54S
1
100nF
AVR
D7
4.7k
PIC
MISO
CON2
+
47F
25V
POWER
MOSI RST SCK
X1
100F
100F 100F
D5
REG3
2.5V
CON1
GND
Q22
2
VCC
VDD
1
Q1
1
10F
100nF
3
– +
+
+
4004
4
+
siliconchip.com.au
REG1
7805
POWER
OFF
100nF
100nF
Q1-Q25: FDS6912A
PIC/AVR Programming Board
(TOP OF BOARD)
AVR ICSP (ABOVE)
1
MOSI
1
24105121
+2.5V
VDD
VIN
IC2
4051B
IC1
4051B
IC4
4051B
MISO
SCK
RST
VPP
VDD
GND
PGD
PGC
GND
VCC
GND
PIC ICSP (ABOVE)
+3.3V
1
GND
Q6
Q20
DIP SWITCHES (ABOVE)
IC8
4071B
1
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Q8
100nF
100nF
Q19
Q18
Q2
Q14
Q1-Q25: FDS6912A
10F
Q21
IC5
4051B
100nF
1
Q10
Q13
Q9
+5VSW
Q5
2N7002P Mosfets. These diodes and
Mosfets look virtually identical so be
careful not to get them mixed up.
Follow with the 13 FDS6912A dual
Mosfets that go on the top of the board.
They are in 8-pin SOIC packages and
are not all orientated in the same manner so check carefully that each one is
the right way around before soldering
it in place. These Mosfets usually have
both a bevelled edge on one side of the
package and a dimple to indicate pin
1 – the position of both is shown on
the overlay diagram.
There are also 13 ICs (including
REG4) on the top of the PCB and they
go in next. Again, their orientations
vary so you should check each one
carefully. Some of the ICs may have
a dot or dimple indicating pin 1 but
some will only have a bevelled edge
so that is the most reliable way to tell
which way they go in. Many of the ICs
are in identical packages so take care
that each type goes in its designated
location.
Regulators REG2 and REG3 can now
be fitted. Solder the three pins and
then the tab. Don’t get the two mixed
up. Then you can fit the passive SMD
components, which consist of eight
100nF ceramic “chip” capacitors, two
220nF ceramic capacitors, three 10µF
ceramic capacitors and one 0.1Ω SMD
resistor/shunt.
It’s now time to fit components to
the other side so fit the four tapped
spacers at each corner on the top side
of the board, using M3 x 6mm screws.
That done, flip it over and it will rest
flat and level on the spacers rather
than the components you have just
finished soldering.
Refer now to Fig.4(b). There are a
further 12 FDS6912A dual Mosfets so
fit them now. Again, be careful with
orientation as it varies. Follow with
the five remaining ICs and then the
three passive SMD components: one
10µF and two 100nF ceramic capacitors. You can then remove the tapped
spacers and refit them on the other
CON3
USB
100nF
CON4
+
Fig.4: the overlay diagrams for both
sides of the PCB. Install the parts as
shown here, paying close attention to
the orientation of the ICs, Mosfets and
electrolytic capacitors. Pin 1 is shown
with a dot in one corner of the IC but
in some cases there may be no dot
and instead, a bevelled edge on the IC
package indicates the side with pin 1.
+16V
+5V
PIC/AVR Programming Board
© 2012
(UNDER SIDE OF BOARD)
June 2012 75
GND
Right: the underside of the PCB also
carries quite a few SMD ICs plus a
10μF SMD capacitor and two 100nF
SMD capacitors
This view shows the completed prototype.
Take care to ensure that the SMDs are all
mounted with the correct orientation (see
Fig.4). An accompanying panel describes
how the SMDs are soldered in.
side of the board, in preparation for
the next step.
Through-hole components
Now we come to the resistors. Check
each value with a DMM before soldering it into place. Follow with the five
diodes, orientated as shown on the
overlay diagram. There are three different types so be sure to put them in
the correct locations.
Mount the 40-pin production (or
dual-wipe) IC socket next, with the
notch at the top. Check carefully that
its edges are parallel to the edges of the
PCB before soldering more than a couple of pins, otherwise the ZIF socket
will be crooked when it is inserted
Bend the leads of REG1 down 90°
6mm from the plastic body and then
mount the tab onto the PCB using the
remaining M3 x 6mm machine screw, a
shakeproof washer and a nut. Do it up
tight, then solder and trim the leads.
Fit the 9-pin resistor network next,
with its pin 1 (usually indicated by
a dot) towards the righthand end of
the PCB. The 8-way DIP switch can
then go in, with the text right-side-up
76 Silicon Chip
as shown in the photos. That done,
solder the three LEDs in place with
their anodes to the right (flat sides to
the left), followed by the MKT and
ceramic capacitors.
Bobbin inductor L1 is next. There is
an extra pad on the PCB so that you
can fit different-sized chokes. If you’re
using the smaller type, make sure it is
soldered across the bottom two holes.
You can then fit slide switch S5 which
can go in either way, although you may
wish to mount it with the stamped
“ON” text at the top.
Now solder in the 2-way, 3-way and
6-way pin headers (CON5, LK2 and
CON1 respectively). Follow with the
IDC socket (CON2) and then crystal
X1. You can then fit all the electrolytic
capacitors with the longer lead though
the hole marked with a “+” symbol in
each case.
The DC and USB sockets go in
now. In each case, push them down
fully onto the PCB and ensure they
are aligned with the edge of the PCB
before soldering their pins. Attach the
USB socket’s tabs to the mounting pads
before soldering the smaller pins.
You can now mount the tactile
pushbuttons after pushing them down
firmly onto the top of the board. Orientate them so that the pins are on the
left and right sides.
Testing
First, check that the power supply
is operating properly. Move all the DIP
switches to their lower (off) positions.
The two pads for LK1 (below the DIP
switches) must not be shorted together.
If you have a current-limited bench
supply, set it for 9V and 100mA and
connect it between a convenient
ground point and the anode of D5.
Otherwise, you can use a 9-12V DC
plugpack. Leave S5 in the “off” position
and then switch on the power supply.
Check the output of REG1, at its
right-most pin. You can use the tab
or mounting screw to connect the
ground probe. You should get a reading very close to 5V. Assuming that’s
OK, switch on S5 and check that the
green power LED lights up.
There are two small round pads
to the right of LK1, below the DIP
switch bank, labelled “+” and “-”.
siliconchip.com.au
acitance between pins 6 & 8 of the ZIF
socket. This should be around 10µF.
Much less than that indicates a fault.
If that all checks out OK, chances are
good that your programming adaptor
board is working properly. You could
test other modes in a similar manner,
referring to the relevant microcontroller data sheets, but it would take a
while to check all the various modes.
It’s now time to install the ZIF
socket, with the lever towards the top
of the board. Support the PCB underneath the socket and press it down
hard. Its large pins are a tight fit but
they should go in with some effort and
it won’t easily come off again unless
you really need to remove it. The unit
is now ready for use.
Using it
These allow you to check the output
of REG4, which should be close to
+16V. However, since they are quite
close together, you may find it easier
to measure between TP1 (the positive
test point) and the same ground point
you used earlier, eg, REG1’s tab.
Confirm that REG4 is providing
around 16V. If not then switch off
and check it and the surrounding
circuitry for faults such as incorrectly
orientated components or bad solder
joints. Assuming that it’s OK, measure
the output of REG2 at its tab, relative
to the same ground point you used
earlier. You should get 3.3V.
You can now disconnect the power
supply and short LK1’s pads together
using a small blob of solder. Set up
the DIP switches for the PIC18F2xJ5x
series of microcontrollers, as shown in
Fig.5. Apply power, turn power switch
S5 on and then press the “Micro Power
On” pushbutton. The yellow LED
should light up. If the red LED lights
up, switch off and check for faults in
the power supply circuitry.
Check the voltage at pin 32 of the
ZIF socket (adjacent to pin 9), relative
siliconchip.com.au
to a convenient ground point, eg, the
tab of REG1. You should get a reading
of around 3.3V. Check that pins 8 and
31 read very close to 0V. They should
not be floating which normally gives
a reading somewhat above 0V.
Now set your DMM to continuity
mode and check that there is a good
connection between pin 1 of the ZIF
socket and the VPP pin of CON1 (rightmost). Check this in both directions,
ie, swap the multimeter probes around
and ensure that there is a connection
either way. You can then perform the
same test to check that ZIF socket pin
40 (upper-right) is connected to PGD
(CON1, third-from left) and that socket
pin 39 connects to PGC, the secondfrom-left pin of CON1.
Now use the DMM to check that the
five right-most pins of CON1 are not
connected to each other. You may get
a brief beep out of the multimeter with
the probes between VDD and GND due
to power supply bypass capacitance.
There should not be continuity between PGD, PGC and VPP.
Assuming that your DMM also has
a capacitance mode, measure the cap
Figs.5 & 6 provide the instructions
you need to operate the unit. These
can be copied and laminated to keep
with the unit. Note that it’s generally
not a good idea to change the positions
of the DIP switches while the unit is
switched on as the design assumes
that all the logic is static. This also
avoids the possibility that you might
accidentally change to the wrong mode
while a microcontroller is in the ZIF
socket and powered up.
Note that some PICs require 5V for
programming even though they can
run at 3.3V (eg, PIC12F675). For this
reason, it’s generally best to program
with a 5V supply if the micro is rated
to operate at 5V, which may require
different DIP switch settings than
those shown in Fig.5. If in doubt,
check the data sheet.
Generally, LK2 can be left in its
default position, with the jumper
shunt across the bottom two positions.
That way, the in-circuit programmer
receives power at the same time as the
micro and so it won’t try to “probe” it
when it is unpowered.
But if the programmer is to provide
power for the micro and you want to
be able to switch it using the on-board
power on/off buttons, you can move
the shorting block to the other position. In this case, the programmer’s
VDD pin is the source of voltage for the
micro power supply circuitry, including the electronic fuse (although incircuit programmers normally provide
some form of current limiting too).
Programming dsPIC30s
We last published a PIC programJune 2012 77
Setting The DIP Switches & Programming The Device
PIC/AVR Programming Adaptor Board Device Selection
PIC12F-,
PIC12HV-
A All
A 50x, 51x, 526, 63x, 67x, 68x, 690, 720, 721, 785, 145x, 150x, 1823-1825, 1828, 1829
PIC16F-,
PIC16LF-
B 54, 7x, 8x(A), 540, 61x, 62x(A), 648(A), 716, 1826, 1827, 1847
C 722-726(A), 737, 767, 882, 883, 886, 913, 916, 151x, 17xx, 1906, 193x
D 707, 747, 777, 87x(A), 884, 887, 914, 917, 1904, 1907
PIC18F-,
PIC18LF-
A 1xK2x
D 4x1x, 4x2x, 4x3x, 4x8x, 4xK2x, 4xK8x
B 1220, 1230, 1320, 1330
E 1xK5x
G 4x5x
C 2x1x, 2x2x, 2x8x, 2xK2x, 2xK8x
F 2x5x
H 2xJ1x, 4xJ1x, 4xJ5x
M *2xJ5x
PIC24E-
I All
PIC24F-
I J16MC102
PIC24H-
I J16GP102, J16MC102, J32MC202, J32MC204, J16GP304, J32GPx0x, J64GPx0x, J120GPx0x
J 0xKA102, 0xKLx01, 0xKLx02
K JxxGAx0x
L JxxGB00x
dsPIC33E-
I All
dsPIC33F-
I J12GP202, J12MC202, J32GP30x, J32MC30x, J64GPx0x, J64MCx0x, J128GPx0x, J128MCx0x
ATtinyATmega-
N 13(A)(V), 15L, 25/45/85(V)
O 26(L), 261/461/861(A)(V)
Q 48/88/168/328(P)(A)(V), 8(A)(L)
P 2313(A)(V), 4313
Q 48/88
R 16/32(A)(L), 164/324/644/1284(P)(A)(V), 8535(L)
x = any digit 0-9 (P), (A), (V), (L) = optional letter suffix
A
E
I
M
P
On
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
On
F
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
On
J
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
On
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
*
(PIC18F-)
On
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
M
Q
On
C
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
On
G
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
On
K
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
On
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
On
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
*
(PIC18LF-)
N
R
On
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
On
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
On
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
On
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
D
H
L
O
On
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
On
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
On
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
On
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
On
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Setting shown for
Setting shown for
(AVR only)
External clock may
3.3V programming;
3.3V programming;
be enabled. Use
some micros may need 6 7 8 5V not recommended
6 7 8
6 7 8
4 5 6
only if necessary.
5V for programming.
and may be disabled.
Fig.5: this diagram shows the supported devices along with the relevant DIP switch configuration. Look up the
part series in the table at the top, then find the letter code for the particular suffix and set the DIP switches to the
corresponding configuration. There may be some parts not listed here that can be programmed in one of the modes.
Setting shown for
5V programming;
3.3V also suitable.
78 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
PIC/AVR Programming Adaptor Board Step-by-Step Guide
1
Set power switch in "off" position
2
Look up device to be programmed in Device Selection sheet and set DIP switches as shown.
3
Lift ZIF socket level and insert microcontroller with pin 1 at upper-left.
Hold microcontroller steady and push lever down until it locks.
4
Launch PC software, select correct target device and connect programmer to CON1 or CON2.
Do not connect both PIC and AVR programmers at the same time.
5
Switch on power to programming adaptor board. Check that green LED is lit.
6
Press “Micro Power On” pushbutton. The yellow LED should light up. If red LED lights instead, press “Micro Power Off”
button and re-check DIP switch positions.
7
If providing external microcontroller power (eg, from PICkit3), enable it now.
8
Check device signature using PC software. This is automatic with Microchip MPLab. Assuming it is correct, you can then
proceed to program, read and/or verify the flash memory in the target microcontroller as required.
9
If providing external microcontroller power (eg, from PICkit3), switch it off now.
10 Press “Micro Power Off” pushbutton and switch board power off.
11 Lift ZIF socket lever. The microcontroller can be safely removed.
39
10F
6
10F
34
7
32
39
32
10F
12
Insert a wire link in the ZIF
socket as shown here to
program PIC18F2331 or
PIC18F2431 micros in
mode C .
An extra 10F tantalum or
ceramic capacitor is required
to program PIC18F44J10 or
PIC18F45J10 micros in
mode D .
An extra 10F tantalum or
ceramic capacitor is required
to program PIC24FVxxKA301
but not PIC24FxxKA301
micros in mode K .
An extra 10F tantalum or
ceramic capacitor is required
to program PIC24FVxxKA302
but not PIC24FxxKA302
micros in mode K .
Fig.6: here are the instructions for using the unit, along with the special case devices which can be programmed with
an extra wire link or 10µF capacitor inserted in the ZIF socket. Ensure that this extra component is well clamped at
both ends before applying power and take care with tantalum capacitor orientation.
mer in the May 2008 issue. This was
called a “Low-cost Programmer for
dsPICs and PICs” and it connected to
the PC via a serial port. That project
required the now-defunct WinPIC softsiliconchip.com.au
ware which is still available but is not
being updated to suit newer micros or
the latest Windows operating systems.
Most constructors would be better
off with the new design described here
because it can handle a larger portion
of the PIC range, works with up-to-date
software and is easier to use. The one
thing the previous unit can do that this
one can’t is to program dsPIC30F miJune 2012 79
Soldering In The Surface Mount Devices (SMDs)
Installing an SMD IC: (A) place a small amount of solder on the top-right pad;
(B) re-melt the solder & slide the IC, the solder the diagonally opposite pad;
(C) solder the remaining pads (ignore solder bridges); (D) remove the excess
solder using solder wick and clean up using isopropanol.
If you don’t have a solder reflow
oven, you can solder the SMDs one at
a time, by hand. With a little practice,
this isn’t too difficult, especially since
the parts used in this project have a
relatively large spacing between pins.
You will need a temperature-controlled soldering iron with a mediumsize or smaller conical tip, a magnifying
glass (preferably a magnifying lamp),
angle-tip tweezers, some desoldering
braid (or solder wick) and a syringe
of no-clean flux paste (Jaycar Cat.
NS3039, Altronics Cat. H-1650). Don’t
try to attempt the job without these
basic tools, otherwise you could wreck
both the ICs and the board.
You don’t need to use a very thin
tip on the soldering iron. In fact, using
a thin tip can make the process more
difficult when it comes to applying
enough heat to the solder wick and
getting the solder to reflow properly.
The standard tip supplied with most
good irons should be sufficient and a
medium to fine conical tip works well.
Be sure also to use fine, good quality solder (0.71mm diameter solder
is ideal).
Step-by-step procedure
The step-by-step procedure for
soldering in each SMD is as follows:
(1) Remove one part from the tube
or tape packaging. With tape, peel
back the clear layer using tweezers
to expose one device at a time. Take
care not to drop the smaller devices as
they can be impossible to find if they
land on the floor.
(2) Find the location for that component on the PCB. Place the board flat
on the workbench with the right side
up and orientated so that pin 1 will be
at upper-left.
(3) Apply a tiny amount of solder to the
top-right pad for the device (or top left if
you are left-handed). To do this, briefly
touch the pad with the soldering iron
and add a dab of solder – just enough
Current Limit Adjustment
Once you have finished programming a chip, by default it will immediately
begin executing the new program code. However, while the electronic fuse
current limit has been chosen to supply sufficient current for programming the
micro, in some cases it may not be enough once it starts operation, especially
with high-speed parts such as dsPIC33s. In this case, the micro power will trip
off immediately after programming is complete and you will lose the ability to
perform further operations, even if you reset the micro power supply.
There are two solutions to this. The first is to set the in-circuit programmer
to hold the micro in reset once programming is complete. This can be done
in Microchip MPLAB via the Programmer menu using the “Hold In Reset” option. However, this option is only available when the programmer is operating
normally so you have to do this first.
The other option is to increase the current limit to allow the micro to operate
once it is programmed. This can be done by reducing the value of the 68kΩ
feedback resistor across IC15 (adjacent to D2 on the PCB). For example,
substituting a 47kΩ resistor increases the current limit to around 130mA. Avoid
increasing it much more than this; if the current limit is high enough, you risk
damage to the micro under fault conditions.
80 Silicon Chip
so that you can see smoke from the
flux – then quickly remove the iron.
You should now be able to see a
small solder bulge on that pad (check
with a magnifying glass if unsure).
(4) Clean the tip of the iron with a damp
sponge to remove any excess solder.
(5) Place the component next to (but
not on) the pads. If you are righthanded, place it slightly to the left of
the pads and vice versa.
(6) For leaded components (ICs,
Mosfets and diodes), check that the
leads are resting on the PCB surface.
Capacitors and resistors should lie flat
on the board. For resistors, keep the
label side up.
(7) Check that the component orientation is correct. For ICs, ensure that the
corner dot/dimple or bevelled edge is
on the lefthand side. SOT-23 FETs and
dual diodes have a triangular pin layout
so the necessary orientation should
be clear. Other components (resistors, capacitors) are not polarised and
orientation is not important.
(8) Grab the part by its sides using a
pair of angled tweezers.
(9) Use the soldering iron to melt the
solder on the top right pad, then gently
slide the part along the board and into
place. Remove the soldering iron immediately it is in place.
This process should only take a couple of seconds, to avoid overheating
the pad and the component.
cros. While a small range of dsPIC30s
is still available, they have essentially
been made obsolete by the dsPIC33F
and dsPIC33E/PIC24E series.
As a result, we don’t expect many
people still use them. If you need to
program one, you could use the May
2008 programmer or alternatively,
build a programming jig on stripboard.
USB power
Finally, if you are going to run the
board from USB power, it generally
draws less than 100mA. However,
depending on the exact configuration
and the micro being programmed, it
could draw more so it’s a good idea to
run it from a computer host port or a
powered hub, especially since it has no
circuitry to negotiate power allocation
from the host computer.
siliconchip.com.au
Don’t worry about getting it in
exactly the right place the first time.
Just try to avoid getting any solder on
the other pins. As long as you do that,
repositioning the part is easy.
(10) If the part is not exactly lined up
with the pads, simply re-melt the solder and nudge it until it is. Wait a few
seconds between each attempt. When
the part is correctly lined up, all its pins
will be centred on their pads.
(11) Once you are happy with the
alignment, re-check that the component orientation is correct, then
rotate the board 180° and solder the
pin at the opposite corner. It shouldn’t
move much during this step but if it
does, reheat the joint and adjust it as
necessary.
(9) Now solder the rest of the pins. The
parts used here can be successfully
soldered one pin at a time without
forming bridges but don’t worry if
you do get bridges as they are easily
removed later. It’s more important to
make sure that solder has flowed onto
all the pins and pads.
(10) Even if you have no bridges, it’s
recommended that you apply a thin
layer of flux paste along both rows of
siliconchip.com.au
pins, towards the outside. A thin layer
should be enough (you can always add
more later if necessary). You can now
remove any excess solder.
That’s done by placing a length of
solder wick immediately alongside
(but not on top of) some of the pads.
Now place the soldering iron on top of
the solder wick, pressing it down onto
the board, while gently sliding the wick
towards the solder on the pads.
As the wick heats, it will start to melt
the flux and the excess solder, creating
visible smoke. At that point you can
slide it right up against the pins. Most
of the excess solder should then be
sucked into the braid. Finally, slide the
wick along the board away from the
pads and lift it and the soldering iron
off the board.
At all times, you should be pressing
down onto the PCB only while sliding
the wick along it. The whole process
should take no more than about 5-6
seconds.
Don’t worry if some solder bridges
are left behind – rather than applying
the heat for too long, it’s better to remove what’s left with a second pass.
When you are finished, the pins should
be left with a near-perfect amount of
solder and no bridges.
The reason we recommend that
you do this even if there are no visible
bridges is that it virtually guarantees
good solder joints by reflowing the solder with the additional flux. Otherwise,
it’s possible to get a joint that a cursory
check suggests is OK but on closer
inspection, the solder has adhered to
the component pin but has not flowed
down onto the pad below it.
(11) Repeat the above process for the
other side of the component.
(12) Inspect the part using a magnifying glass to check for any solder
bridges or bad joints. If there are solder
bridges, apply a little flux and then use
the solder wick to clean it up.
(12) If you are using no-clean (noncorrosive) flux (ie, the recommended
type) then you theoretically don’t need
to clean off the flux residue. However
since this board won’t necessarily be
installed in a housing, it’s a good idea
to clean the sticky flux off it using pure
alcohol (eg, isopropanol).
Finally, if you do get flux on your
hands, be sure to wash them as it
SC
can be toxic.
June 2012 81
Agilent’s
Dynamic
Signal
Analyser
Review by
Allan Linton-Smith
The Agilent 35670A has been around for many years and has become
virtually the industry standard for sound and vibration engineers.
As well as carrying out audio analysis, it is equally at home with
measurement applications in aeronautical, structural, mechanical,
civil, automotive and electronics engineering.
It can be used for everything from analysing microphones to earthquakes,
from examining bridges and beams for metal fatigue to vibration in
motors.
82 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
35670A
T
he 35670A has been in production for quite a few years and has
not undergone any significant
updates in that time, so it still looks
and feels like a 1990s instrument.
On the other hand, it is a real workhorse in the field, built to withstand
tough conditions and able to be operated from mains or battery. But it is also
a very accurate bench top instrument
with many useful features not readily
found elsewhere. So in effect, the Agilent 35670A is “an oldie but a goody”.
siliconchip.com.au
What other instrument can analyse
a bridge beam or automobile chassis,
analyse for metal fatigue or troubleshoot engine problems?
One of the photos in this review
shows a typical automotive test for
analysing road and engine noise. Sensors can be placed at various locations
around the vehicle and a connection
made to the tachometer input for determination of noise vs RPM.
Closer to the interest of those in the
SILICON CHIP offices, it measures THD
and does spectrum analysis (via FFT)
simultaneously on two channels. You
can also “save to table” and observe or
print out the value of each harmonic
in the spectrum analysis.
It is extremely sensitive and can
accurately measure RMS voltages
down to the nanovolt region, which is
important when using accelerometers
and sensors. (Most audio analysers
have trouble analysing RMS levels
less than 10mV.)
It has a 16-bit ADC (90dB dynamic
June 2012 83
The rear panel houses sockets for the GPIB interface, keyboard, serial and
parallel ports plus power supply inputs (AC and DC) and power switching
options. We used the blue GPIB-USB device to connect to our computer to
download coloured traces.
terfall displays, frequency response
using both Fast Fourier Transform
(FFT) or swept sine and it also has an
optional arbitrary waveform generator. This latter option is also capable
of generating repetitive waveforms
which have been previously stored.
Various averaging modes let you
further refine spectrum analysis measurements. Time averaging extracts repetitive signals out of the noise while
RMS averaging reduces the noise to
its mean value.
The instrument also has “exponential” averaging for both time and RMS
volts. This is useful for reducing the
noise while following changing signals, such as tracking the resonance
shifts in a fatiguing structure; when
metal fatigue happens the natural
resonance changes drastically and is
easily observed with this instrument.
Other features
range) and a real time bandwidth of
0-25.6kHz so you can be sure nothing will be missed. In the swept sine
mode, the dynamic range increases
to a whopping 130dB.
You can resolve signals using
100-1600 lines or for really close-in
analysis, use the frequency zoom
to resolve signals with up to 61µHz
resolution. (Even very good spectrum
analysers can only manage about 1Hz
resolution!).
There is a facility for time or RPM
arming to develop waterfalls of sequential vibration spectra for trend
analysis, or for an overview of device
vibration.
You can match your spectrum
measurement mode to the signal being tested and use the linear spectrum
analysis to measure BOTH the amplitude and phase of periodic signals
such as the spectra of rotating machinery. Power spectrum analysis is
provided for averaging non-repetitive
signals.
In addition to all this, it can timecapture waveforms, measure phase
distortion, side-band power, noise
power, display spectral maps, wa-
Fig.1: the trace shows 10 averages the spectrum of 50Hz
mains harmonics up to 1.63kHz. The signal has been
significantly attenuated to prevent instrument overload.
Each harmonic is marked and a THD figure is calculated
shown in red. In this case 31 harmonics can be read and
the THD is 2%
84 Silicon Chip
The 35670A is a standalone instrument requiring no peripheral computer for general operation, although we
used a small laptop PC to record traces
and to add captions and colours.
The standard instrument allows
you to look at signals in the frequency,
time and amplitude domain and there
are several options which are available to either add new measurements
or enhance all measurement modes.
Options:
AY6 adds two channels (four total)
IDO computed order tracking
Fig.2: a spectrum waterfall of mains harmonics gathered at
160 specified time intervals. A base suppression of 24% was
used to eliminate noise. The lower chart is a slice of activity
between counts 146-160 where the red marker is positioned
at 1.326kHz showing around 1 microvolt. Our mains
harmonic distortion looks like a veritable graveyard!
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.3: a comparison of the HYQ-5 microphone vs the Behringer
ECM 8000 for our loudspeaker frequency response article (SC
Dec 11) using the back/front display mode with the 1/3 octave
real time option. Pink noise was used and fed to a
loudspeaker and simultaneously picked up by both mics
positioned closely. It can be seen that at 1kHz the HYQ-5 is
only about 5dB less sensitive than the much more expensive
calibrated ECM 8000 and is very close in response too!
ID1 real-time octave measurement.
UK4 microphone adapter and power
supply
ID2 swept sine measurements (has a
dynamic range of 130dB)
ID3 curve fit and synthesis
ID4 arbitrary waveform source
IC2 Instrument Basic
Our 2-channel instrument had all of
the options fitted except Instrument
basic which allows you to develop
a custom user-interface, integrate
several instruments and peripherals
into a system using the 35670A as
the system controller and to automate
measurements. These can be added
retrospectively as can all the other
options if desired.
This option would be really useful
because there are a lot of buttons to
press for each setup and it is easy to
make a mistake.
There are large volumes of instrument and service manuals and application notes provided by Agilent and
very good explanations of the theories
Fig.5 mains harmonics are displayed to 25kHz and a peak
of 16.38kHz is displayed. THD figure is incorrect because
of “aliasing” errors and the “zoom” should be used for
accuracy, nevertheless we included this trace to show how
much rubbish is on our powerlines!
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.4: the blue trace shows harmonic distortion is
0.0063% from a very good sine wave generator. The
green trace is 0.1034% from a cheaper unit. The number
of harmonics set for measurement was 20 although 200
is possible! Bottom traces are the sine wave time record
simultaneously obtained from both units
behind all the more complicated tests.
The online HELP menu is particularly useful as it gives full screen
instructions of the functions of the
last button press.
It’s a rugged unit able to withstand
extremes of temperature (0-55°C),
altitude (4600 metres) and shock (up
to 10G!!).
Although it weighs in at 15kg it
remains a very compact and portable
unit well suited for applications in the
field, especially since it can operate
Fig.6 when the “help” key is pressed directly after the
“harmonic marker” key you get to view an excellent set
of instructions so you will never get lost!
June 2012 85
Fig.7 THD can
be saved to a
table which
shows the RMS
voltage of each
harmonic. In
this case we
were looking
at an improved
“Champ” LM386
chip which has
mainly second
harmonic
distortion. 10
averages were
used for this result
although you can
have 200 averages
if you wish!
from 12-28V DC as well as from 90264VAC.
At the back of the instrument there
is a BNC socket for the source signals,
external trigger and tachometer input,
capable of handling 42V peak, so you
can read RPM without any signal
conditioning (such as a micro switch
or solenoid)
There is also the power select switch
which switches between AC and DC
power sources without interrupting
operation and is protected from accidental switching.
There is a parallel port and a serial
port for printers (sorry, no USB) and
also a keyboard socket to accommodate a standard PC keyboard, which
allows you to add captions and control
the instrument.
There is an HPIB (Hewlett-Packard
Interface Bus) connector which can be
used for controlling and programming
the instrument using an appropriate
interface or linking it to other instrument equipped with HPIB (or GPIB –
General Purpose Interface Bus).
There has been quite a bit of discussion on the internet about saving
traces to files but we used the National
Instruments GPIB-USB converter
to download traces into a notebook
computer using John Miles’s excellent
(free) HP7470A emulator software.
This allows you to download traces
in colour, change colours and add
captions and save then print or save
as PDF files.
It’s a much better option than printing from the serial port which is only
in monochrome.
If you need to do this, go to the
website www.ke5fx.com/gpib/7470.
htm and you will find that you can do
86 Silicon Chip
this for a whole raft of HP, Tektronix &
Rohde & Schwarz spectrum analysers
The front of the instrument has
21 “hard keys” which are fairly self
explanatory and eight “soft keys” labelled preset, help, basic, HPIB/local,
utility, plot/print and save/recall.
Our instrument has two BNC inputs
and one output for source signals (duplicated at the back).
The system uses a 3.5 inch floppy
which stores instrument states, programs, time captured data, waterfall
data, trace data, limits, math functions,
data tables, and curve fit/synthesis
tables.
Supported disk formats are HP-LIF
and MS-DOS. Internal RAM on our
device was 8Mb, which appears to be
more than enough for most purposes.
One of the nice features is the superquiet fan which you can only hear in
extremely quiet environments. There
is provision to turn it off for short pe-
riods while the instrument is running,
so as not to interfere with sensitive
loudspeaker tests. But at a quoted output of <45dB it is almost impossible to
hear the difference! It is without doubt
a very quiet instrument.
Now we come to one of the most
unpopular features of this device – the
external monitor output socket. This is
a DE9 9-pin socket which does not fit
any modern external monitor.
Not only that but even if you use a
converter to a 15-pin socket, the monitor will not work, because it requires
multi-sync monitor which may now
be difficult to obtain.
Agilent has devoted a fair amount
of time on this issue and details for
selecting and fitting suitable monitors
can be found at:
www.home.agilent.com/agilent/
editorial.jspx?cc=AU&lc=eng&ckey
=490434&nid=-11143.0.00&id
=490434&pselect=SR.GENERAL
Measurements
There are five basic measurement
types that can be performed:
1: Measuring Rotating Machinery
This involves connecting & calibrating transducers and measuring
vibration power, characterising
tachometer signals and measuring
an order spectrum.
An RPM stepped order map can
be set up to observe, for example,
what happens as a motor increases
its speed.
Using proximity sensors and
orbital diagrams, it is also possible
to identify problems such as bent
shafts or eccentric rotation.
Key Specifications
(1 channel) 195.3mHz to 102.4kHz
(2 channel) 97.7mHz to 51.2kHz
(4 channel) 48.8mHz to 25.6kHz
Lines of resolution: 100, 200, 400, 800 and 1600 lines of resolution
Dynamic range:
90dB (130dB in swept-sine mode)
Accuracy:
±0.15dB
Maximum input:
42V peak
Source:
Random, Burst Random, Periodic Chirp, Burst Chirp,
Pink Noise, Sine, Arbitrary Waveform
Maximum output:
±5V peak (AC)
Measurements:
Linear, Cross, and Power Spectrum, Power Spectral Density,
Frequency Response, Coherence, THD to 0.0015%,
Phase Distortion, Harmonic Power, Time Waveform,
Auto-correlation, Cross-Correlation, Histogram, Polar Display,
Octave analysis with triggered waterfall display
Tachometer input and order tracking with orbit diagram
Engineering units: g, m/s2, m/s, m, in/s2, in/s, in, mil, kg, dyne, lb, N, and pascals
Frequency range:
siliconchip.com.au
One of the major
advantages of the
35670A is that
it can operate
from AC and
DC, making it
highly versatile
and one of the
few instruments
that can swap
from the
laboratory to the
field (including
mobile use) with
ease. Here it is
being used in a
motor vehicle
where a range of
parameters can
be recorded for
later analysis.
2: Measuring Structures
All structures have natural frequencies of resonance – as some
very large bridge builders have
found to their horror.
The frequency response function
measures the input excitation and
output response simultaneously.
To find natural frequencies, an
impulse response measurement can
be performed on the structure and
the Agilent 35670A can be used to
compute the frequency response.
An instrumented hammer impacts
the structure and an accelerometer
measures the response.
The impact hammer has a load
cell that measures the level of force
during the impact.
Basically, bigger hammers are
required for bigger structures and
various methods can be used to
finely tune the instrument to obtain
reliable results.
Because it is such a transient test, it
is best to first look at a time trace of
the excitation (like an oscilloscope
record) and setting the instrument
amplitude ranges to avoid clipping
during the frequency response
evaluation.
This method would be useful in
evaluating speaker enclosures and
room vibrations too.
3: Measuring Sound
Using the microphone adapter
which screws on to the bottom of
the 35670A, with a 4-channel instrument it is possible to attach and
calibrate up to four microphones
and also provide them with phansiliconchip.com.au
tom power up to 200V DC.
will allow measurements of
sound pressure levels (SPLs) and
impulses and real time 1/3 or 1/12
octave measurements. You can also
view frequency response and impulses over time with the waterfall
function and obtain a time record.
This
4: Measuring Spectra and Networks
This involves measuring wideband and narrowband spectra,
frequency and amplitude, noise
power, harmonic distortion and
sideband power.
Frequency response can be measured using FFT (includes phase
measurement) or swept sine. The
latter is more accurate for frequencies lower than 100Hz.
Spectral maps can also be generated, phase distortion calculated
and displayed as microsecond delay
vs frequency.
5: Measuring Control Systems
Performance, step response, stability, loop response, gain and phase
margins can all be measured with
this instrument.
Also of interest is the ability to
generate Nyquist diagrams for evaluating various control systems such
as servo systems.
The control loop may be composed of mechanical devices and/
or analog, digital or electrical elements.
Drawbacks
There is no doubt the 35670A has already become an industry standard for
those applications mentioned above.
In fact, many industry and even
government department and organisation tenders and contracts specifically
call for the 35670A as part of their
validation, quality control and testing
procedures. As such, it has become de
rigeur in many standards – to replace it
would call for massive re-writes (and
therefore costs).
However, the popularity of the
device should be reason enough for a
long-overdue upgrade, such as faster
processing times, better and more
user-friendly programming, USB
connectivity, external monitoring,
pre-programmed setups and better
displays.
This should be relatively easy for
Agilent to undertake.
Perhaps because the instrument has
such a monopoly on low and ultra low
frequency analysis that it has little to
compete against and has generated a
culture of “its good enough!”
Conclusion
With the rare ability to accurately
evaluate low frequencies, the instrument is at the opposite end of the
ever-growing high frequency range of
spectrum analysers where there are
many manufacturers fighting to demonstrate they have the best devices for
upwards of 100GHz.
But, in a way this has kept the
Agilent 35670A in the doldrums of
development.
The fact that it has survived for so
long demonstrates that it is an excellent and well-respected instrument.
Current users are largely happy to
put up with the drawbacks because
they feel familiar with its controls
and all their standards are based on it.
It will probably continue to be manufactured for some years to come but
it would be nice to see some of those
long-overdue improvements.
SC
Where from?
The Agilent 35670A Dynamic Signal
Analyser and its extensive range of
options/accessories is available from
Agilent Technologies Australia Pty Ltd,
679 Springvale Road, Mulgrave Vic
3170; Tel (03) 9560-7133, Fax: (03)
9560-7950.
The company’s international website is www.agilent.com, from where
you can specify your country.
June 2012 87
WANT TO SAVE 10%? S
C (PRINT EDITION)
AUTOMATICALLY QUALIFY FOR
REFERENCE $ave SUBSCRIBERS*
CHIP BOOKSHOP 10% A 10% DISCOUNT ON ALL BOOK PURCHASES!
SILICON
ILICON HIP
(*Does not apply to website orders)
SELF ON AUDIO
by Douglas Self 2nd Edition 2006 $69.00
PROGRAMMING and CUSTOMIZING THE
PICAXE By David Lincoln (2nd Ed, 2011) $65.00
See
Review
A great aid when wrestling with applications for the PICAXE
series of microcontrollers, at beginner, intermediate and advanced April
2011
levels. Every electronics class, school and library should have a copy,
A collection of 35 classic magazine articles offering a dependable methodology for designing audio power amplifiers to improve performance at every
point without significantly increasing cost. Includes compressors/limiters,
hybrid bipolar/FET amps, electronic switching and more. 474 pages in paperback.
along with anyone who works with PICAXEs. 300 pages in paperback
SMALL SIGNAL AUDIO DESIGN
By Douglas Self – First Edition 2010 $88.00
PIC IN PRACTICE
The latest from the Guru of audio. Explains audio concepts in easy-to-understand language with plenty of examples and reasoning. Inspiration for audio
designers, superb background for audio enthusiasts and especially where it comes to
component peculiarities and limitations. Expensive? Yes. Value for money? YES! Highly
recommended. 558 pages in paperback.
by D W Smith. 2nd Edition - published 2006 $60.00
Based on popular short courses on the PIC, for professionals, students and
teachers. Can be used at a variety of levels. An ideal introduction to the world
of microcontrollers. 255 pages in paperback.
AUDIO POWER AMPLIFIER DESIGN HANDBOOK
PIC MICROCONTROLLER – your personal introduc-
by Douglas Self – 5th Edition 2009 $81.00
tory course By John Morton 3rd edition 2005. $60.00
"The Bible" on audio power amplifiers. Many revisions and
updates to the previous edition and now has an extra three
chapters covering Class XD, Power Amp Input Systems and
Input Processing and Auxiliarly Subsystems. Not cheap and not a book
for the beginner but if you want the best reference on Audio Power Amps,
you want this one! 463 pages in paperback.
A unique and practical guide to getting up and running with the PIC. It assumes no knowledge of microcontrollers – ideal introduction for students,
teachers, technicians and electronics enthusiasts. Revised 3rd edition
focuses entirely on re-programmable flash PICs such as 16F54, 16F84 12F508 and
12F675. 226 pages in paperback.
PRACTICAL GUIDE TO SATELLITE TV
OP AMPS FOR EVERYONE
By Garry Cratt – Latest (7th) Edition 2008 $49.00
By Carter & Mancini – 3RD EDITION $100.00
Written in Australia, for Australian conditions by one of Australia's foremost
satellite TV experts. If there is anything you wanted to know about setting
up a satellite TV system, (including what you can't do!) it's sure to be covered in this
176-page paperback book.
Substantially updates coverage for low-speed and high-speed applications,
and provides step-by-step walk-throughs for design and selection of op
amps. Huge 648 pages!
PROGRAMMING 32-bit MICROCONTROLLERS
IN C By Luci di Jasio (2008) $79.00
NEWNES GUIDE TO TV & VIDEO TECHNOLOGY
By KF Ibrahim 4th Edition (Published 2007) $49.00
Subtitled Exploring the PIC32, a Microchip insider tells all on this powerful
PIC! Focuses on examples and exercises that show how to solve common,
real-world design problems quickly. Includes handy checklists. FREE CD-ROM includes
source code in C, the Microchip C30 compiler, and MPLAB SIM. 400 pages paperback.
It's back! Provides a full and comprehensive coverage of video and television technology including HDTV and DVD. Starts with fundamentals so is
ideal for students but covers in-depth technologies such as Blu-ray, DLP,
Digital TV, etc so is also perfect for engineers. 600+ pages in paperback.
USING UBUNTU LINUX
RF CIRCUIT DESIGN
by J Rolfe & A Edney – published 2007 $27.00
by Chris Bowick, Second Edition, 2008. $63.00
Ubuntu Linux is a free and easy-to-use operating system, a viable alternative to Windows and Mac OS. Introduces Ubuntu, tells how to set it up,
covers the various Open Office applications and gives troubleshooting
hints and tips. Highly recommended. 222 pages in paperback
DVD PLAYERS AND DRIVES
by K.F. Ibrahim. Published 2003. $71.00
A guide to DVD technology and applications, with particular focus on design issues and pitfalls, maintenance and repair. Ideal
for engineers, technicians, students of consumer electronics
and sales and installation staff. 319 pages in paperback.
The classic RF circuit design book. RF circuit design is now more important
that ever in the wireless world. In most of the wireless devices that we use
there is an RF component – this book tells how to design and integrate in a very practical fashion. 244 pages in paperback.
PRACTICAL RF HANDBOOK
See
Review
Feb
2004
by Ian Hickman. 4th edition 2006 $61.00
A guide to RF design for engineers, technicians, students and enthusiasts.
Covers key topics in RF: analog design principles, transmission lines,
couplers, transformers, amplifiers, oscillators, modulation, transmitters
and receivers, propagation and antennas. 279 pages in paperback.
ELECTRIC MOTORS AND DRIVES
PRACTICAL VARIABLE SPEED DRIVES &
POWER ELECTRONICS
Se
By Austin Hughes - Third edition 2006 $51.00
Intended for non-specialist users of electric motors and drives,
filling the gap between academic texts and general "handbooks".
Explores all of the widely-used modern types of motor and drive
including conventional & brushless DC, induction motors, steppers, servos, synchronous and reluctance. 384 pages, soft cover.
e
Review
Feb
An essential reference for engineers and anyone who wishes
2003
to design or use variable speed drives for induction motors.
by Malcolm Barnes. 1st Ed, Feb 2003. $73.00
286 pages in soft cover.
BUILD YOUR OWN ELECTRIC MOTORCYCLE
AC MACHINES
by Carl Vogel. Published 2009. $40.00
By Jim Lowe Published 2006 $66.00
Applicable to Australian trades-level courses including NE10 AC Machines,
NE12 Synchronous Machines and the AC part of NE30 Electric Motor Control
and Protection. Covering polyphase induction motors, single-phase motors,
synchronous machines and polyphase motor starting. 160 pages in paperback.
Alternative fuel expert Carl Vogel gives you a hands-on guide with
the latest technical information and easy-to-follow instructions
for building a two-wheeled electric vehicle – from a streamlined
scooter to a full-sized motorcycle. 384 pages in soft cover.
NOTE: ALL PRICES ARE PLUS P&P – AUSTRALIA ONLY: $10.00 per order;
OR
FAX (24/7)
OR
NZ – $12.00 PER BOOK;
PAYPAL (24/7)
REST OF WORLD $18.00 PER BOOK
PHONE – (9-5, Mon-Fri)
eMAIL (24/7)
OR
To
Call (02) 9939 3295 with
Your order and card details to
Use your PayPal account
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Place
88 S
ilicon
C
hip
with order & credit card details
(02) 9939 2648 with all details
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
with order & credit card details
Your
Or use the handy order form on P105 of this issue
Order:
06-12
See
Review
March
2010
OR
MAIL
Your order to PO Box 139
siliconchip.com.au
Collaroy NSW 2097
*ALL TITLES SUBJECT TO AVAILABILITY. PRICES VALID FOR MONTH OF MAGAZINE ISSUE ONLY. ALL PRICES INCLUDE GST
The bad news: It's Tax Time!
The good news: Subscribe to
SILICON CHIP before June 30
and you can claim your tax
deduction THIS YEAR!
If your business is electronics – whatever the level, from apprentice to PhD – the chances are
your subscription to SILICON CHIP is 100% tax deductible (check with your accountant).
So why not let the tax man pick up part of your subscription – it's better than getting something for nothing. It's getting something BACK from the tax man!
But you have to hurry: you MUST lodge your subscription order by JUNE 30 in order to
claim your deduction THIS FINANCIAL YEAR. Don't wait: do it today!
PLUS! There are some BIG ADVANTAGES in subscribing . . .
u
v
w
x
y
z
{
It's cheaper – you $ave money!
PRICE OF 12 ISSUES
It's delivered right to your mail box!!
OVER-THE-COUNTER
IN AUSTRALIA:
You can always be sure you'll receive it!!!
We pick up all the postage and handling charges!!!!
You will never miss an issue because it's sold out (or you forgot)!!!!!
You choose the length of subscription required: 6, 12 or 24 months.
11160
$
You can even choose to auto-renew your subscription at the end of the period!
Here's the deal:
SILICON CHIP : 52 in Australia; 55 in NZ*; 80 o'seas*
12 Months SILICON CHIP : 97 in Australia; 99 in NZ*; 140 o'seas*
24 Months SILICON CHIP : 188 in Australia; 196 in NZ*; 265 o'seas* VIA AIR MAIL
6 months
$
00
$
$
$AU
50
00
00
$AU
$AU
$AU
00
00
$AU
00
$AU
00
00
There's a handy order form on P97
siliconchip.com.au
June 2012 89
Vintage Radio
By Rodney Champness, VK3UG
John de Haas and his
Philips collection
This month, we take a look at a vintage radio collection belonging to
enthusiast John de Haas. Philips receivers made in both Europe and
Australia feature prominently in his collection and although some
models look identical, the chassis used can be quite different.
I
T’S ALWAYS INTERESTING to find
out how fellow vintage radio collectors became involved in the hobby and
started their collections. In some cases,
it’s because they worked in radio or
electronics as technicians and adopted
the hobby as a natural extension of
their professional expertise. On the
other hand, many collectors had no
interest in vintage radio until some
incident sparked their curiosity.
90 Silicon Chip
In my case, it began when I was
invited to a meeting of vintage radio
enthusiasts, which I reluctantly agreed
to attend. My interest at that stage was
only lukewarm and I was really only
interested in portable WWII military
equipment. In short, I only wanted to
deal with “real” radios such as complex military radio transceivers but
after a few meetings, I very quickly
became interested in collecting and
restoring domestic radios.
One fellow enthusiast, John de
Haas, has some rather special Philips
receivers among his collection, many
of them originating from Europe. His
background is equally as interesting.
John’s introduction to vintage radio
occurred back in 2003 when he was involved in winding up his late mother’s
estate in Holland. Amongst the items
left to him was a rather nice-looking
siliconchip.com.au
This view shows the three-part aluminium and Bakelite chassis of a Sierra 159X receiver which is currently undergoing
restoration on John’s workbench.
Philips BX480A table receiver which
was manufactured in 1939 (it’s shown
in one of the photos). The receiver
had a lot of appeal and a great deal of
sentimental value, so he decided to
bring it back to Australia.
John carefully packed the set so that
it would not be damaged on the long
journey but when it arrived, the cabinet had shattered into many pieces,
the chassis was bent and several valves
had broken. It was a huge disappointment and an indictment of the care
taken by freight agents.
After getting over his initial shock,
John resolved that he would completely rebuild the receiver. And so the
box of pieces was left on a shelf in the
garage for a year until he eventually
mustered the enthusiasm to start the
mammoth job.
The challenge now was to turn the
broken parts back into a recognisable
receiver. John started with the cabinet
and over the next four months, carefully glued the various pieces back together using two-part Araldite. These
pieces were held together while the
glue dried using Glad-Wrap covered
boards and C-clamps, to ensure flat
surfaces.
siliconchip.com.au
Despite being badly damaged in transit, this 1939 Philips BX480A has now
been restored to full working order. The restoration included extensive cabinet
repairs and the manufacture of a new glass dial-scale.
Eventually, the Bakelite cabinet was
back in one piece but the glued joints
looked terrible so it needed painting.
And so, after a thorough sanding, the
cabinet was spray painted good old
Mission Brown. As John points out,
it now looks OK but it’s no longer
original which is a pity.
The dial scale was broken into many
pieces too and it took John many hours
of patient work to make a new one. In
fact, repairing and making dial-scales
is a task that John has well and truly
mastered. He has since reproduced
June 2012 91
dial scales for several of his other sets
and they are virtually indistinguishable from the original items.
In fact, his technique for reproducing dial-scales may form part of an
article later on. His method is quite
practical but like many such undertakings, it does take time to do.
Restoring the circuit
The Philips Sierra model H283 (left) and its Australian Philips equivalent.
The cabinets are identical, although different dial scales are used to suit the
intended market.
Another set of Philips twins, this time showing the Dutch model 209U and the
visually identical Australian model 112 at right. Note the “pop-up” dial scales.
Also in John’s collection is this magnificent Graetz Sinfonia Model 422 5-band
table receiver. The 30cm ruler at the left gives an indication of the set’s size.
92 Silicon Chip
Apart from the broken valves, the
electronic components were largely
unaffected by the rough treatment
during the set’s trip to Australia. However, quite a lot of work was required
to restore the chassis. For example,
in order to straighten the chassis, all
items attached to it had to be first removed before it could be hammered
back into shape. The various parts
were then refitted.
This was quite a job and the set now
looks quite good from the outside.
However, it still bears the scars of its
mistreatment inside the cabinet and
under the chassis.
John’s restoration of his mother’s set
back in 2003 kick-started his interest
in vintage radio. And because John
has connections with both Europe and
Australia, it was logical that he would
collect radios from both regions.
Because of his Dutch background,
John has a liking for Philips receivers
and these feature prominently in his
collection. One particular feature of
his collection are several Dutch and
Australian Philips designs which
have identical cabinets but different
chassis.
John’s background
John’s parents were with the Colonial Service of the Dutch Government.
He was born in Indonesia in 1935 and
subsequently migrated to Australia
from Holland in 1957 at the age of
22. Both he and his wife Harriet now
regularly travel back to Holland to visit
friends and relatives.
While there, he often visits the
various vintage radio groups (John
is a member of the NVHR, the Dutch
equivalent of our HRSA). During these
visits, he sometimes finds a vintage
European set that catches his eye and
brings it back to Australia.
John tells me that in a previous
life, before retirement, he worked as
a mechanical engineer in mining and
construction. He retired from BHP in
1992 and then worked as a freelance
Maintenance Management Consultant
siliconchip.com.au
This photo shows the Dutch Philips BX462A at left and the Australian Philips 115 at right. Although visually identical
apart from the pop-up dial scales, their chassis are quite different as the photo below shows.
in Australia, India and Indonesia up
until 2000.
His interest in valve radios actually dates back to his younger days in
Holland. He built radios and amplifiers as a hobby during the immediate
post-war years but subsequently lost
interest in the 1960s with the advent
of the transistor and integrated circuit technology. As stated, it was the
restoration of his mother’s old radio
that rekindled his interest in valve
technology.
As well as being a member of the
HRSA and the NVHR, John is also a
member of the South East Queensland
Vintage Radio Club and the Vintage
Radio Club of North East Victoria. In
fact, he joined these organisations not
long after the successful restoration of
his mother’s set. Club membership is
important to vintage radio collectors,
particularly when it comes technical
advice and backup and help with obtaining hard-to-get parts.
John’s collection
During the last nine years, John
has restored many quite elaborate
European radios, particularly Philips
sets. He has also restored a number of
Australian sets, along with one Canadian receiver and a mantel receiver
from New Zealand. At last count,
there were over 50 restored radios in
his collection, so he has added about
of six receivers to his collection each
siliconchip.com.au
The Australian Philips 115 and the Dutch Philips BX462A from the rear, with
their backs removed. The differences between the two chassis are quite marked.
year. Most of these sets are in full
working order.
In all, there are about 30 European
sets in the collection. These range from
quite simple four and 5-valve AC/DC
mantel receivers to quite elaborate
receivers boasting long wave, medium
wave and one or more shortwave
bands plus the 88-108MHz FM band.
Some of these receivers feature upwards of 12 valves.
The Australian sets are standard
mantel and table-model receivers,
many of which have been described in
Vintage Radio over the years. The lone
New Zealand set is a Philco, while the
Canadian set is a Motorola.
The top-of-the-line receivers all
have attractive, large wooden cabinets,
while those a little further down the
pecking order have large, good-quality
Bakelite cabinets. The simpler, cheaper models either have small Bakelite
or plastic cabinets.
John’s collection is neatly arranged
along a number of shelves in his garage, with one of his vehicles relegated
to a spot outside. The sets are all permanently connected to power and are
each fitted with a short antenna so that
they can be operated on a regular basis.
One interesting aspect of the collection is a group of eight Philips receivers arranged in four pairs of apparently
June 2012 93
each of these pairs at a later date.
John’s large table radios, such as
the Graetz Sinfonia 422 5-band receiver and the Philips BX653A 5-band
12-valve receiver, are big, powerful
units with impressive performance.
But although these are magnificent
receivers, they are far from easy to
service and a service manual and
plenty of time are needed to ensure a
successful restoration.
The mantel receivers in the display were made by most of the major
manufacturers in Australia, with a
sprinkling of overseas brands. These
are receivers that Australian collectors
are more familiar with, particularly
when it comes to fault-finding and
restoration.
John’s workshop
More Philips “twins” – the Australian model 138 is shown at top, while below it
is the almost visually-identical Dutch BX221U.
identical units. However, on close
inspection, the pairs of receivers are
not identical at all. In each case, one
receiver is of Dutch manufacture and
the other is Australian made.
Apparently, copies of the respective
cabinet moulds were sent to Australia
from the Philips parent company
in Eindhoven, Holland. The resulting locally-produced cabinets were
then each used to house different
Australian-designed chassis. It will
be interesting to compare the circuits,
performance, layout and facilities of
John’s NZ-made La Gloria
Philco mantel receiver.
94 Silicon Chip
John has a spacious workbench for
doing electronic and basic mechanical
work on his radios. Alignment and
sensitivity adjustments are carried
out with the aid of a Philips GM2883
signal generator. This is a step up from
a basic signal generator such as the
Leader LSG10 and LSG11. A Philips
GM6001 valve voltmeter is used for
voltage and current measurements,
along with a digital multimeter.
Also included in the test-gear lineup are two variable power supplies
which can substitute for the internal
power supplies of most receivers. In
addition, a Variac is used to test the
performance of receivers across the
normal mains voltage range. This is a
very handy test which will often bring
to light voltage-sensitive faults.
Other equipment includes an adjustable lampholder plus a supply
of jumper leads which are stored at
the back of the workbench. These
leads make it easy to attach meters
to a circuit so that various operating
conditions can be observed, eg, while
alignment adjustments are made.
Another workbench is used for some
of the larger mechanical work. During
my visit, a speaker cloth was being
glued to a frame and this was held in
place with several clamps. And talking about speaker cloth, John’s wife
Harriet hand-wove open-mesh speaker
cloth for several of the receivers in his
collection.
A number of small trays and drawers containing various components are
mounted behind the main workbench,
while larger parts are stored against
one of the garage walls. John also has
siliconchip.com.au
The 3-band Philips BX373A receiver
features a dial that’s styled to look
like a compass.
a good supply of valves, which are
used as necessary. However, according
to John, many of the old radios he has
restored didn’t require replacement
valves and only rarely was more than
one required.
Some useful tips
Based on their experience, most
vintage radio collectors come up with
ideas to help make restoration jobs
easier and John is certainly no different in this regard.
One of his useful tips is to use aluminium foil patty pans (available from
supermarkets) to keep components together when a set is dismantled. These
are ideal for storing the many nuts,
bolts, screws, knobs and other parts
that may be removed from a receiver
during restoration.
Good organisation is important
when is comes to restoring a vintage
radio. There is nothing worse than not
keeping the bits and pieces together
and then finding that some vital item is
missing somewhere in the workshop.
Restringing dial-drive systems is
something that many vintage radio
restorers would rather not have to
do. The larger European sets in particular often have extremely complex
dial-drives and other remote control
mechanisms. As a result, it’s important
to try to obtain a diagram of the layout,
as some are quite difficult to figure out
from scratch.
John therefore tries to obtain a
manual for any set that’s being worked
on and he photographs the dial-drive
system before he working on it. This
approach is particularly important
with the more complex receivers such
as the Graetz Sinfonia 422, the Philips
BX653A and sets like the AWA 7-band
siliconchip.com.au
John de Hass with his vintage radio receiver collection. He’s been collecting and
restoring vintage receivers for around nine years.
The Philips BX653A 5-band twin-amplifier table receiver is a large, powerful
unit with no less than 12 valves. A service manual and plenty of time were
necessary to complete the restoration of this magnificent receiver.
series of radios. Conversely, sets using
handspan dials are so simple that no
diagram is necessary.
Summary
As can be seen, John has quite a
wide variety of receivers from both
Europe and elsewhere and he has done
an excellent job restoring them to full
working order. This is particularly evident with the larger European models.
The workshop is very functional and
most problems can be diagnosed and
fixed using his existing equipment and
spare parts.
As to which sets John prefers, the
Dutch Philips receivers are favourites,
particularly when it comes to appearance. However, he also says that the
European sets are more difficult to
service, with bits and pieces scattered
everywhere inside them. So for ease
of service, he definitely prefers the
SC
Australian sets.
June 2012 95
SILICON
CHIP
PARTSHOP
Looking for a specialised component to build that latest and greatest SILICON CHIP project? Maybe it’s the PCB you’re after.
Or a pre-programmed micro. Or some other hard-to-get “bit”. The chances are they are available direct from the SILICON CHIP PARTSHOP.
As a service to readers, SILICON CHIP has established the PARTSHOP. No, we’re not going into opposition with your normal suppliers
– this is a direct response to requests from readers who have found difficulty in obtaining specialised parts.
•
•
•
•
PCBs nominated are normally IN STOCK and ready for despatch (you don’t have to wait for them to be made!).
Even if stock runs out (eg, for high demand), in most cases there will be no longer than a two-week wait.
One low p&p charge: $10 per order, regardless of how many boards you order! (Australia only; overseas clients – email us for a postage quote).
New project boards will normally be available within days of the magazine on-sale date: no waiting!
• Our PCBs are beautifully made, very high quality fibreglass boards with pre-tinned tracks, silk screen overlays and where applicable, solder masks.
• Best of all, those boards with fancy cut-outs or edges are already cut out to the SILICON CHIP specifications – no messy blade work required!
PROJECT
PUBLISHED
AM RADIO TRANSMITTER
CHAMP: SINGLE CHIP AUDIO AMPLIFIER
PROJECT
PUBLISHED
CODE
Price*
CODE
Price*
JAN 1993
06112921
$25.00
100W DC-DC CONVERTER
MAY 2011
11105111
$25.00
FEB 1994
01102941
$5.00
PHONE LINE POLARITY CHECKER
MAY 2011
12105111
$10.00
PRECHAMP: 2-TRANSISTOR PREAMPLIER
JUL 1994
01107941
$5.00
20A 12/24V DC MOTOR SPEED CONTROLLER MK2
JUNE 2011
11106111
$25.00
HEAT CONTROLLER
JULY 1998
10307981
$25.00
USB STEREO RECORD/PLAYBACK
JUNE 2011
07106111
$25.00
MINIMITTER FM STEREO TRANSMITTER
APR 2001
06104011
$25.00
VERSATIMER/SWITCH
JUNE 2011
19106111
$25.00
MICROMITTER FM STEREO TRANSMITTER
DEC 2002
06112021
$10.00
USB BREAKOUT BOX
JUNE 2011
04106111
$10.00
SMART SLAVE FLASH TRIGGER
JUL 2003
13107031
$10.00
ULTRA-LD MK3 200W AMP MODULE
JULY 2011
01107111
$25.00
12AX7 VALVE AUDIO PREAMPLIFIER
NOV 2003
01111031
$25.00
PORTABLE LIGHTNING DETECTOR
JULY 2011
04107111
$25.00
POOR MAN’S METAL LOCATOR
MAY 2004
04105041
$10.00
RUDDER INDICATOR FOR POWER BOATS (4 PCBs)
JULY 2011
20107111-4 $80 per set
BALANCED MICROPHONE PREAMP
AUG 2004
01108041
$25.00
VOX
JULY 2011
01207111
$25.00
LITTLE JIM AM TRANSMITTER
JAN 2006
06101062
$25.00
ELECTRONIC STETHOSCOPE
AUG 2011
01108111
$25.00
POCKET TENS UNIT
JAN 2006
11101061
$25.00
DIGITAL SPIRIT LEVEL/INCLINOMETER
AUG 2011
04108111
$15.00
STUDIO SERIES RC MODULE
APRIL 2006 01104061
$25.00
ULTRASONIC WATER TANK METER
SEP 2011
04109111
$25.00
ULTRASONIC EAVESDROPPER
AUG 2006
01208061
$25.00
ULTRA-LD MK2 AMPLIFIER UPGRADE
SEP 2011
01209111
$5.00
RIAA PREAMPLIFIER
AUG 2006
01108061
$25.00
ULTRA-LD MK3 AMPLIFIER POWER SUPPLY
SEP 2011
01109111
$25.00
GPS FREQUENCY REFERENCE (A) (IMPROVED)
MAR 2007
04103073
$55.00
HIFI STEREO HEADPHONE AMPLIFIER
SEP 2011
01309111
$45.00
GPS FREQUENCY REFERENCE DISPLAY (B)
MAR 2007
04103072
$30.00
GPS FREQUENCY REFERENCE (IMPROVED)
SEP 2011
04103073
$55.00
KNOCK DETECTOR
JUNE 2007
05106071
$25.00
DIGITAL LIGHTING CONTROLLER LED SLAVE
OCT 2011
16110111
$30.00
SPEAKER PROTECTION AND MUTING MODULE
JULY 2007
01207071
$25.00
USB MIDIMATE
OCT 2011
23110111
$30.00
CDI MODULE SMALL PETROL MOTORS
MAY 2008
05105081
$15.00
QUIZZICAL QUIZ GAME
OCT 2011
08110111
$30.00
LED/LAMP FLASHER
SEP 2008
11009081
$10.00
ULTRA-LD MK3 PREAMP & REMOTE VOL CONTROL
NOV 2011
01111111
$35.00
12V SPEED CONTROLLER/DIMMER (Use Hot Wire Cutter PCB from Dec2010 18112101)
$25.00
ULTRA-LD MK3 INPUT SWITCHING MODUL
NOV 2011
01111112
$25.00
CAR SCROLLING DISPLAY
DEC 2008
05101092
$25.00
ULTRA-LD MK3 SWITCH MODULE
NOV 2011
01111113
$10.00
USB-SENSING MAINS POWER SWITCH
JAN 2009
10101091
$45.00
ZENER DIODE TESTER
NOV 2011
04111111
$20.00
DIGITAL AUDIO MILLIVOLTMETER
MAR 2009
04103091
$35.00
MINIMAXIMITE
NOV 2011
07111111
$10.00
INTELLIGENT REMOTE-CONTROLLED DIMMER
APR 2009
10104091
$10.00
ADJUSTABLE REGULATED POWER SUPPLY
DEC 2011
18112111
$5.00
INPUT ATTENUATOR FOR DIG. AUDIO M’VOLTMETER
MAY 2009
04205091
$10.00
DIGITAL AUDIO DELAY
DEC 2011
01212111
$30.00
6-DIGIT GPS CLOCK
MAY 2009
04105091
$35.00
DIGITAL AUDIO DELAY FRONT & REAR PANELS
DEC 2011
0121211P2/3 $20 per set
6-DIGIT GPS CLOCK DRIVER
JUNE 2009
07106091
$25.00
AM RADIO
JAN 2012
06101121
$10.00
UHF ROLLING CODE TX
AUG 2009
15008091
$10.00
STEREO AUDIO COMPRESSOR
JAN 2012
01201121
$30.00
UHF ROLLING CODE RECEIVER
AUG 2009
15008092
$45.00
STEREO AUDIO COMPRESSOR FRONT & REAR PANELS
JAN 2012
0120112P1/2 $20.00
6-DIGIT GPS CLOCK AUTODIM ADD-ON
SEPT 2009
04208091
$10.00
3-INPUT AUDIO SELECTOR (SET OF 2 BOARDS)
JAN 2012
01101121/2 $30 per set
STEREO DAC BALANCED OUTPUT BOARD
JAN 2010
01101101
$25.00
CRYSTAL DAC
FEB 2012
01102121
DIGITAL INSULATION METER
JUN 2010
04106101
$25.00
SWITCHING REGULATOR
FEB 2012
18102121
$5.00
ELECTROLYTIC CAPACITOR REFORMER
AUG 2010
04108101
$55.00
SEMTEST LOWER BOARD
MAR 2012
04103121
$40.00
ULTRASONIC ANTI-FOULING FOR BOATS
SEP 2010
04109101
$25.00
SEMTEST UPPER BOARD
MAR 2012
04103122
$40.00
HEARING LOOP RECEIVER
SEP 2010
01209101
$25.00
SEMTEST FRONT PANEL
MAR 2012
04103123
$75.00
S/PDIF/COAX TO TOSLINK CONVERTER
OCT 2010
01210101
$10.00
INTERPLANETARY VOICE
MAR 2012
08102121
$10.00
TOSLINK TO S/PDIF/COAX CONVERTER
OCT 2010
01210102
$10.00
12/24V 3-STAGE MPPT SOLAR CHARGER REV.A
MAR 2012
14102112
$20.00
DIGITAL LIGHTING CONTROLLER SLAVE UNIT
OCT 2010
16110102
$45.00
SOFT START SUPPRESSOR
APR 2012
10104121
$10.00
HEARING LOOP TESTER/LEVEL METER
NOV 2010
01111101
$25.00
RESISTANCE DECADE BOX
APR 2012
04105121
$20.00
UNIVERSAL USB DATA LOGGER
DEC 2010
04112101
$25.00
RESISTANCE DECADE BOX PANEL/LID
APR 2012
04105122
$20.00
HOT WIRE CUTTER CONTROLLER
DEC 2010
18112101
$25.00
1.5kW INDUCTION MOTOR SPEED CONTROLLER
APR 2012
10105121
$35.00
433MHZ SNIFFER
JAN 2011
06101111
$10.00
HIGH TEMPERATURE THERMOMETER MAIN PCB
MAY 2012
21105121
$30.00
CRANIAL ELECTRICAL STIMULATION
JAN 2011
99101111
$30.00
HIGH TEMPERATURE THERMOMETER F&R PANELS
MAY 2012
21105122/3 $20 per set
HEARING LOOP SIGNAL CONDITIONER
JAN 2011
01101111
$30.00
MIX-IT! 4 CHANNEL MIXER
JUNE 2012
01106121
$20.00
LED DAZZLER
FEB 2011
16102111
$25.00
PIC/AVR PROGRAMMING ADAPTOR BOARD
JUNE 2012
24105121
$30.00
12/24V 3-STAGE MPPT SOLAR CHARGER
FEB 2011
14102111
$15.00
CRAZY CRICKET/FREAKY FROG
JUNE 2012
08109121
$10.00
SIMPLE CHEAP 433MHZ LOCATOR
FEB 2011
06102111
$5.00
THE MAXIMITE
MAR 2011
06103111
$25.00
UNIVERSAL VOLTAGE REGULATOR
MAR 2011
18103111
$15.00
12V 20-120W SOLAR PANEL SIMULATOR
MAR 2011
04103111
$25.00
MICROPHONE NECK LOOP COUPLER
MAR 2011
01209101
$25.00
PORTABLE STEREO HEADPHONE AMP
APRIL 2011 01104111
$25.00
CHEAP 100V SPEAKER/LINE CHECKER
APRIL 2011 04104111
$25.00
PROJECTOR SPEED CONTROLLER
APRIL 2011 13104111
$10.00
SPORTSYNC AUDIO DELAY
MAY 2011
$30.00
01105111
Other items currently in the PartShop:
$20.00
* All prices P&P – $10 Per order within Australia.
G-FORCE METER/ACCELEROMETER SHORT FORM KIT
AUG 2011/NOV 2011
$44.50
(contains PCB (04108111), programmed PIC micro, MMA8451Q accelerometer chip and 4 MOSFETS)
TENDA USB/SD AUDIO PLAYBACK MODULE (TD896 or 898)
JAN 2012
$33.00
JST CONNECTOR LEAD 3-WAY
JAN 2012
$4.50
JST CONNECTOR LEAD 2-WAY
siliconchip.com.au
JAN 2012
$3.45
RADIO & HOBBIES ON DVD-ROM (Needs PC to play!)
n/a
$62.00
AMATEUR SCIENTIST VOL4 ON CD
n/a
$62.00
AND NOW THE PRE-PROGRAMMED MICROS, TOO!
Micros from copyrighted and contributed
projects may not be available.
As a service to readers, SILICON CHIP is now stocking microcontrollers and microprocessors used in new projects (from 2012 on) and some
selected older projects – pre-programmed and ready to fly! Price for any of these micros is just $15.00 each + $10 p&p per order
PIC18F2550-I/SP
PIC18F4550-I/P
PIC16F877A-I/P
dsPIC33FJ128GP802-I/SP
Batt Capacity Meter (Jun09), Intelligent Fan Controller (Jul10)
GPS Car Computer (Jan10), GPS Boat Computer (Oct10)
6-Digit GPS Clock (May-Jun09), Lab Digital Pot (Jul10) Semtest (Feb-May12)
Digital Audio Signal Generator (Mar-May10), Digital Lighting Controller (Oct-
Dec10), SportSync (May11), Digital Audio Delay (Dec11)
PIC16F88-E/P
Projector Speed (Apr11), Vox (Jun11), Ultrasonic Water Tank
Level (Sep11), Quizzical (Oct11), Ultra-LD Preamp (Nov11)
PIC18F27J53-I/SP
USB Data Logger (Dec10-Feb11)
PIC32MX795F512H-80I/PT Maximite (Mar11), miniMaximite (Nov11)
PIC18LF14K22
PIC18F14K50
ATTiny861
PIC12F675
ATTiny2313
ATMega48
PIC18F1320-I/SO
dsPIC33FJ64MC802-E/SP
Digital Spirit Level (Aug11), G-Force Meter (Nov11)
USB MIDIMate (Oct11)
VVA Thermometer/Thermostat (Mar10), Rudder Position Indicator (Jul11)
UHF Remote Switch (Jan09), Ultrasonic Cleaner (Aug10),
Ultrasonic Anti-fouling (Sep10), Cricket/Frog (Jun12)
Remote-Controlled Timer (Aug10)
Stereo DAC (Sep-Nov09)
Intelligent Dimmer (Apr09)
Induction Motor Speed Controller (Apr-May12)
*Note: P&P is extra ($10 per order). Prices listed include GST and are valid only for month of publication of this list; thereafter are subject to change without notice. 06/12
When ordering, be sure to nominate BOTH the micro required and the project for which it must be programmed.
SILICON CHIP Order Form
Your Name:
Your Address:
State:
Postcode:
Country:
Telephone No:
Fax No:
Email Address:
Please supply:
Qty
Item
Price
Item Description
P&P
if extra
Total
Price
TOTAL $A
Thank you for your order.
Payment options:
EFT/Bank Deposit: Silicon Chip BSB 012-243 A/C 2636-80001 Please confirm transfer by email to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au or fax 02 9939 2648
PayPal: From your PayPal account: “Send Money” to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Cheque/Money Order/Bank Draft: payable to Silicon Chip (Australian dollars only) Mail to Silicon Chip PO Box 139 Collaroy NSW 2097 Australia
Credit Card (see below; Visa and Mastercard ONLY): Fax to 02 9939 2648, telephone 02 9939 3295 or mail or email to above address.
If paying by Visa or Mastercard please enter your details below (we DO NOT accept Amex, Diners or other credit cards)
Card
No:
Cardholder Name:
To
eMAIL (24/7)
Place
siliconchip.com.au
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Your
with order & credit card details
Order:
-
OR
-
FAX (24/7)
This form (or a photocopy) to
(02) 9939 2648 with all details
-
/
Expiry
Date:
Signature:
OR
PAYPAL (24/7)
OR
Use PayPal to pay
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
PHONE – (9-5, Mon-Fri)
Call (02) 9939 3295 with
your credit card details
MAIL
2012 97
OR June
This form
to PO Box 139,
*ALL ITEMS SUBJECT TO AVAILABILITY. PRICES VALID FOR MONTH OF MAGAZINE ISSUE ONLY. ALL PRICES IN AUSTRALIAN DOLLARS AND INCLUDE GST WHERE APPLICABLE.
Collaroy NSW 2097
06/12
ASK SILICON CHIP
Got a technical problem? Can’t understand a piece of jargon or some technical principle? Drop us a line
and we’ll answer your question. Write to: Ask Silicon Chip, PO Box 139, Collaroy Beach, NSW 2097 or
send an email to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Bed pan machine is a
pain in the . . .
I am an electrical engineer at Ipswich Hospital in the UK. I wonder if
you could give me some advice. We
have problems occasionally with the
timing chip (picture attached to email)
from a bed pan machine. Basically it
times pumps, solenoids and motors.
Unfortunately, the timing chip goes
wrong on a regular basis and we have
no option but to purchase a new board
which costs £300. Is there a way or
company to duplicate these chips in
the UK? (M. E., Ipswich, UK).
• It seems highly likely that the IC is
a micro and the label on it refers to the
version of software it is programmed
with. If you peel off the label, you may
be able to identify what type of micro
it is. However, the software is likely to
be in flash memory and so it is unlikely
that you could get the chip duplicated.
The question you should be asking of the suppliers is “why do these
modules keep failing?” Is there no
warranty? It may also be possible to
compare voltages etc with a known
good module. If the micro keeps failing, perhaps it is being hit by voltage
spikes on its supply or input leads.
If you can trace out the circuit, you
might be able to add diode clamping
to particular inputs and also ensure
that the power supply itself does not
cause the failures.
Alphanumeric clock
tells the time in English
I was in Singapore recently and saw
this cool-looking clock in action. My
first thought, “What a great idea for
a project!”. See it at http://store.biegertfunk.com/us/collection-qlocktwo.
html What do you think? (T. R., via
email).
• As you say, that clock idea looks
pretty neat. But SILICON CHIP actually
did the same thing 18 years ago, back
in November 1994, with a PIC16C57
driving LED dot-matrix displays. It
gave the same sort of readouts such
as 10 past 8, 6 o’clock, midnight and
noon.
Providing a source of
120VAC at 60Hz
My son and daughter-in-law have
recently inherited a 60-year-old model
steam train that originated from the
USA. To rejuvenate this model, they
purchased spare parts and two new
model train sets from the original
manufacturer in the USA. These
model train sets are powered via a
control transformer from 120VAC
60Hz/18VAC at about 80W for each
loco.
The control transformer produces
sequenced outputs that synchronise
bells, whistles, voice announcements,
engine reverse etc. Having access to
only 120VAC at 50Hz, these sequenced
outputs are out of sync. Could you suggest a source of 230/120VAC 60Hz at
about 200W that does not involve the
purchase of a petrol-powered generator from the USA? (M. O., Wyndham,
WA).
• We assume that the model locomotive was made by Lionel or one of the
big model O-scale train makers of the
time. Their system for generating bells
and whistles was quite intriguing but
as you say, it did depend on a 60Hz
mains supply.
Unfortunately, there is no easy solution to your problem. One possible
way would be to feed a 60Hz sinewave
into an audio amplifier to produce
an output of 18VAC. This could be
substituted for the transformer in your
120VAC train power supply to run the
bells, whistles etc.
For example, you could use an
SC480 100W amplifier module as de-
Modular Solar Power System Proposal
I’d like to see a design for a modular solar system to recharge a battery
during the day and provide 230VAC
power to a single 10A outlet continuously. The system would need
to be modular enough to allow for
different loads, eg, it might be used
for only a few hours in the evening
to run a 60W lamp or it might run a
450W computer power supply or a
full 10A load continuously.
I do understand that you can’t
make a one-size-fits-all system,
which is why I suggest a modular
design, so the builder can decide the
balance; large battery and high-amp
98 Silicon Chip
solar array or smaller battery and/or
lower amperage array? It depends on
how much sun you expect in your
area and how much risk you’re willing to take on running out of power.
It would be nice (but not essential)
if you could include an option for
the system to automatically switch
over to house power from a standard
outlet if the battery gets too low. (J.
W., Bairnsdale, Vic).
• What you are proposing is actually three separate systems, with
major differences between numbers
of panels, battery bank and inverter
rating. In fact, the system to run a
10A load continuously (2300W)
would be very large and expensive.
And why would you want to run
a 450W computer power supply? If
you have such a computer which
needs this huge amount of power, it
may be time to update. For example,
we recently installed a new server
with four 1TB drives. It draws an
average of 60W. It would not have
enough computing grunt to be a super games machine, though.
As an alternative, where you have
to run on solar power, a late-model
laptop PC can be a very efficient
choice.
siliconchip.com.au
scribed in the January and February
2003 issues. However, we would not
regard this an easy or simple solution.
Nor would the purchase of a petrolpowered generator from the USA be a
good solution. The frequency accuracy
and stability of such generators is quite
unpredictable and tends to vary markedly with the load. A better solution
might be to obtain a 12V DC to 120VAC
60Hz sinewave inverter. This could be
powered from a 12V car battery or a
standard PC power supply.
Query on fluorescent
lamp starters
Many years ago a magazine (probably Electronics Australia) featured an
article on constructing an electronic
starter switch for fluorescent lamps
– you know, the little white cased
thing that pre-heats the filament and
then helps generate the spike to start
the lamp.
Before I could make one, Jaycar (or
was it Dick) offered a made-up unit
for sale. I bought one and have been
delighted. Tube life is phenomenal
and light up is instant. I want more
but have lost the magazine and no-one
knows what I am talking about. Can
you help? (M. S., Narrogin, WA).
• We described an electronic starter
for fluorescent lamps in the August 1996 issue, featuring a Philips
UBA200T chip. The chip should still
be available but we do not have the
PCB. However, we would not recommend that you build the device.
Electronics starters can be purchased
from some hardware stores and lighting outlets.
Better still, have a look at the Circuit Notebook pages in the May 2012
issue. They describe how the electronic driver from a CFL can be used
as an electronic ballast for a standard
fluorescent lamp. It not only provides
flicker-free turn-on but its higher
frequency operation means that the
tube is brighter and overall efficiency
is improved.
Amplitude of S-video
luminance signal
An S-video socket has four pins; two
are for the luminance signal and two
for the chrominance signal.
Does the luminance signal also contain horizontal, vertical and probably
the colour-burst sync signals? If the
siliconchip.com.au
Questions On The Motor Speed Controller
With respect to the circuit of the
Induction Motor Speed Controller
published in the April & May 2012
issues, if the IGBT module logic is
powered up slightly after the 340V
DC bus appears, as may in fact occur,
then there would be no logic control
over the IGBTs, potentially risking
the module or at least the fuse and
circuit breaker. Is this a problem?
Also what about the possibility
of incorporating a braking resistor
and control system to stop DC bus
over-voltage when using the speed
control with a lathe motor? (R. H.,
via email).
• The IGBT module includes inbuilt under-voltage lock-out on all
of the IGBT drivers, so there is no
danger of the IGBTs switching unexpectedly, regardless of the state of
the logic signals. The IGBTs are held
off until the drive power supplies
luminance signal does include sync,
is it a standard video signal of 1.4V at
70 ohms? (P. C., Carnegie, Vic).
• The luminance signal does carry
the sync and colour burst signals. With
a peak-white signal, the amplitude is
1V peak-peak, the same as a standard
composite video signal.
Running the 10W LED
spotlight at 6V
I would really like to run the 10W
white LED spotlight (SILICON CHIP,
February 2012) on 6V rather than 12V.
Is this possible? (J. W., via email).
• Three white LEDs in series require
more than 10V and you cannot rewire
the LEDs on the chip so the answer is
no; you cannot run it from 6V.
Transistor substitute for
Programmable Ignition
I am interested in building the
Programmable Ignition System from
March-May 2007.
In the article, you outline a schematic for an ignition coil driver
which includes a BU941P Darlington
transistor which is protected from
voltage spikes using a string of four
75V 1W zener diodes. I couldn’t find
the BU941P transistor but Element14
sell a BU941ZP which appears to be a
reach the proper levels. On top of
this, the module includes “shootthrough” protection to ensure that
high-side and low-side switches can
never be on at the same time – in fact
it provides for a small “dead-time”
between them.
It is certainly possible to use a
braking resistor which is switched
across the DC bus if high-inertia
loads must be decelerated quickly.
However, it is a relatively expensive
proposition; another 600V 20A
IGBT, plus drive and protection circuitry, and a kW-rated, high-voltage
resistor with associated mounting
and cooling headaches.
It is only necessary when it is not
safe or feasible to decelerate the motor over a long period. The current
design offers a deceleration period
up to 30 seconds which should be
adequate for most loads.
replacement and it includes an integral
protection zener. The datasheet can
be seen at: http://www.datasheetcatalog.org/datasheet/stmicroelectronics/1008.pdf
If this part is used, is it safe to assume that the string of zener diodes
can be omitted? (T. R., via email).
• Yes, you can omit the four 75V diodes. No other changes are necessary.
Auto-transformer
for 120VAC
I have an idea that could be published in the Circuit Notebook pages.
Many electronic products that operate
on 120VAC are being purchased on
the net from the USA but they need
a source of 120VAC. I recently made
an auto-transformer from two identical mains transformers that I found
in a bargain bin from one of the local
suppliers.
It involves connecting the primary
windings in series and the secondary
windings in parallel. The primary
windings can then be configured as
an auto-transformer. (J. C., via email).
• It is an interesting idea but one that
simply cannot work, except maybe
with very light loads.
For a start, if you are merely going
to use the primaries of two identical
transformers in series to tap off 120V,
June 2012 99
Delusions Of Sound Quality Improvement On The Ultra-LD
I have downloaded and read
with great interest your articles on
the Ultra-LD Mk.3 amplifier and
upgrade from Mk.2. I have a couple
of comments and some questions.
I was very disappointed with the
Mk.2 amplifier sound quality as I
had already built your April 1996
amplifier design from a Jaycar kit
and it sounds better than the UltraLD Mk.2 in my tests. I managed to
raise the sound quality to nearly
that of the 1996 design by replacing
the 12kΩ feedback resistor with a
10kΩ bulk-foil version. I have made
similar upgrades on other amplifiers
previously and never been disappointed; it has always improved the
sound quality. I had some 10kΩ bulk
foil resistors already so I used this
instead of a 12kΩ resistor.
I suggest this modification is also
tried by others on both the Mk.2 and
Mk.3 to improve the sound quality
massively; it may also be worth replacing the 510Ω resistor attached
here too.
I can’t wait to complete the upgrade to Mk.3 on my amplifier and
hope it will then sound at least as
good as your April 1996 design.
During sound quality tests I will
also remove the bulk foil resistors so
I can compare a standard Mk.2 and
Mk.3 sound quality (I hope to hear
a massive difference).
I can’t seem to find a full kit of
parts for the Mk.3. Do you know of
any suppliers as I wish to build a
surround sound version for my son.
Thanks for your excellent designs
and honesty about the failings of the
Ultra-LD Mk.2; just as it should be,
honest and as it really is.
I have also made two of your Studio Series Preamps with headphones
and Alps motor pots; fantastic
sound, difficult to beat at any price.
It’s best to build an earthed metal
shield around the relays to reduce
noise though. (R. P., Horley, UK).
that means that the primary of the top
transformer must be able to provide the
full load current of the 120VAC device.
This may be OK for a low-power appliance but is unworkable for higher
power. There would also be no point in
connecting the transformer secondary
100 Silicon Chip
•
While your Ultra-LD Mk.2 may
possibly not sound as good as the
Plastic Power amplifier from April
1996, the idea that changing a single resistor makes all the difference
is just ridiculous. If your Ultra-LD
sounds poor then it is possible that
you have one or two low-spec transistors. This does happen. But if this
was the fault, changing the feedback
resistor would not make the slightest
difference.
For the record, the performance of
all of the Ultra-LD series amplifiers is
superior to the Plastic Power design
and you can see the distortion figure
comparisons for the Ultra-LD Mk.2 &
Mk.3 designs in the July 2011 issue.
That is not to say that the Plastic
Power amplifier was a bad design;
it was good at the time. But that
was then and now we can do better
and much of the improvement has
come about from improved layout
of the PCBs.
Yes, we have seen the stuff on
the internet where people claim
that when they change to bulk-foil
resistors the sound suddenly improves. Well, here we go again as
we must dismantle yet another in
a long (seemingly inexhaustible)
line of audio myths. So what are
the wonderful attributes of metal
foil resistors?
They are very close tolerance,
very stable (ie, they don’t change
their value), they have low noise and
they have a very low temperature
coefficient. These are all good characteristics but in the vast majority of
audio designs none of these make the
slightest difference in performance
or sound quality when compared to
exactly the same circuits which use
metal-film resistors.
The most important parameter
that could make a difference in
sound quality in the 12kΩ feedback
resistor is the temperature coefficient. If the TC was poor (high),
windings in parallel as they perform
no function in the auto-transformer
action. And if you get the parallel
connection wrong, both transformers
will burn out.
Secondly, many 120VAC appliances
simply would not withstand the stress-
the feedback resistor could change
its value over the course of a single
output excursion due to the differing self-heating as the output
voltage and thus dissipation in the
resistor changes. If this effect was
large enough to cause distortion,
we would see it in our measurements; the relatively low dissipation (90mW at full power) and the
resistor’s thermal inertia mean the
change in value is negligible with a
standard metal film resistor. If foil
resistors did make a difference, we
would definitely specify them.
That is really the end of the story
but we must reiterate a point that we
have made many times before. It is
simply futile for any audio enthusiast to make circuit changes unless he
or she has the equipment to measure
the effect of such changes. In our
experience, virtually all changes
made in this way actually degrade
performance.
And anyone who makes assertions
about improvements to sound quality on the basis of a simple “before
and after” listening test is probably
suffering from delusions. At the very
least, if listening tests are made they
must be “blind” whereby the person
doing the listening comparison does
not know which “source” he or she is
listening to. Better still are “doubleblind” tests whereby the person
running the test (ie, switching the
“sources”), does not know which
source is being listened to.
Such tests are very difficult to
do properly because such things as
gain, frequency and phase response
must all be very closely matched
otherwise very slight differences in
gain etc can easily lead to the conclusion that the slightly louder device
is the better one.
Here ends the diatribe. We understand that Altronics (www.altronics.
com.au) will ultimately have a kit of
parts for the amplifier.
es of connection to our 230VAC mains
supply even if they only have 120VAC
applied from an autotransformer. The
danger is that unless the wiring is correct, the 120VAC appliance may have
230VAC applied between its wiring
and any metalwork. So there is defisiliconchip.com.au
Retro-fitting A Heated Oxygen Sensor
I want to install a heated oxygen
sensor into my Land Rover Discovery. However, the ECU and the
vehicle were never produced with
oxygen sensors.
Is there a PCB for controlling the
heated element inside the oxygen
sensor? Can one be made up to
simply check for temperature and
supply voltage when needed?
I do have a 1-wire sensor installed,
however I would like a heated one to
perform more accurate tuning. (M.
M., Croydon South, Vic).
• Narrowband oxygen sensors
often do have heater elements, however, they are really only useful for
detecting stoichiometric ratios due
to the sharp change in voltage as
the mixture becomes slightly rich
or lean from stoichiometric. Outside
stoichiometric, the sensor voltage
does not accurately measure air/fuel
ratios that are rich or lean.
A wideband sensor, however, is
suitable for accurate measurements
of air/fuel ratios that are rich or lean
as well as stoichiometric. It can be
used in place of a standard narrowband sensor but requires a controller.
Have a look at the first article on the
Wideband Oxygen Sensor Controller
in this issue. It is the deluxe answer
for your application.
ANTRIM
TRANSFORMERS
manufactured in
Australia by
Harbuch Electronics Pty Ltd
harbuch<at>optusnet.com.au
Toroidal – Conventional Transformers
Power – Audio – Valve – ‘Specials’
Medical – Isolated – Stepup/down
Encased Power Supplies
Toroidal General
Construction
OUTER
INSULATION
OUTER
WINDING
WINDING
INSULATION
nitely a fire or shock hazard.
Third, the idea is probably not workable if the said 120VAC appliance contains an induction motor because our
50Hz grid may not suit 60Hz motors
or the resultant speed will be wrong.
A similar comment may apply to the
120VAC transformer in the appliance
itself.
Keeping the worst until last, you
cannot simply wire the primaries
or other windings of two transformers together and hope that they will
work as an auto-transformer. For that
to happen, the windings need be immersed in a common magnetic flux.
That cannot happen when you have
two separate transformers.
Using a bright LED
in a slide projector
I have hundreds of colour slides dating back to 1950 that I would like to examine with a projector. Unfortunately,
my old ALDIS 240VAC machine runs
extremely hot after a few minutes, as
I found out the hard way.
Could you advise me if there is a
super-bright Star LED module available that would work as a replacement
lamp in the projector? The projected
image does not have to light up the
far wall. A range of about two metres
would be enough to view the image.
If a Star LED will work OK could
you advise me what units of electronic
equipment etc I would need to purchase? (B. S., via email).
• Have a look at the LED Dazzler project in the February 2011 issue. One
siliconchip.com.au
10W LED would probably suffice but
it will need to be mounted on a heatsink. We assume that your projector is
fan-cooled so the heatsink might not
have to be very big.
Electronic substitute for
centrifugal start switch
In regards to the Induction Motor
Speed Controller presently being described, for single phase motors with
start switches, would it not be possible
the replace the centrifugal start switch
with an electronic switch which does
the same job, ie, after a pre-determined
time the switch would turn off and stay
off until such time as the power to the
motor was turned off?
Would these motors then have the
same torque at low speeds as at normal
speed with this arrangement? (J. B.,
Charlestown, NSW).
• Your suggestion is certainly feasible
but we would be reluctant to do it since
it would be necessary to modify the
wiring of the motor and then install the
additional circuitry in an external box.
Two and 3-wire
reluctor question
I am in need of some information or
advice on the reluctor version of the
Programmable Ignition system (SILICON CHIP, March, April & May 2007).
The reluctor referred to in your articles
is a 2-wire magnetic pickup but mine
has three wires.
By my understanding, two wires
means a sinewave and three is a
INNER
WINDING
CORE
CORE
INSULATION
Comprehensive data available:
www.harbuch.com.au
Harbuch Electronics Pty Ltd
9/40 Leighton Pl, HORNSBY 2077
Ph (02) 9476 5854 Fax (02) 9476 3231
square-wave signal. Do I use the Hall
effect version of the kit in this scenario? Or is there no allowance for my
application? (R. W., via email).
• A reluctor delivers an AC signal
which is generated in a coil that has
two wires. Some reluctors do have a
connection to chassis. A sensor with
three wires is possibly one that has
a processed signal where a supply
is required or the sensor may have a
power transistor to directly drive the
ignition coil.
You would need to find out what
the wires are normally connected to
and what type of signal the sensor
delivers. This should be possible by
turning over the motor to check for an
AC signal from two of the wires. It is
not recommended to connect any of
the three wires to a supply if the sensor
requires this unless the wire connections and required voltage are known.
If the 3-wire sensor requires a supply and has a digital output, then the
Hall effect configuration may be suitable. If the sensor has an integrated
transistor for directly driving the
ignition coil, then the points version
might be better where the points input
June 2012 101
Speedo Corrector Gives Intermittent Reading
I have purchased five Speedo
Corrector kits (Jaycar KC5435) to be
used in a limited vehicle production
to overcome an original equipment
manufacturer problem. The vehicle
speedo needs to be clocked faster
than the incoming frequency from
the axle so this kit is ideal.
They work perfectly well except
for a randomly occurring problem.
Just when taking off (1 in 20 times)
the Speedo Corrector sends out a
trail of pulses and the speedo “runs”
around to 160km/h and returns
to zero and then indicates vehicle
speed. I have tried filtering the incoming and outgoing pulses but it
is no different.
is the output transistor from the sensor.
Either way, the Programmable Ignition does cater for the signal from
your sensor once the wire connection
requirements/output are determined.
Boat projects
wanted
I love your projects and your DIY
style. Have you ever considered doing
marine projects such as depth finders,
GSP locating mapping auto pilot, rudder angle indicator, fuel consumption
and smart chargers? There is a hole that
other main-stream magazines forget.
Keep up the good work. (J. S., Shelton, Ct, USA).
• We have produced a number of boat
projects, as follows:
(1) Twin-Engine Speed Match Indicator, November 2009.
(2) Ultrasonic Anti-fouling For Boats,
September & November 2010.
Is it possible to have a software
update in the PIC chip to eliminate
this problem? (J. B., via email).
• As far as we are aware, there is
no software problem that causes the
random high-frequency signal burst.
Instead, the incorrect reading
could possibly be corrected by increasing the capacitor at the input
(ie, across the collector and emitter
of transistor Q1) from 1nF (code 102
or 1n0) to 10nF (code 103 or 10n).
On the PCB, this is the capacitor
just above the 150Ω resistor that is
above IC1.
If the problem persists, try a 47nF
(473 or 47n) or 100nF (104 or 100n)
capacitor instead.
(3) GPS Boat Computer/Navigator,
October 2010.
(4) Rudder Position Indicator, July &
August 2011.
We can supply back issues for
$AUD15.00 each including airmail
P&P (outside Australia).
Fault in digital
thermometer
I have purchased the kit for the High
Temperature Digital Thermometer
(SILICON CHIP’s Performance Electronics for Cars, 2004; Jaycar KC-5376). My
intent was to measure exhaust gas temperature and you advertise your device
is capable of doing that. However,
after soldering everything into place
the device has never worked correctly
when measuring high temperatures.
After calibrating the device it seems
to perform more or less OK when
measuring temperatures up to 100°C.
But when I try to measure the temperature of the exhaust gases the reading
of the temperature on the LCD starts
rising and when it reaches somewhere
around 300°C, the rising of the temperature stops for a second, and then
the reading of the temperature starts
going down and goes below zero, eventually showing negative temperatures
although the real temperature is a few
hundred degrees Celsius.
But again, when measuring up to
around 100°C it seems to work OK.
Whatever I do, it is always like that. I
believe I connected the LCD correctly
and also connected 9 pin to pin 10
and 5 pin to pin 8 on the LCD. My
thermocouple is specially designed
to measure exhaust gas temperatures.
(M. E., via email).
• When used to connect to the exhaust of a vehicle, the thermocouple
probe needs to be an insulated type.
An earthed probe will cause the thermocouple to be grounded and the
readings will be affected.
Either ensure an earthed probe is
insulated electrically from the exhaust
pipe or use an insulated probe. Use of
an insulated probe is mentioned in the
parts list and text under the “fitting”
sub-heading.
You can test if your probe is earthed
by measuring the resistance between
the probe and one of the thermocouple connections. An earthed probe
will show close to zero ohms, while
an insulated probe will show a high
impedance above 1MΩ.
We should also note that your probe
could have a fault whereby it goes open
circuit at temperatures above 300°C.
Incidentally, the High Temperature
Thermometer/Thermostat described
in the May 2012 issue of SILICON CHIP
is a similar project but with improved
continued on page 104
WARNING!
SILICON CHIP magazine regularly describes projects which employ a mains power supply or produce high voltage. All such
projects should be considered dangerous or even lethal if not used safely.
Readers are warned that high voltage wiring should be carried out according to the instructions in the articles. When
working on these projects use extreme care to ensure that you do not accidentally come into contact with mains AC voltages
or high voltage DC. If you are not confident about working with projects employing mains voltages or other high voltages,
you are advised not to attempt work on them. Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd disclaims any liability for damages should
anyone be killed or injured while working on a project or circuit described in any issue of SILICON CHIP magazine.
Devices or circuits described in SILICON CHIP may be covered by patents. SILICON CHIP disclaims any liability for the infringement of such patents by the manufacturing or selling of any such equipment. SILICON CHIP also disclaims any liability
for projects which are used in such a way as to infringe relevant government regulations and by-laws.
Advertisers are warned that they are responsible for the content of all advertisements and that they must conform to the
Competition & Consumer Act 2010 or as subsequently amended and to any governmental regulations which are applicable.
102 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
MARKET CENTRE
Cash in your surplus gear. Advertise it here in SILICON CHIP
ELNEC IC PROGRAMMERS
Battery Packs & Chargers
High quality
Realistic prices
Free software updates
Large range of adaptors
Windows 95/98/Me/NT/2k/XP
C O N T R O L S
Tough times
demand innovative solutions!
CLEVERSCOPE
USB OSCILLOSCOPES
2 x 100MSa/s 10bit inputs + trigger
100MHz bandwidth
8 x digital inputs
4M samples/input
Sig-gen + spectrum analyser
Windows 98/Me/NT/2k/XP
IMAGECRAFT C COMPILERS
ANSI C compilers, Windows IDE
AVR, TMS430, ARM7/ARM9
68HC08, 68HC11, 68HC12
GRANTRONICS PTY LTD
www.grantronics.com.au
Siomar Battery Engineering
www.batterybook.com
Phone (08) 9302 5444
Circuit Ideas Wanted
Made in Australia, used by OEMs world-wide
splat-sc.com
Do you have a good circuit idea? If so,
sketch it out, write a brief description of
its operation & send it to us. We pay up
to $100 for an original circuit so send
your idea to:
Silicon Chip Publications,
PO Box 139, Collaroy, NSW 2097.
KIT ASSEMBLY & REPAIR
FOR SALE
PCBs MADE, ONE OR MANY. Any
format, hobbyists welcome. Sesame
Electronics Phone (02) 8068 2713.
sesame<at>sesame.com.au
www.sesame.com.au
LEDs! Nichia, Cree and other brand
name LEDs at excellent prices. LED
drivers, including ultra-reliable linear
driver options. Many other interesting
and hard-to-find electronic items!
www.ledsales.com.au
PCBs & Micros: Silicon Chip Pub
lications can supply PCBs and programmed micros for recent (and some
not so recent) projects described in the
magazine. Phone ( 02) 9939 3295 or
email silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
questronix.com.au – audiovisual experts solve home, corporate security
and devotional installation & editing
woes. QuestAV CYP, Kramer TVone
(02) 4343 1970 or sales<at>questronix.
com.au
WANTED
CUSTOMERS WANTED: Truscotts
Electronic World – large range of semiconductors and passive components for
industry, hobbyist and amateur projects
including Drew Diamond. 27 The Mall,
South Croydon, Melbourne. Phone
(03) 9723 3860. www.electronicworld.
com.au
ADVERTISING IN MARKET CENTRE
Classified Ad Rates: $29.50 (incl. GST) for up to 20 words plus 85 cents for
each additional word. Display ads: $54.50 (incl. GST) per column centimetre
(max. 10cm). Closing date: 5 weeks prior to month of sale. To book, email the
text to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au and include your name, address & credit
card details, or fax (02) 9939 2648, or phone (02) 9939 3295.
siliconchip.com.au
KEITH RIPPON KIT ASSEMBLY &
REPAIR:
* Australia & New Zealand;
* Small production runs.
Phone Keith 0409 662 794.
keith.rippon<at>gmail.com
GEOFF COPPA KIT ASSEMBLY AND
TROUBLE SHOOTING SERVICE.
Phone Geoff on 0414226102.
coppamitchell2<at>bigpond.com
Issues Getting
Dog-Eared? $14.
REAL
VALUE
AT
95
PLUS P
&P
Keep your
copies of
SILICON CHIP
safe with
these handy
binders
Available Aust. only. Price: $A14.95 plus
$10 p&p per order (includes GST). Just fill in
and mail the handy order form in this issue;
or fax (02) 9939 2648; or call (02) 9939 3295
and quote your credit card number.
June 2012 103
Advertising Index
Altronics...........................loose insert
Dyne Industries................................ 7
Embedded Logic Solutions.............. 8
Emona Instruments........................ 11
Geoff Coppa................................. 103
Grantronics.................................. 103
Harbuch Electronics..................... 101
Hare & Forbes............................ OBC
Instant PCBs................................ 103
Ask SILICON CHIP
DOWNLOAD OUR CATALOG at
. . . continued from p102
www.iinet.net.au/~worcom
circuitry based on an Analog Devices
AD8495 precision instrumentation
amplifier.
MPPT operation
misunderstood
According to the schematic supplied for the MPPT Solar Charge
Controller in the March 2012 issue,
there is no voltage conversion that is
characteristic of a MPPT controller. I
believe it is not really an MPPT device.
Just having a bit of smarts does not
qualify. (J. H., via email).
• The MPPT operation of this project
was fully explained in the first article,
in the February 2011 issue. The voltage
WORLDWIDE ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS
PO Box 631, Hillarys, WA 6923
Ph: (08) 9307 7305 Fax: (08) 9307 7309
Email: worcom<at>iinet.net.au
conversion is done by switching the
Mosfet at 31.25kHz under the control
of the micro. There is a brief mention
of this PWM (pulse width modulation)
in the caption of the circuit diagram
on page 92 of the March 2012 issue.
So the microcontroller is actually
providing two functions: MPPT for the
solar panel and 3-stage charging for the
battery. If you would like a copy of the
February 2011 issue, we can supply
it for $12 including postage and packSC
ing.
Notes & Errata
Ultra-LD Mk.3 200W Amplifier
Module, Pt.2 (August 2011): the Dynamic Headroom specification was
calculated incorrectly. It should be
1dB for 8Ω loads and 1.3dB for 4Ω
loads. The Music Power and Slew
Rate figures are correct.
USB MIDIMate (October 2011):
the 18-pin IC socket specified in
the parts list should be a 20-pin IC
socket.
Crystal DAC (February 2012): the
original PCB has the trimpots rotating in the opposite direction to that
stated in the article, ie, clockwise
rotation decreases the quiescent
current rather than increasing it. A
modified PCB file has been uploaded
to the website which fixes this prob104 Silicon Chip
lem. Constructors using the original
PCB should rotate both trimpots
fully clockwise before applying
power for the first time.
1.5kW Induction Motor Speed Controller (April-May 2012): the PCB
overlay diagram (May, p69) shows
two 270Ω resistors below IC3 which
should have been labelled 100Ω
(their value is wrong in the parts
list too). Also, the circuit diagram
(April, p22) shows the three pull-up
resistors for the pins of CON5 (two
4.7kΩ & one 1.5kΩ) all connected
to pin 1 of CON4. They are actually
connected to the +3.3V rail.
Finally, the Altronics catalog
number for the 470μF 400V capacitors in the parts list is incorrect. It
should be R5448.
Jaycar ................................ IFC,49-56
Keith Rippon................................. 103
Kitstop............................................ 45
LED Sales.................................... 103
LHP.NET.AU................................. IBC
Microchip Technology..................... 15
Mikroelektronika............................. 23
Oatley Electronics.......................... 31
Ocean Controls................................ 6
Quest Electronics......................... 103
Radio & Hobbies DVD.................... 45
Reality Design.................................. 7
Red Button Technologies................. 5
RF Modules.................................. 104
Roc-Solid......................................... 9
Sesame Electronics..................... 103
Silicon Chip Binders................ 72,103
Silicon Chip Bookshop................... 88
Silicon Chip Order Form................ 97
Silicon Chip Partshop..................... 96
Silicon Chip Subscriptions............. 89
Siomar Battery Engineering...... 3,103
Splat Controls.............................. 103
Truscotts Electronic World............ 103
Verbatim Lights.............................. 81
Wiltronics....................................... 10
Winradio Communications............. 25
Worldwide Elect. Components..... 104
siliconchip.com.au
|